summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/.emacs.d/org-7.4/doc/org
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to '.emacs.d/org-7.4/doc/org')
-rw-r--r--.emacs.d/org-7.4/doc/org16592
1 files changed, 16592 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.emacs.d/org-7.4/doc/org b/.emacs.d/org-7.4/doc/org
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7712859
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.emacs.d/org-7.4/doc/org
@@ -0,0 +1,16592 @@
+This is org, produced by makeinfo version 4.8 from org.texi.
+
+ This manual is for Org version 7.4.
+
+ Copyright (C) 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010 Free Software
+Foundation, Inc.
+
+ Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this
+ document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License,
+ Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software
+ Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts
+ being "A GNU Manual," and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a)
+ below. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled
+ "GNU Free Documentation License."
+
+ (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: "You have the freedom to copy and
+ modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
+ developing GNU and promoting software freedom."
+
+ This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU
+ Free Documentation License. If you want to distribute this
+ document separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a
+ copy of the license to the document, as described in section 6 of
+ the license.
+
+INFO-DIR-SECTION Emacs
+START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
+* Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
+END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
+
+
+File: org, Node: Top, Next: Introduction, Prev: (dir), Up: (dir)
+
+Org Mode Manual
+***************
+
+This manual is for Org version 7.4.
+
+ Copyright (C) 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010 Free Software
+Foundation, Inc.
+
+ Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this
+ document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License,
+ Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software
+ Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts
+ being "A GNU Manual," and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a)
+ below. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled
+ "GNU Free Documentation License."
+
+ (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: "You have the freedom to copy and
+ modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
+ developing GNU and promoting software freedom."
+
+ This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU
+ Free Documentation License. If you want to distribute this
+ document separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a
+ copy of the license to the document, as described in section 6 of
+ the license.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Introduction:: Getting started
+* Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
+* Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
+* Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
+* TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
+* Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
+* Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
+* Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
+* Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
+* Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
+* Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
+* Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
+* Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
+* Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
+* Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
+* Hacking:: How to hack your way around
+* MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
+* History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
+* Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
+* Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
+* Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
+* Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
+
+ --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
+
+Introduction
+
+* Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
+* Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
+* Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
+* Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
+* Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
+
+Document structure
+
+* Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
+* Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
+* Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
+* Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
+* Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
+* Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
+* Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
+* Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
+* Blocks:: Folding blocks
+* Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
+* Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
+
+Tables
+
+* Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
+* Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
+* Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
+* Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
+* The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
+* Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
+
+The spreadsheet
+
+* References:: How to refer to another field or range
+* Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
+* Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
+* Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
+* Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
+* Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
+* Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
+* Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
+
+Hyperlinks
+
+* Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
+* Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
+* External links:: URL-like links to the world
+* Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
+* Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
+* Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
+* Search options:: Linking to a specific location
+* Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
+
+Internal links
+
+* Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
+
+TODO items
+
+* TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
+* TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
+* Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
+* Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
+* Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
+* Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
+
+Extended use of TODO keywords
+
+* Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
+* TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
+* Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
+* Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
+* Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
+* Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
+* TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
+
+Progress logging
+
+* Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
+* Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
+* Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
+
+Tags
+
+* Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
+* Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
+* Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
+
+Properties and columns
+
+* Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
+* Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
+* Property searches:: Matching property values
+* Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
+* Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
+* Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
+
+Column view
+
+* Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
+* Using column view:: How to create and use column view
+* Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
+
+Defining columns
+
+* Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
+* Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
+
+Dates and times
+
+* Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
+* Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
+* Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
+* Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
+* Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
+* Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
+* Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
+
+Creating timestamps
+
+* The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
+* Custom time format:: Making dates look different
+
+Deadlines and scheduling
+
+* Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
+* Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
+
+Clocking work time
+
+* Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
+* The clock table:: Detailed reports
+* Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
+
+Capture - Refile - Archive
+
+* Capture:: Capturing new stuff
+* Attachments:: Add files to tasks
+* RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
+* Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
+* Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
+* Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
+
+Capture
+
+* Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
+* Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
+* Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
+
+Capture templates
+
+* Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
+* Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
+
+Archiving
+
+* Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
+* Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
+
+Agenda views
+
+* Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
+* Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
+* Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
+* Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
+* Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
+* Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
+* Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
+* Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
+
+The built-in agenda views
+
+* Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
+* Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
+* Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
+* Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
+* Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
+* Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
+
+Presentation and sorting
+
+* Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
+* Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
+* Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
+
+Custom agenda views
+
+* Storing searches:: Type once, use often
+* Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
+* Setting Options:: Changing the rules
+
+Markup for rich export
+
+* Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
+* Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
+* Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
+* Include files:: Include additional files into a document
+* Index entries:: Making an index
+* Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
+* Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
+
+Structural markup elements
+
+* Document title:: Where the title is taken from
+* Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
+* Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
+* Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
+* Lists:: Lists
+* Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
+* Footnote markup:: Footnotes
+* Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
+* Horizontal rules:: Make a line
+* Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
+
+Embedded LaTeX
+
+* Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
+* Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
+* LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
+* Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
+* CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
+
+Exporting
+
+* Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
+* Export options:: Per-file export settings
+* The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
+* ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
+* HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
+* LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to LaTeX, and processing to PDF
+* DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
+* TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
+* Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
+* XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
+* iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
+
+HTML export
+
+* HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
+* Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
+* Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
+* Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
+* Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
+* Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
+* Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
+* CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
+* JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
+
+LaTeX and PDF export
+
+* LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
+* Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
+* Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal LaTeX code
+* Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to LaTeX
+* Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into LaTeX output
+* Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
+
+DocBook export
+
+* DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
+* Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
+* Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
+* Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
+* Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
+* Special characters:: How to handle special characters
+
+Publishing
+
+* Configuration:: Defining projects
+* Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
+* Sample configuration:: Example projects
+* Triggering publication:: Publication commands
+
+Configuration
+
+* Project alist:: The central configuration variable
+* Sources and destinations:: From here to there
+* Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
+* Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
+* Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
+* Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
+* Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
+* Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
+
+Sample configuration
+
+* Simple example:: One-component publishing
+* Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
+
+Working with source code
+
+* Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
+* Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
+* Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
+* Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
+* Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
+* Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
+* Languages:: List of supported code block languages
+* Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
+* Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
+* Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
+* Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
+* Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
+
+Header arguments
+
+* Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
+* Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
+
+Using header arguments
+
+* System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
+* Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
+* Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
+* Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
+* Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
+* Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
+
+Specific header arguments
+
+* var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
+* results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
+ be collected and handled
+* file:: Specify a path for file output
+* dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
+ directory for code block execution
+* exports:: Export code and/or results
+* tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
+* comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
+ code files
+* no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
+ expansion during tangling
+* session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
+* noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
+* cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
+* hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
+* colnames:: Handle column names in tables
+* rownames:: Handle row names in tables
+* shebang:: Make tangled files executable
+* eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
+
+Miscellaneous
+
+* Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
+* Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
+* Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
+* Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
+* Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
+* In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
+* The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
+* Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
+* TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
+* Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
+
+Interaction with other packages
+
+* Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
+* Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
+
+Hacking
+
+* Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
+* Add-on packages:: Available extensions
+* Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
+* Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
+* Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for LaTeX and other programs
+* Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
+* Special agenda views:: Customized views
+* Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
+* Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
+* Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
+
+Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
+
+* Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
+* A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
+* Translator functions:: Copy and modify
+* Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
+
+MobileOrg
+
+* Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
+* Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
+* Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
+
+
+File: org, Node: Introduction, Next: Document Structure, Prev: Top, Up: Top
+
+1 Introduction
+**************
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
+* Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
+* Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
+* Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
+* Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
+
+
+File: org, Node: Summary, Next: Installation, Prev: Introduction, Up: Introduction
+
+1.1 Summary
+===========
+
+Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
+project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
+
+ Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
+lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is implemented
+on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the content of
+large files well structured. Visibility cycling and structure editing
+help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created with a built-in
+table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines, timestamps, and
+scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an agenda that
+utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar and diary.
+Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails, Usenet messages,
+BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects. For printing and
+sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a structured ASCII
+file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an iCalendar file.
+It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of linked web pages.
+
+ As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to
+outline nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted
+in queries and create dynamic agenda views.
+
+ Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work
+with embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code
+evaluation, documentation, and tangling.
+
+ Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
+capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
+minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
+tables in arbitrary file types, for example in LaTeX. The structure
+editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with the
+minor Orgstruct mode.
+
+ Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should feel
+like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
+imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
+it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for
+different ends, for example:
+
+ * an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing
+ * an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes
+ * a TODO list editor
+ * a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling
+ * an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system
+ * a simple hypertext system, with HTML and LaTeX export
+ * a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages
+ * an environment for literate programming
+
+ There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
+version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
+questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc. This page is located at
+`http://orgmode.org'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Installation, Next: Activation, Prev: Summary, Up: Introduction
+
+1.2 Installation
+================
+
+Important: If you are using a version of Org that is part of the Emacs
+distribution or an XEmacs package, please skip this section and go
+directly to *Note Activation::.
+
+ If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution
+`.zip' or `.tar' file, or as a Git archive, you must take the following
+steps to install it: go into the unpacked Org distribution directory
+and edit the top section of the file `Makefile'. You must set the name
+of the Emacs binary (likely either `emacs' or `xemacs'), and the paths
+to the directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you
+don't have access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run
+Org directly from the distribution directory by adding the `lisp'
+subdirectory to the Emacs load path. To do this, add the following
+line to `.emacs':
+
+ (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
+
+If you plan to use code from the `contrib' subdirectory, do a similar
+step for this directory:
+
+ (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
+
+Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
+
+ make
+
+If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is all.
+If you want to install Org into the system directories, use (as
+administrator)
+
+ make install
+
+ Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in
+the `install-info' program. In Debian it copies the info files into the
+correct directory and modifies the info directory file. In many other
+systems, the files need to be copied to the correct directory
+separately, and `install-info' then only modifies the directory file.
+Check your system documentation to find out which of the following
+commands you need:
+
+ make install-info
+ make install-info-debian
+
+ Then add the following line to `.emacs'. It is needed so that Emacs
+can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
+when Org-mode starts.
+ (require 'org-install)
+
+ Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Activation, Next: Feedback, Prev: Installation, Up: Introduction
+
+1.3 Activation
+==============
+
+Add the following lines to your `.emacs' file. The last three lines
+define _global_ keys for the commands `org-store-link', `org-agenda',
+and `org-iswitchb'--please choose suitable keys yourself.
+
+ ;; The following lines are always needed. Choose your own keys.
+ (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
+ (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
+ (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
+ (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
+
+ Furthermore, you must activate `font-lock-mode' in Org buffers,
+because significant functionality depends on font-locking being active.
+You can do this with either one of the following two lines (XEmacs
+users must use the second option):
+ (global-font-lock-mode 1) ; for all buffers
+ (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock) ; Org buffers only
+
+ With this setup, all files with extension `.org' will be put into
+Org-mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look like
+this:
+
+ MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
+
+which will select Org-mode for this buffer no matter what the file's
+name is. See also the variable `org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file'.
+
+ Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is active. To
+make use of this, you need to have `transient-mark-mode'
+(`zmacs-regions' in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
+in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
+ (transient-mark-mode 1)
+ If you do not like `transient-mark-mode', you can create an active
+region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing `C-<SPC>'
+twice before moving the cursor.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Feedback, Next: Conventions, Prev: Activation, Up: Introduction
+
+1.4 Feedback
+============
+
+If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or
+ideas about it, please mail to the Org mailing list
+<emacs-orgmode@gnu.org>. If you are not a member of the mailing list,
+your mail will be passed to the list after a moderator has approved
+it(1).
+
+ For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the
+latest version of Org available--if you are running an outdated
+version, it is quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If
+the bug persists, prepare a report and provide as much information as
+possible, including the version information of Emacs (`M-x
+emacs-version <RET>') and Org (`M-x org-version <RET>'), as well as the
+Org related setup in `.emacs'. The easiest way to do this is to use
+the command
+ M-x org-submit-bug-report
+ which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
+that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the
+Email from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your
+Email program.
+
+ If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how
+to create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear
+information about:
+
+ 1. What exactly did you do?
+
+ 2. What did you expect to happen?
+
+ 3. What happened instead?
+ Thank you for helping to improve this program.
+
+How to create a useful backtrace
+................................
+
+If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
+understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
+providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a _backtrace_.
+This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
+error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
+
+ 1. Reload uncompiled versions of all Org-mode Lisp files. The
+ backtrace contains much more information if it is produced with
+ uncompiled code. To do this, use
+ C-u M-x org-reload RET
+ or select `Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled' from the
+ menu.
+
+ 2. Go to the `Options' menu and select `Enter Debugger on Error'
+ (XEmacs has this option in the `Troubleshooting' sub-menu).
+
+ 3. Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
+ document the steps you take.
+
+ 4. When you hit the error, a `*Backtrace*' buffer will appear on the
+ screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using `C-x C-w')
+ and attach it to your bug report.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Please consider subscribing to the mailing list, in order to
+minimize the work the mailing list moderators have to do.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Conventions, Prev: Feedback, Up: Introduction
+
+1.5 Typesetting conventions used in this manual
+===============================================
+
+Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags, and property
+names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
+
+`TODO'
+`WAITING'
+ TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
+ user-defined.
+
+`boss'
+`ARCHIVE'
+ User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with
+ special meaning are written with all capitals.
+
+`Release'
+`PRIORITY'
+ User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
+ special meaning are written with all capitals.
+
+ The manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for
+accessing functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for
+different functions, depending on context. The command that is bound
+to such keys has a generic name, like `org-metaright'. In the manual
+we will, wherever possible, give the function that is internally called
+by the generic command. For example, in the chapter on document
+structure, `M-<right>' will be listed to call `org-do-demote', while in
+the chapter on tables, it will be listed to call
+org-table-move-column-right.
+
+ If you prefer, you can compile the manual without the command names
+by unsetting the flag `cmdnames' in `org.texi'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Document Structure, Next: Tables, Prev: Introduction, Up: Top
+
+2 Document structure
+********************
+
+Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to edit the
+structure of the document.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
+* Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
+* Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
+* Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
+* Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
+* Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
+* Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
+* Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
+* Blocks:: Folding blocks
+* Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
+* Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
+
+
+File: org, Node: Outlines, Next: Headlines, Prev: Document Structure, Up: Document Structure
+
+2.1 Outlines
+============
+
+Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a document
+to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least for me) is
+the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview of this
+structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the document
+to show only the general document structure and the parts currently
+being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of outlines by
+compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single command,
+`org-cycle', which is bound to the <TAB> key.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Headlines, Next: Visibility cycling, Prev: Outlines, Up: Document Structure
+
+2.2 Headlines
+=============
+
+Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
+start with one or more stars, on the left margin(1). For example:
+
+ * Top level headline
+ ** Second level
+ *** 3rd level
+ some text
+ *** 3rd level
+ more text
+
+ * Another top level headline
+
+Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an outline
+that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline starters.
+*Note Clean view::, describes a setup to realize this.
+
+ An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
+will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
+least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
+the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
+variable `org-cycle-separator-lines' to modify this behavior.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) See the variables `org-special-ctrl-a/e', `org-special-ctrl-k',
+and `org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree' to configure special behavior of `C-a',
+`C-e', and `C-k' in headlines.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Visibility cycling, Next: Motion, Prev: Headlines, Up: Document Structure
+
+2.3 Visibility cycling
+======================
+
+Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer. Org
+uses just two commands, bound to <TAB> and `S-<TAB>' to change the
+visibility in the buffer.
+
+`<TAB>' (`org-cycle')
+ _Subtree cycling_: Rotate current subtree among the states
+
+ ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
+ '-----------------------------------'
+
+ The cursor must be on a headline for this to work(1). When the
+ cursor is at the beginning of the buffer and the first line is not
+ a headline, then <TAB> actually runs global cycling (see
+ below)(2). Also when called with a prefix argument (`C-u <TAB>'),
+ global cycling is invoked.
+
+`S-<TAB>' (`org-global-cycle')
+C-u <TAB>
+ _Global cycling_: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
+
+ ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
+ '--------------------------------------'
+
+ When `S-<TAB>' is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
+ CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that
+ inside tables, `S-<TAB>' jumps to the previous field.
+
+`C-u C-u C-u <TAB>' (`show-all')
+ Show all, including drawers.
+
+`C-c C-r' (`org-reveal')
+ Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the
+ following heading and the hierarchy above. Useful for working
+ near a location that has been exposed by a sparse tree command
+ (*note Sparse trees::) or an agenda command (*note Agenda
+ commands::). With a prefix argument show, on each level, all
+ sibling headings. With double prefix arg, also show the entire
+ subtree of the parent.
+
+`C-c C-k' (`show-branches')
+ Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one
+ subtree.
+
+`C-c C-x b' (`org-tree-to-indirect-buffer')
+ Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer(3). With a numeric
+ prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N
+ is negative then go up that many levels. With a `C-u' prefix, do
+ not remove the previously used indirect buffer.
+
+ When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
+OVERVIEW, i.e. only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
+configured through the variable `org-startup-folded', or on a per-file
+basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the buffer:
+
+ #+STARTUP: overview
+ #+STARTUP: content
+ #+STARTUP: showall
+ #+STARTUP: showeverything
+
+Furthermore, any entries with a `VISIBILITY' property (*note Properties
+and Columns::) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed
+values for this property are `folded', `children', `content', and `all'.
+`C-u C-u <TAB>' (`org-set-startup-visibility')
+ Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e. whatever
+ is requested by startup options and `VISIBILITY' properties in
+ individual entries.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) see, however, the option `org-cycle-emulate-tab'.
+
+ (2) see the option `org-cycle-global-at-bob'.
+
+ (3) The indirect buffer (*note Indirect Buffers: (emacs)Indirect
+Buffers.) will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the
+current tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the
+original buffer, but without affecting visibility in that buffer.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Motion, Next: Structure editing, Prev: Visibility cycling, Up: Document Structure
+
+2.4 Motion
+==========
+
+The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
+
+`C-c C-n' (`outline-next-visible-heading')
+ Next heading.
+
+`C-c C-p' (`outline-previous-visible-heading')
+ Previous heading.
+
+`C-c C-f' (`org-forward-same-level')
+ Next heading same level.
+
+`C-c C-b' (`org-backward-same-level')
+ Previous heading same level.
+
+`C-c C-u' (`outline-up-heading')
+ Backward to higher level heading.
+
+`C-c C-j' (`org-goto')
+ Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
+ visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer,
+ where you can use the following keys to find your destination:
+ <TAB> Cycle visibility.
+ <down> / <up> Next/previous visible headline.
+ <RET> Select this location.
+ / Do a Sparse-tree search
+ The following keys work if you turn off `org-goto-auto-isearch'
+ n / p Next/previous visible headline.
+ f / b Next/previous headline same level.
+ u One level up.
+ 0-9 Digit argument.
+ q Quit
+ See also the variable `org-goto-interface'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Structure editing, Next: Sparse trees, Prev: Motion, Up: Document Structure
+
+2.5 Structure editing
+=====================
+
+`M-<RET>' (`org-insert-heading')
+ Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is
+ in a plain list item, a new item is created (*note Plain lists::).
+ To force creation of a new headline, use a prefix argument, or
+ first press <RET> to get to the beginning of the next line. When
+ this command is used in the middle of a line, the line is split
+ and the rest of the line becomes the new headline(1). If the
+ command is used at the beginning of a headline, the new headline is
+ created before the current line. If at the beginning of any other
+ line, the content of that line is made the new heading. If the
+ command is used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e. behind the
+ ellipses at the end of a headline), then a headline like the
+ current one will be inserted after the end of the subtree.
+
+`C-<RET>' (`org-insert-heading-respect-content')
+ Just like `M-<RET>', except when adding a new heading below the
+ current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead
+ of before it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
+
+`M-S-<RET>' (`org-insert-todo-heading')
+ Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See
+ also the variable `org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change'.
+
+`C-S-<RET>' (`org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content')
+ Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
+ `C-<RET>', the new headline will be inserted after the current
+ subtree.
+
+`<TAB>' (`org-cycle')
+ In a new entry with no text yet, the first <TAB> demotes the entry
+ to become a child of the previous one. The next <TAB> makes it a
+ parent, and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another <TAB>,
+ and you are back to the initial level.
+
+`M-<left>' (`org-do-promote')
+ Promote current heading by one level.
+
+`M-<right>' (`org-do-demote')
+ Demote current heading by one level.
+
+`M-S-<left>' (`org-promote-subtree')
+ Promote the current subtree by one level.
+
+`M-S-<right>' (`org-demote-subtree')
+ Demote the current subtree by one level.
+
+`M-S-<up>' (`org-move-subtree-up')
+ Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same level).
+
+`M-S-<down>' (`org-move-subtree-down')
+ Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
+
+`C-c C-x C-w' (`org-cut-subtree')
+ Kill subtree, i.e. remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
+ With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
+
+`C-c C-x M-w' (`org-copy-subtree')
+ Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy
+ the N sequential subtrees.
+
+`C-c C-x C-y' (`org-paste-subtree')
+ Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the
+ subtree to make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position.
+ The yank level can also be specified with a numeric prefix
+ argument, or by yanking after a headline marker like `****'.
+
+`C-y' (`org-yank')
+ Depending on the variables `org-yank-adjusted-subtrees' and
+ `org-yank-folded-subtrees', Org's internal `yank' command will
+ paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command
+ as `C-c C-x C-y'. With the default settings, no level adjustment
+ will take place, but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing
+ so would swallow text previously visible. Any prefix argument to
+ this command will force a normal `yank' to be executed, with the
+ prefix passed along. A good way to force a normal yank is `C-u
+ C-y'. If you use `yank-pop' after a yank, it will yank previous
+ kill items plainly, without adjustment and folding.
+
+`C-c C-x c' (`org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift')
+ Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You
+ will be prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can
+ also specify if any timestamps in the entry should be shifted.
+ This can be useful, for example, to create a number of tasks
+ related to a series of lectures to prepare. For more details, see
+ the docstring of the command `org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift'.
+
+`C-c C-w' (`org-refile')
+ Refile entry or region to a different location. *Note Refiling
+ notes::.
+
+`C-c ^' (`org-sort-entries-or-items')
+ Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all
+ entries in the region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of
+ the current headline are sorted. The command prompts for the
+ sorting method, which can be alphabetically, numerically, by time
+ (first timestamp with active preferred, creation time, scheduled
+ time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword (in the
+ sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the
+ value of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You
+ can also supply your own function to extract the sorting key.
+ With a `C-u' prefix, sorting will be case-sensitive. With two
+ `C-u C-u' prefixes, duplicate entries will also be removed.
+
+`C-x n s' (`org-narrow-to-subtree')
+ Narrow buffer to current subtree.
+
+`C-x n w' (`widen')
+ Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
+
+`C-c *' (`org-toggle-heading')
+ Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it
+ becomes a subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into
+ a normal line by removing the stars. If there is an active
+ region, turn all lines in the region into headlines. If the first
+ line in the region was an item, turn only the item lines into
+ headlines. Finally, if the first line is a headline, remove the
+ stars from all headlines in the region.
+
+ When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
+demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
+headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
+line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
+just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
+inside a table (*note Tables::), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
+functionality.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) If you do not want the line to be split, customize the variable
+`org-M-RET-may-split-line'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Sparse trees, Next: Plain lists, Prev: Structure editing, Up: Document Structure
+
+2.6 Sparse trees
+================
+
+An important feature of Org-mode is the ability to construct _sparse
+trees_ for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
+document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is
+made visible along with the headline structure above it(1). Just try
+it out and you will see immediately how it works.
+
+ Org-mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
+commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
+
+`C-c /' (`org-sparse-tree')
+ This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating
+ command.
+
+`C-c / r' (`org-occur')
+ Occur. Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all
+ matches. If the match is in a headline, the headline is made
+ visible. If the match is in the body of an entry, headline and
+ body are made visible. In order to provide minimal context, also
+ the full hierarchy of headlines above the match is shown, as well
+ as the headline following the match. Each match is also
+ highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed
+ by an editing command(2), or by pressing `C-c C-c'. When called
+ with a `C-u' prefix argument, previous highlights are kept, so
+ several calls to this command can be stacked.
+
+For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
+use the variable `org-agenda-custom-commands' to define fast keyboard
+access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
+accessible through the agenda dispatcher (*note Agenda dispatcher::).
+For example:
+
+ (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
+ '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
+
+will define the key `C-c a f' as a shortcut for creating a sparse tree
+matching the string `FIXME'.
+
+ The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO
+keywords, tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this
+manual.
+
+ To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
+`ps-print-buffer-with-faces' which does not print invisible parts of
+the document (3). Or you can use the command `C-c C-e v' to export
+only the visible part of the document and print the resulting file.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) See also the variables `org-show-hierarchy-above',
+`org-show-following-heading', `org-show-siblings', and
+`org-show-entry-below' for detailed control on how much context is
+shown around each match.
+
+ (2) This depends on the option `org-remove-highlights-with-change'
+
+ (3) This does not work under XEmacs, because XEmacs uses selective
+display for outlining, not text properties.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Plain lists, Next: Drawers, Prev: Sparse trees, Up: Document Structure
+
+2.7 Plain lists
+===============
+
+Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
+additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of
+checkboxes (*note Checkboxes::). Org supports editing such lists, and
+every exporter (*note Exporting::) can parse and format them.
+
+ Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
+ * _Unordered_ list items start with `-', `+', or `*'(1) as bullets.
+
+ * _Ordered_ list items start with a numeral followed by either a
+ period or a right parenthesis(2), such as `1.' or `1)'. If you
+ want a list to start with a different value (e.g. 20), start the
+ text of the item with `[@20]'(3). Those constructs can be used in
+ any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering.
+
+ * _Description_ list items are unordered list items, and contain the
+ separator ` :: ' to separate the description _term_ from the
+ description.
+
+ Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on
+the first line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number
+`10.', then the 2-digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the
+other numbers in the list.
+
+ Two methods(4) are provided to terminate lists. A list ends before
+the next line that is indented like the bullet/number or less, or it
+ends before two blank lines(5). In both cases, all levels of the list
+are closed(6). For finer control, you can end lists with any pattern
+set in `org-list-end-regexp'. Here is an example:
+
+ ** Lord of the Rings
+ My favorite scenes are (in this order)
+ 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
+ 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
+ + this was already my favorite scene in the book
+ + I really like Miranda Otto.
+ 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
+ He makes a really funny face when it happens.
+ - on DVD only
+ But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
+ Important actors in this film are:
+ - Elijah Wood :: He plays Frodo
+ - Sean Austin :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
+ him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in The Goonies.
+
+ Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to
+deal with them correctly(7), and by exporting them properly (*note
+Exporting::). Since indentation is what governs the structure of these
+lists, many structural constructs like `#+BEGIN_...' blocks can be
+indented to signal that they should be considered as a list item.
+
+ If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that
+used for the current list-level) improves readability, customize the
+variable `org-list-demote-modify-bullet'.
+
+ The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first
+line of an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them
+imply the application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact.
+If some of these actions get in your way, configure
+`org-list-automatic-rules' to disable them individually.
+
+`<TAB>' (`org-cycle')
+ Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this
+ works only if the cursor is on a plain list item. For more
+ details, see the variable `org-cycle-include-plain-lists'. If
+ this variable is set to `integrate', plain list items will be
+ treated like low-level headlines. The level of an item is then
+ given by the indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always
+ subordinate to real headlines, however; the hierarchies remain
+ completely separated.
+
+`M-<RET>' (`org-insert-heading')
+ Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a
+ new heading (*note Structure editing::). If this command is used
+ in the middle of a line, the line is _split_ and the rest of the
+ line becomes the new item(8). If this command is executed _before
+ an item's body_, the new item is created _before_ the current
+ item. If the command is executed in the white space before the
+ text that is part of an item but does not contain the bullet, a
+ bullet is added to the current line.
+
+ As a new item cannot be inserted in a structural construct (like
+ an example or source code block) within a list, Org will instead
+ insert it right before the structure, or return an error.
+
+M-S-<RET>
+ Insert a new item with a checkbox (*note Checkboxes::).
+
+`<TAB>' (`org-cycle')
+ In a new item with no text yet, the first <TAB> demotes the item to
+ become a child of the previous one. Subsequent <TAB>s move the
+ item to meaningful levels in the list and eventually get it back
+ to its initial position.
+
+S-<up>
+S-<down>
+ Jump to the previous/next item in the current list, but only if
+ `org-support-shift-select' is off. If not, you can still use
+ paragraph jumping commands like `C-<up>' and `C-<down>' to quite
+ similar effect.
+
+M-S-<up>
+M-S-<down>
+ Move the item including subitems up/down (swap with previous/next
+ item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering is
+ automatic.
+
+M-<left>
+M-<right>
+ Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children
+ alone.
+
+M-S-<left>
+M-S-<right>
+ Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
+ Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation.
+ When these commands are executed several times in direct
+ succession, the initially selected region is used, even if the new
+ indentation would imply a different hierarchy. To use the new
+ hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor motion or so.
+
+ As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a
+ list will move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by
+ configuring `org-list-automatic-rules'. The global indentation of
+ a list has no influence on the text _after_ the list.
+
+C-c C-c
+ If there is a checkbox (*note Checkboxes::) in the item line,
+ toggle the state of the checkbox. Also, makes sure that all the
+ items on this list level use the same bullet and that the
+ numbering of list items (if applicable) is correct.
+
+C-c -
+ Cycle the entire list level through the different
+ itemize/enumerate bullets (`-', `+', `*', `1.', `1)') or a subset
+ of them, depending on `org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator',
+ the type of list, and its position(9). With a numeric prefix
+ argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an
+ active region when calling this, all lines will be converted to
+ list items. If the first line already was a list item, any item
+ markers will be removed from the list. Finally, even without an
+ active region, a normal line will be converted into a list item.
+
+C-c *
+ Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
+ subheading at its location). *Note Structure editing::, for a
+ detailed explanation.
+
+S-<left>/<right>
+ This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the
+ bullet or anywhere in an item line, details depending on
+ `org-support-shift-select'.
+
+C-c ^
+ Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
+ numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) When using `*' as a bullet, lines must be indented or they will
+be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
+stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a
+star are visually indistinguishable from true headlines. In short:
+even though `*' is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain
+list items.
+
+ (2) You can filter out any of them by configuring
+`org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator'.
+
+ (3) If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie must be put
+_before_ the checkbox.
+
+ (4) To disable either of them, configure `org-list-ending-method'.
+
+ (5) See also `org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists'.
+
+ (6) So you cannot have a sublist, some text and then another sublist
+while still in the same top-level list item. This used to be possible,
+but it was only supported in the HTML exporter and difficult to manage
+with automatic indentation.
+
+ (7) Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For XEmacs,
+you should use Kyle E. Jones' `filladapt.el'. To turn this on, put
+into `.emacs': `(require 'filladapt)'
+
+ (8) If you do not want the line to be split, customize the variable
+`org-M-RET-may-split-line'.
+
+ (9) See `bullet' rule in `org-list-automatic-rules' for more
+information.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Drawers, Next: Blocks, Prev: Plain lists, Up: Document Structure
+
+2.8 Drawers
+===========
+
+Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
+normally don't want to see it. For this, Org-mode has _drawers_.
+Drawers need to be configured with the variable `org-drawers'(1).
+Drawers look like this:
+
+ ** This is a headline
+ Still outside the drawer
+ :DRAWERNAME:
+ This is inside the drawer.
+ :END:
+ After the drawer.
+
+ Visibility cycling (*note Visibility cycling::) on the headline will
+hide and show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single
+line. In order to look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor
+to the drawer line and press <TAB> there. Org-mode uses the
+`PROPERTIES' drawer for storing properties (*note Properties and
+Columns::), and you can also arrange for state change notes (*note
+Tracking TODO state changes::) and clock times (*note Clocking work
+time::) to be stored in a drawer `LOGBOOK'. If you want to store a
+quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
+
+`C-c C-z'
+ Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) You can define drawers on a per-file basis with a line like
+`#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN PROPERTIES STATE'
+
+
+File: org, Node: Blocks, Next: Footnotes, Prev: Drawers, Up: Document Structure
+
+2.9 Blocks
+==========
+
+Org-mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including
+source code examples (*note Literal examples::) to capturing time
+logging information (*note Clocking work time::). These blocks can be
+folded and unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also
+get all blocks folded at startup by configuring the variable
+`org-hide-block-startup' or on a per-file basis by using
+
+ #+STARTUP: hideblocks
+ #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
+
+
+File: org, Node: Footnotes, Next: Orgstruct mode, Prev: Blocks, Up: Document Structure
+
+2.10 Footnotes
+==============
+
+Org-mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
+`footnote.el' package, Org-mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
+larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
+syntax is similar to the one used by `footnote.el', i.e. a footnote is
+defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
+brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph
+break inside a footnote, use the LaTeX idiom `\par'. The footnote
+reference is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For
+example:
+
+ The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
+ ...
+ [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
+
+ Org-mode extends the number-based syntax to _named_ footnotes and
+optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
+`footnote.el' does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
+encouraged because of possible conflicts with LaTeX snippets (*note
+Embedded LaTeX::). Here are the valid references:
+
+`[1]'
+ A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with `footnote.el',
+ but not recommended because something like `[1]' could easily be
+ part of a code snippet.
+
+`[fn:name]'
+ A named footnote reference, where `name' is a unique label word,
+ or, for simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
+
+`[fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]'
+ A LaTeX-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given
+ directly at the reference point.
+
+`[fn:name: a definition]'
+ An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name
+ for the note. Since Org allows multiple references to the same
+ note, you can then use `[fn:name]' to create additional references.
+
+ Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create
+names yourself. This is handled by the variable
+`org-footnote-auto-label' and its corresponding `#+STARTUP' keywords.
+See the docstring of that variable for details.
+
+The following command handles footnotes:
+
+`C-c C-x f'
+ The footnote action command.
+
+ When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the
+ definition. When it is at a definition, jump to the (first)
+ reference.
+
+ Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
+ `org-footnote-define-inline'(1), the definition will be placed
+ right into the text as part of the reference, or separately into
+ the location determined by the variable `org-footnote-section'.
+
+ When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of
+ additional options is offered:
+ s Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,
+ Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular
+ sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will
+ also move entries according to `org-footnote-section'. Automatic
+ sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the
+ variable `org-footnote-auto-adjust'.
+ r Renumber the simple `fn:N' footnotes. Automatic renumbering
+ after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable
+ `org-footnote-auto-adjust'.
+ S Short for first `r', then `s' action.
+ n Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including
+ inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them
+ in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is
+ meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g. sending
+ off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could
+ something like `message-send-hook'.
+ d Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references
+ to it.
+ Depending on the variable `org-footnote-auto-adjust'(2),
+ renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each
+ insertion or deletion.
+
+`C-c C-c'
+ If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition.
+ If it is a the definition, jump back to the reference. When
+ called at a footnote location with a prefix argument, offer the
+ same menu as `C-c C-x f'.
+
+`C-c C-o or mouse-1/2'
+ Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding
+ definition/reference, and you can use the usual commands to follow
+ these links.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) The corresponding in-buffer setting is: `#+STARTUP: fninline' or
+`#+STARTUP: nofninline'
+
+ (2) the corresponding in-buffer options are `fnadjust' and
+`nofnadjust'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Orgstruct mode, Prev: Footnotes, Up: Document Structure
+
+2.11 The Orgstruct minor mode
+=============================
+
+If you like the intuitive way the Org-mode structure editing and list
+formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes
+like Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode `orgstruct-mode'
+makes this possible. Toggle the mode with `M-x orgstruct-mode', or
+turn it on by default, for example in Mail mode, with one of:
+
+ (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
+ (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
+
+ When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to
+Org like a headline or the first line of a list item, most structure
+editing commands will work, even if the same keys normally have
+different functionality in the major mode you are using. If the cursor
+is not in one of those special lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in
+the shadows. When you use `orgstruct++-mode', Org will also export
+indentation and autofill settings into that mode, and detect item
+context after the first line of an item.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Tables, Next: Hyperlinks, Prev: Document Structure, Up: Top
+
+3 Tables
+********
+
+Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
+calculations are supported using the Emacs `calc' package (*note Calc:
+(Calc)Top.).
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
+* Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
+* Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
+* Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
+* The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
+* Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
+
+
+File: org, Node: Built-in table editor, Next: Column width and alignment, Prev: Tables, Up: Tables
+
+3.1 The built-in table editor
+=============================
+
+Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with `|'
+as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table.
+`|' is also the column separator. A table might look like this:
+
+ | Name | Phone | Age |
+ |-------+-------+-----|
+ | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
+ | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
+
+ A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press <TAB> or
+<RET> or `C-c C-c' inside the table. <TAB> also moves to the next
+field (<RET> to the next row) and creates new table rows at the end of
+the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation of the table is
+set by the first line. Any line starting with `|-' is considered as a
+horizontal separator line and will be expanded on the next re-align to
+span the whole table width. So, to create the above table, you would
+only type
+
+ |Name|Phone|Age|
+ |-
+
+and then press <TAB> to align the table and start filling in fields.
+Even faster would be to type `|Name|Phone|Age' followed by `C-c <RET>'.
+
+ When typing text into a field, Org treats <DEL>, <Backspace>, and
+all character keys in a special way, so that inserting and deleting
+avoids shifting other fields. Also, when typing _immediately after the
+cursor was moved into a new field with `<TAB>', `S-<TAB>' or `<RET>'_,
+the field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
+unpredictable for you, configure the variables
+`org-enable-table-editor' and `org-table-auto-blank-field'.
+
+Creation and conversion
+.......................
+
+`C-c | (`org-table-create-or-convert-from-region')'
+ Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at
+ least one TAB character, the function assumes that the material is
+ tab separated. If every line contains a comma, comma-separated
+ values (CSV) are assumed. If not, lines are split at whitespace
+ into fields. You can use a prefix argument to force a specific
+ separator: `C-u' forces CSV, `C-u C-u' forces TAB, and a numeric
+ argument N indicates that at least N consecutive spaces, or
+ alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
+ If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
+ table. But it's easier just to start typing, like
+ `|Name|Phone|Age <RET> |- <TAB>'.
+
+Re-aligning and field motion
+............................
+
+`C-c C-c (`org-table-align')'
+ Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
+
+`<TAB> (`org-table-next-field')'
+ Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
+ necessary.
+
+`S-<TAB> (`org-table-previous-field')'
+ Re-align, move to previous field.
+
+`<RET> (`org-table-next-row')'
+ Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
+ necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, <RET> still does
+ NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
+
+`M-a (`org-table-beginning-of-field')'
+ Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the
+ previous field.
+
+`M-e (`org-table-end-of-field')'
+ Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
+
+Column and row editing
+......................
+
+`M-<left> (`org-table-move-column-left')'
+`M-<right> (`org-table-move-column-right')'
+ Move the current column left/right.
+
+`M-S-<left> (`org-table-delete-column')'
+ Kill the current column.
+
+`M-S-<right> (`org-table-insert-column')'
+ Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
+
+`M-<up> (`org-table-move-row-up')'
+`M-<down> (`org-table-move-row-down')'
+ Move the current row up/down.
+
+`M-S-<up> (`org-table-kill-row')'
+ Kill the current row or horizontal line.
+
+`M-S-<down> (`org-table-insert-row')'
+ Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument,
+ the line is created below the current one.
+
+`C-c - (`org-table-insert-hline')'
+ Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix
+ argument, the line is created above the current line.
+
+`C-c <RET> (`org-table-hline-and-move')'
+ Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor
+ into the row below that line.
+
+`C-c ^ (`org-table-sort-lines')'
+ Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point
+ indicates the column to be used for sorting, and the range of
+ lines is the range between the nearest horizontal separator lines,
+ or the entire table. If point is before the first column, you
+ will be prompted for the sorting column. If there is an active
+ region, the mark specifies the first line and the sorting column,
+ while point should be in the last line to be included into the
+ sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
+ (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a
+ prefix argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
+
+Regions
+.......
+
+`C-c C-x M-w (`org-table-copy-region')'
+ Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard.
+ Point and mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there
+ is no active region, copy just the current field. The process
+ ignores horizontal separator lines.
+
+`C-c C-x C-w (`org-table-cut-region')'
+ Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
+ blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the "cut" operation.
+
+`C-c C-x C-y (`org-table-paste-rectangle')'
+ Paste a rectangular region into a table. The upper left corner
+ ends up in the current field. All involved fields will be
+ overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
+ the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal
+ separator lines.
+
+`M-<RET> (`org-table-wrap-region')'
+ Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest
+ to the line below. If there is an active region, and both point
+ and mark are in the same column, the text in the column is wrapped
+ to minimum width for the given number of lines. A numeric prefix
+ argument may be used to change the number of desired lines. If
+ there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument, the current
+ field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
+ above.
+
+Calculations
+............
+
+`C-c + (`org-table-sum')'
+ Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined
+ by the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
+ be inserted with `C-y'.
+
+`S-<RET> (`org-table-copy-down')'
+ When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field
+ above. When not empty, copy current field down to next row and
+ move cursor along with it. Depending on the variable
+ `org-table-copy-increment', integer field values will be
+ incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not be
+ incremented. Also, a `0' prefix argument temporarily disables the
+ increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related
+ modes (*note Conflicts::).
+
+Miscellaneous
+.............
+
+`C-c ` (`org-table-edit-field')'
+ Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for
+ fields that are not fully visible (*note Column width and
+ alignment::). When called with a `C-u' prefix, just make the full
+ field visible, so that it can be edited in place.
+
+`M-x org-table-import'
+ Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
+ separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
+ from a database, because these programs generally can write
+ TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the
+ file into the buffer and then converting the region to a table.
+ Any prefix argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it
+ to determine the separator.
+
+`C-c | (`org-table-create-or-convert-from-region')'
+ Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
+ buffer, selecting the pasted text with `C-x C-x' and then using the
+ `C-c |' command (see above under Creation and conversion).
+
+`M-x org-table-export'
+ Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
+ exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The
+ format used to export the file can be configured in the variable
+ `org-table-export-default-format'. You may also use properties
+ `TABLE_EXPORT_FILE' and `TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT' to specify the file
+ name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports
+ quite general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is
+ the same as the format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see *Note
+ Translator functions::, for a detailed description.
+
+ If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
+way on lines which you would like to start with `|', you can turn it
+off with
+
+ (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
+
+Then the only table command that still works is `C-c C-c' to do a
+manual re-align.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Column width and alignment, Next: Column groups, Prev: Built-in table editor, Up: Tables
+
+3.2 Column width and alignment
+==============================
+
+The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor.
+And also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the
+fraction of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
+
+ Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text,
+leading to inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a
+table with several columns having a fixed width, regardless of content.
+To set(1) the width of a column, one field anywhere in the column may
+contain just the string `<N>' where `N' is an integer specifying the
+width of the column in characters. The next re-align will then set the
+width of this column to this value.
+
+ |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
+ | | | | | <6> |
+ | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
+ | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
+ | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
+ | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
+ |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
+
+Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string `=>'. Note
+that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden. To see the
+full text, hold the mouse over the field--a tool-tip window will show
+the full content. To edit such a field, use the command `C-c `' (that
+is `C-c' followed by the backquote). This will open a new window with
+the full field. Edit it and finish with `C-c C-c'.
+
+ When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
+necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
+be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
+`org-startup-align-all-tables' will realign all tables in a file upon
+visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option on
+a per-file basis with:
+
+ #+STARTUP: align
+ #+STARTUP: noalign
+
+ If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich
+columns to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use
+`<r>', `c'(2) or `<l>' in a similar fashion. You may also combine
+alignment and field width like this: `<l10>'.
+
+ Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
+automatically when exporting the document.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) This feature does not work on XEmacs.
+
+ (2) Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an effect
+when exporting to HTML.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Column groups, Next: Orgtbl mode, Prev: Column width and alignment, Up: Tables
+
+3.3 Column groups
+=================
+
+When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical lines
+because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
+however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
+of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
+order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
+first field contains only `/'. The further fields can either contain
+`<' to indicate that this column should start a group, `>' to indicate
+the end of a column, or `<>' to make a column a group of its own.
+Boundaries between column groups will upon export be marked with
+vertical lines. Here is an example:
+
+ | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
+ |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
+ | / | < | | > | < | > |
+ | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
+ | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
+ | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
+ |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
+ #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
+
+ It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
+every vertical line you would like to have:
+
+ | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
+ |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
+ | / | < | | | < | |
+
+
+File: org, Node: Orgtbl mode, Next: The spreadsheet, Prev: Column groups, Up: Tables
+
+3.4 The Orgtbl minor mode
+=========================
+
+If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you might
+also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode. The
+minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle the
+mode with `M-x orgtbl-mode'. To turn it on by default, for example in
+mail mode, use
+
+ (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
+
+ Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain
+tables in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is
+possible to construct LaTeX tables with the underlying ease and power of
+Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
+*Note Tables in arbitrary syntax::.
+
+
+File: org, Node: The spreadsheet, Next: Org-Plot, Prev: Orgtbl mode, Up: Tables
+
+3.5 The spreadsheet
+===================
+
+The table editor makes use of the Emacs `calc' package to implement
+spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
+derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's
+implementation is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example,
+Org knows the concept of a _column formula_ that will be applied to all
+non-header fields in a column without having to copy the formula to
+each relevant field. There is also a formula debugger, and a formula
+editor with features for highlighting fields in the table corresponding
+to the references at the point in the formula, moving these references
+by arrow keys
+
+* Menu:
+
+* References:: How to refer to another field or range
+* Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
+* Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
+* Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
+* Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
+* Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
+* Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
+* Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
+
+
+File: org, Node: References, Next: Formula syntax for Calc, Prev: The spreadsheet, Up: The spreadsheet
+
+3.5.1 References
+----------------
+
+To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
+reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced by
+name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
+out what the coordinates of a field are, press `C-c ?' in that field,
+or press `C-c }' to toggle the display of a grid.
+
+Field references
+................
+
+Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
+any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
+combination like `B3', meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
+
+Org also uses another, more general operator that looks like this:
+ @ROW$COLUMN
+
+Column references can be absolute like `1', `2',...`N', or relative to
+the current column like `+1' or `-2'.
+
+ The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal
+separator lines (hlines). You can use absolute row numbers `1'...`N',
+and row numbers relative to the current row like `+3' or `-1'. Or
+specify the row relative to one of the hlines: `I' refers to the first
+hline(1), `II' to the second, etc. `-I' refers to the first such line
+above the current line, `+I' to the first such line below the current
+line. You can also write `III+2' which is the second data line after
+the third hline in the table.
+
+ `0' refers to the current row and column. Also, if you omit either
+the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is
+implied.
+
+ Org's references with _unsigned_ numbers are fixed references in the
+sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
+different fields, the same field will be referenced each time. Org's
+references with _signed_ numbers are floating references because the
+same reference operator can reference different fields depending on the
+field being calculated by the formula.
+
+ As a special case, references like `$LR5' and `$LR12' can be used to
+refer in a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the
+table.
+
+ Here are a few examples:
+
+ @2$3 2nd row, 3rd column
+ C2 same as previous
+ $5 column 5 in the current row
+ E& same as previous
+ @2 current column, row 2
+ @-1$-3 the field one row up, three columns to the left
+ @-I$2 field just under hline above current row, column 2
+
+Range references
+................
+
+You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
+references connected by two dots `..'. If both fields are in the
+current row, you may simply use `$2..$7', but if at least one field is
+in a different row, you need to use the general `@row$column' format at
+least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with `@' in
+order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
+
+ $1..$3 First three fields in the current row.
+ $P..$Q Range, using column names (see under Advanced)
+ @2$1..@4$3 6 fields between these two fields.
+ A2..C4 Same as above.
+ @-1$-2..@-1 3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row
+
+Range references return a vector of values that can be fed into Calc
+vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally suppressed, so
+that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but see the `E'
+mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields, `[0]' is
+returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
+
+Field coordinates in formulas
+.............................
+
+For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas `@#' and `$#' can be used to get
+the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
+The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are `org-table-current-dline'
+and `org-table-current-column'. Examples:
+
+ if(@# % 2, $#, string("")) column number on odd lines only
+ $3 = remote(FOO, @@#$2) copy column 2 from table FOO into
+ column 3 of the current table
+
+For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows as
+the current table. Inefficient(2) for large number of rows.
+
+Named references
+................
+
+`$name' is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or constant.
+Constants are defined globally through the variable
+`org-table-formula-constants', and locally (for the file) through a
+line like
+
+ #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
+
+Also properties (*note Properties and Columns::) can be used as
+constants in table formulas: for a property `:Xyz:' use the name
+`$PROP_Xyz', and the property will be searched in the current outline
+entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the `constants.el'
+package, it will also be used to resolve constants, including natural
+constants like `$h' for Planck's constant, and units like `$km' for
+kilometers(3). Column names and parameters can be specified in special
+table lines. These are described below, see *Note Advanced features::.
+All names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
+numbers.
+
+Remote references
+.................
+
+You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different
+table, either in the current file or even in a different file. The
+syntax is
+
+ remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
+
+where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
+`#+TBLNAME: NAME' line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
+entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the
+first table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference
+as described above for example `@3$3' or `$somename', valid in the
+referenced table.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Note that only hlines are counted that _separate_ table lines.
+If the table starts with a hline above the header, it does not count.
+
+ (2) The computation time scales as O(N^2) because table FOO is
+parsed for each field to be copied.
+
+ (3) `constants.el' can supply the values of constants in two
+different unit systems, `SI' and `cgs'. Which one is used depends on
+the value of the variable `constants-unit-system'. You can use the
+`#+STARTUP' options `constSI' and `constcgs' to set this value for the
+current buffer.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Formula syntax for Calc, Next: Formula syntax for Lisp, Prev: References, Up: The spreadsheet
+
+3.5.2 Formula syntax for Calc
+-----------------------------
+
+A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
+`Calc' package. Note that `calc' has the non-standard convention that
+`/' has lower precedence than `*', so that `a/b*c' is interpreted as
+`a/(b*c)'. Before evaluation by `calc-eval' (*note calc-eval:
+(Calc)Calling Calc from Your Programs.), variable substitution takes
+place according to the rules described above. The range vectors can be
+directly fed into the Calc vector functions like `vmean' and `vsum'.
+
+ A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon.
+This string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
+execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision 12,
+angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
+format, however, has been changed to `(float 8)' to keep tables
+compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
+`org-calc-default-modes'.
+
+ p20 set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits
+ n3 s3 e2 f4 Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed
+ format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.
+ Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as
+ long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.
+ D R angle modes: degrees, radians
+ F S fraction and symbolic modes
+ N interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers
+ T force text interpretation
+ E keep empty fields in ranges
+ L literal
+
+Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation and
+-display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
+`printf' format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
+passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the formatting(1).
+A few examples:
+
+ $1+$2 Sum of first and second field
+ $1+$2;%.2f Same, format result to two decimals
+ exp($2)+exp($1) Math functions can be used
+ $0;%.1f Reformat current cell to 1 decimal
+ ($3-32)*5/9 Degrees F -> C conversion
+ $c/$1/$cm Hz -> cm conversion, using `constants.el'
+ tan($1);Dp3s1 Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1
+ sin($1);Dp3%.1e Same, but use printf specifier for display
+ vmean($2..$7) Compute column range mean, using vector function
+ vmean($2..$7);EN Same, but treat empty fields as 0
+ taylor($3,x=7,2) Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree
+
+ Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
+
+ if($1<20,teen,string("")) "teen" if age $1 less than 20, else empty
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) The `printf' reformatting is limited in precision because the
+value passed to it is converted into an `integer' or `double'. The
+`integer' is limited in size by truncating the signed value to 32 bits.
+The `double' is limited in precision to 64 bits overall which leaves
+approximately 16 significant decimal digits.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Formula syntax for Lisp, Next: Field formulas, Prev: Formula syntax for Calc, Up: The spreadsheet
+
+3.5.3 Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
+----------------------------------
+
+It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be
+useful for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's
+functionality is not enough. If a formula starts with a single-quote
+followed by an opening parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp
+form. The evaluation should return either a string or a number. Just
+as with `calc' formulas, you can specify modes and a printf format
+after a semicolon. With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious
+about the way field references are interpolated into the form. By
+default, a reference will be interpolated as a Lisp string (in
+double-quotes) containing the field. If you provide the `N' mode
+switch, all referenced elements will be numbers (non-number fields will
+be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If you
+provide the `L' flag, all fields will be interpolated literally,
+without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a
+string by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in
+double-quotes, like `"$3"'. Ranges are inserted as space-separated
+fields, so you can +embed them in list or vector syntax. Here are a
+few examples--note how the `N' mode is used when we do computations in
+Lisp:
+
+ Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1
+ '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
+ Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's `$1+$2'
+ '(+ $1 $2);N
+ Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's `vsum($1..$4)'
+ '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
+
+
+File: org, Node: Field formulas, Next: Column formulas, Prev: Formula syntax for Lisp, Up: The spreadsheet
+
+3.5.4 Field formulas
+--------------------
+
+To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the
+field, preceded by `:=', for example `:=$1+$2'. When you press <TAB>
+or <RET> or `C-c C-c' with the cursor still in the field, the formula
+will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the
+current field replaced with the result.
+
+ Formulas are stored in a special line starting with `#+TBLFM:'
+directly below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of
+the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like
+`@3$4=$1+$2'. When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows with
+the appropriate commands, absolute references (but not relative ones)
+in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the same
+field. Of course this is not true if you edit the table structure with
+normal editing commands--then you must fix the equations yourself. The
+left-hand side of a formula may also be a named field (*note Advanced
+features::), or a last-row reference like `$LR3'.
+
+ Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
+following command
+
+`C-u C-c = (`org-table-eval-formula')'
+ Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts
+ for a formula with default taken from the `#+TBLFM:' line, applies
+ it to the current field, and stores it.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Column formulas, Next: Editing and debugging formulas, Prev: Field formulas, Up: The spreadsheet
+
+3.5.5 Column formulas
+---------------------
+
+Often in a table, the same formula should be used for all fields in a
+particular column. Instead of having to copy the formula to all fields
+in that column, Org allows you to assign a single formula to an entire
+column. If the table contains horizontal separator hlines, everything
+before the first such line is considered part of the table _header_ and
+will not be modified by column formulas.
+
+ To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in
+the column, preceded by an equal sign, like `=$1+$2'. When you press
+<TAB> or <RET> or `C-c C-c' with the cursor still in the field, the
+formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
+and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains
+only `=', the previously stored formula for this column is used. For
+each column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In
+the `#+TBLFM:' line, column formulas will look like `$4=$1+$2'. The
+left-hand side of a column formula cannot currently be the name of
+column, it must be the numeric column reference.
+
+ Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
+following command:
+
+`C-c = (`org-table-eval-formula')'
+ Install a new formula for the current column and replace current
+ field with the result of the formula. The command prompts for a
+ formula, with default taken from the `#+TBLFM' line, applies it to
+ the current field and stores it. With a numeric prefix
+ argument(e.g. `C-5 C-c =') the command will apply it to that many
+ consecutive fields in the current column.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Editing and debugging formulas, Next: Updating the table, Prev: Column formulas, Up: The spreadsheet
+
+3.5.6 Editing and debugging formulas
+------------------------------------
+
+You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
+field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active formulas
+of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org converts
+references to the standard format (like `B3' or `D&') if possible. If
+you prefer to only work with the internal format (like `@3$2' or `$4'),
+configure the variable `org-table-use-standard-references'.
+
+`C-c = or C-u C-c = (`org-table-eval-formula')'
+ Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
+ minibuffer. See *Note Column formulas::, and *Note Field
+ formulas::.
+
+`C-u C-u C-c = (`org-table-eval-formula')'
+ Re-insert the active formula (either a field formula, or a column
+ formula) into the current field, so that you can edit it directly
+ in the field. The advantage over editing in the minibuffer is
+ that you can use the command `C-c ?'.
+
+`C-c ? (`org-table-field-info')'
+ While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
+ referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
+
+`C-c }'
+ Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using
+ overlays (`org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays'). These are
+ updated each time the table is aligned; you can force it with `C-c
+ C-c'.
+
+`C-c {'
+ Toggle the formula debugger on and off
+ (`org-table-toggle-formula-debugger'). See below.
+
+`C-c ' (`org-table-edit-formulas')'
+ Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where
+ the formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field
+ has an active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark
+ it. While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically
+ highlight any field or range reference at the cursor position.
+ You may edit, remove and add formulas, and use the following
+ commands:
+ `C-c C-c or C-x C-s (`org-table-fedit-finish')'
+ Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas.
+ With `C-u' prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire
+ table.
+
+ `C-c C-q (`org-table-fedit-abort')'
+ Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
+
+ `C-c C-r (`org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type')'
+ Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard
+ (like `B3') and internal (like `@3$2').
+
+ `<TAB> (`org-table-fedit-lisp-indent')'
+ Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line
+ containing a Lisp formula, format the formula according to
+ Emacs Lisp rules. Another <TAB> collapses the formula back
+ again. In the open formula, <TAB> re-indents just like in
+ Emacs Lisp mode.
+
+ `M-<TAB> (`lisp-complete-symbol')'
+ Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
+
+ `S-<up>/<down>/<left>/<right>'
+ Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference
+ is `B3' and you press `S-<right>', it will become `C3'. This
+ also works for relative references and for hline references.
+
+ `M-S-<up> (`org-table-fedit-line-up')'
+ `M-S-<down> (`org-table-fedit-line-down')'
+ Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up
+ and down.
+
+ `M-<up> (`org-table-fedit-scroll-down')'
+ `M-<down> (`org-table-fedit-scroll-up')'
+ Scroll the window displaying the table.
+
+ `C-c }'
+ Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
+
+ Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated
+with the field, because that is stored in a different line (the
+`#+TBLFM' line)--during the next recalculation the field will be filled
+again. To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty
+reply when prompted for the formula, or to edit the `#+TBLFM' line.
+
+ You may edit the `#+TBLFM' directly and re-apply the changed
+equations with `C-c C-c' in that line or with the normal recalculation
+commands in the table.
+
+Debugging formulas
+..................
+
+When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
+becomes the string `#ERROR'. If you would like see what is going on
+during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
+turn on formula debugging in the `Tbl' menu and repeat the calculation,
+for example by pressing `C-u C-u C-c = <RET>' in a field. Detailed
+information will be displayed.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Updating the table, Next: Advanced features, Prev: Editing and debugging formulas, Up: The spreadsheet
+
+3.5.7 Updating the table
+------------------------
+
+Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
+triggered by a command. See *Note Advanced features::, for a way to
+make recalculation at least semi-automatic.
+
+ In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use
+the following commands:
+
+`C-c * (`org-table-recalculate')'
+ Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column
+ formulas from left to right, and all field formulas in the current
+ row.
+
+`C-u C-c *'
+`C-u C-c C-c'
+ Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the
+ first hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the
+ table header.
+
+`C-u C-u C-c * or C-u C-u C-c C-c (`org-table-iterate')'
+ Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
+ This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of
+ other fields that are computed later in the calculation sequence.
+
+`M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables'
+ Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
+
+`M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables'
+ Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge
+ table-to-table dependencies.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Advanced features, Prev: Updating the table, Up: The spreadsheet
+
+3.5.8 Advanced features
+-----------------------
+
+If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if
+you want to be able to assign names to fields and columns, you need to
+reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters.
+`C-# (`org-table-rotate-recalc-marks')'
+ Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states ` ',
+ `#', `*', `!', `$'. When there is an active region, change all
+ marks in the region.
+
+ Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students
+and makes use of these features:
+
+ |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
+ | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
+ |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
+ | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
+ | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
+ | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
+ |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
+ | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
+ | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
+ |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
+ | | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
+ | ^ | | | | | at | |
+ | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
+ |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
+ #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@-II..@-I);%.1f
+
+Important: please note that for these special tables, recalculating the
+table with `C-u C-c *' will only affect rows that are marked `#' or
+`*', and fields that have a formula assigned to the field itself. The
+column formulas are not applied in rows with empty first field.
+
+ The marking characters have the following meaning:
+`!'
+ The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you
+ may refer to a column as `$Tot' instead of `$6'.
+
+`^'
+ This row defines names for the fields _above_ the row. With such
+ a definition, any formula in the table may use `$m1' to refer to
+ the value `10'. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
+ will be stored as `$name=...'.
+
+`_'
+ Similar to `^', but defines names for the fields in the row
+ _below_.
+
+`$'
+ Fields in this row can define _parameters_ for formulas. For
+ example, if a field in a `$' row contains `max=50', then formulas
+ in this table can refer to the value 50 using `$max'. Parameters
+ work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on a
+ per-table basis.
+
+`#'
+ Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
+ <TAB> or <RET> or `S-<TAB>' in this row. Also, this row is
+ selected for a global recalculation with `C-u C-c *'. Unmarked
+ lines will be left alone by this command.
+
+`*'
+ Selects this line for global recalculation with `C-u C-c *', but
+ not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
+ recalculation slows down editing too much.
+
+`'
+ Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with `C-u C-c *'.
+ All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with `#' or
+ `*'.
+
+`/'
+ Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the
+ narrowing `<N>' markers or column group markers.
+
+ Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
+fantastic `calc.el' package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
+series of degree `n' at location `x' for a couple of functions.
+
+ |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
+ | | Func | n | x | Result |
+ |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
+ | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
+ | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
+ | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
+ | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
+ | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
+ | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
+ |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
+ #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
+
+
+File: org, Node: Org-Plot, Prev: The spreadsheet, Up: Tables
+
+3.6 Org-Plot
+============
+
+Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org
+tables using `Gnuplot' `http://www.gnuplot.info/' and `gnuplot-mode'
+`http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html'. To see
+this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode
+installed on your system, then call `org-plot/gnuplot' on the following
+table.
+
+ #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
+ | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
+ |-----------+-----------+---------|
+ | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
+ | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
+ | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
+ | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
+ | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
+
+ Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as
+labels. Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance
+of plots can be exercised through the `#+PLOT:' lines preceding a
+table. See below for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more
+information and examples see the Org-plot tutorial at
+`http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.php'.
+
+Plot Options
+............
+
+`set'
+ Specify any `gnuplot' option to be set when graphing.
+
+`title'
+ Specify the title of the plot.
+
+`ind'
+ Specify which column of the table to use as the `x' axis.
+
+`deps'
+ Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by
+ parentheses and separated by spaces for example `dep:(3 4)' to
+ graph the third and fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other
+ columns aside from the `ind' column).
+
+`type'
+ Specify whether the plot will be `2d', `3d', or `grid'.
+
+`with'
+ Specify a `with' option to be inserted for every col being plotted
+ (e.g. `lines', `points', `boxes', `impulses', etc...). Defaults
+ to `lines'.
+
+`file'
+ If you want to plot to a file, specify
+ `"PATH/TO/DESIRED/OUTPUT-FILE"'.
+
+`labels'
+ List of labels to be used for the `deps' (defaults to the column
+ headers if they exist).
+
+`line'
+ Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
+
+`map'
+ When plotting `3d' or `grid' types, set this to `t' to graph a
+ flat mapping rather than a `3d' slope.
+
+`timefmt'
+ Specify format of Org-mode timestamps as they will be parsed by
+ Gnuplot. Defaults to `%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S'.
+
+`script'
+ If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place
+ the file name between double-quotes) which will be used to plot.
+ Before plotting, every instance of `$datafile' in the specified
+ script will be replaced with the path to the generated data file.
+ Note: even if you set this option, you may still want to specify
+ the plot type, as that can impact the content of the data file.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Hyperlinks, Next: TODO Items, Prev: Tables, Up: Top
+
+4 Hyperlinks
+************
+
+Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to other
+files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
+* Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
+* External links:: URL-like links to the world
+* Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
+* Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
+* Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
+* Search options:: Linking to a specific location
+* Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
+
+
+File: org, Node: Link format, Next: Internal links, Prev: Hyperlinks, Up: Hyperlinks
+
+4.1 Link format
+===============
+
+Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as clickable
+links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
+
+ [[link][description]] or alternatively [[link]]
+
+Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org will
+change the display so that `description' is displayed instead of
+`[[link][description]]' and `link' is displayed instead of `[[link]]'.
+Links will be highlighted in the face `org-link', which by default is
+an underlined face. You can directly edit the visible part of a link.
+Note that this can be either the `link' part (if there is no
+description) or the `description' part. To edit also the invisible
+`link' part, use `C-c C-l' with the cursor on the link.
+
+ If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of
+the displayed text and press <BACKSPACE>, you will remove the
+(invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
+and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
+missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the internal
+structure of all links, use the menu entry `Org->Hyperlinks->Literal
+links'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Internal links, Next: External links, Prev: Link format, Up: Hyperlinks
+
+4.2 Internal links
+==================
+
+If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal
+in the current file. The most important case is a link like
+`[[#my-custom-id]]' which will link to the entry with the `CUSTOM_ID'
+property `my-custom-id'. Such custom IDs are very good for HTML export
+(*note HTML export::) where they produce pretty section links. You are
+responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique in a file.
+
+ Links such as `[[My Target]]' or `[[My Target][Find my target]]'
+lead to a text search in the current file.
+
+ The link can be followed with `C-c C-o' when the cursor is on the
+link, or with a mouse click (*note Handling links::). Links to custom
+IDs will point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for
+a text link is a dedicated target: the same string in double angular
+brackets. Targets may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient
+to put them into a comment line. For example
+
+ # <<My Target>>
+
+In HTML export (*note HTML export::), such targets will become named
+anchors for direct access through `http' links(1).
+
+ If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that
+is exactly the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and
+tags(2). In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
+link text. In the above example the search would be for `my target'.
+
+ Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
+return to the previous position with `C-c &'. Using this command
+several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
+earlier.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Note that text before the first headline is usually not
+exported, so the first such target should be after the first headline,
+or in the line directly before the first headline.
+
+ (2) To insert a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can
+be used. Just type a star followed by a few optional letters into the
+buffer and press `M-<TAB>'. All headlines in the current buffer will
+be offered as completions.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Radio targets, Prev: Internal links, Up: Internal links
+
+4.2.1 Radio targets
+-------------------
+
+Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names in
+normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
+text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
+enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target `<<<My
+Target>>>' causes each occurrence of `my target' in normal text to
+become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically for
+radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To update
+the target list during editing, press `C-c C-c' with the cursor on or
+at a target.
+
+
+File: org, Node: External links, Next: Handling links, Prev: Internal links, Up: Hyperlinks
+
+4.3 External links
+==================
+
+Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages, BBDB
+database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their logs.
+External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
+identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
+the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
+
+ http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik on the web
+ doi:10.1000/182 DOI for an electronic resource
+ file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg file, absolute path
+ /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg same as above
+ file:papers/last.pdf file, relative path
+ ./papers/last.pdf same as above
+ file:/myself@some.where:papers/last.pdf file, path on remote machine
+ /myself@some.where:papers/last.pdf same as above
+ file:sometextfile::NNN file with line number to jump to
+ file:projects.org another Org file
+ file:projects.org::some words text search in Org file
+ file:projects.org::*task title heading search in Org file
+ docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN open file in doc-view mode at page NNN
+ id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 Link to heading by ID
+ news:comp.emacs Usenet link
+ mailto:adent@galaxy.net Mail link
+ vm:folder VM folder link
+ vm:folder#id VM message link
+ vm://myself@some.where.org/folder#id VM on remote machine
+ wl:folder WANDERLUST folder link
+ wl:folder#id WANDERLUST message link
+ mhe:folder MH-E folder link
+ mhe:folder#id MH-E message link
+ rmail:folder RMAIL folder link
+ rmail:folder#id RMAIL message link
+ gnus:group Gnus group link
+ gnus:group#id Gnus article link
+ bbdb:R.*Stallman BBDB link (with regexp)
+ irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob IRC link
+ info:org:External%20links Info node link (with encoded space)
+ shell:ls *.org A shell command
+ elisp:org-agenda Interactive Elisp command
+ elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") Elisp form to evaluate
+
+ A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
+descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (*note Link
+format::), for example:
+
+ [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
+
+If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
+export (*note HTML export::) will inline the image as a clickable
+button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
+image, that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
+
+ Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
+as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
+`bbdb:Richard Stallman'), or if you need to remove ambiguities about
+the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Handling links, Next: Using links outside Org, Prev: External links, Up: Hyperlinks
+
+4.4 Handling links
+==================
+
+Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to insert
+it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
+
+`C-c l (`org-store-link')'
+ Store a link to the current location. This is a _global_ command
+ (you must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in
+ any buffer to create a link. The link will be stored for later
+ insertion into an Org buffer (see below). What kind of link will
+ be created depends on the current buffer:
+
+ Org-mode buffers
+ For Org files, if there is a `<<target>>' at the cursor, the link
+ points to the target. Otherwise it points to the current
+ headline, which will also be the description.
+
+ If the headline has a `CUSTOM_ID' property, a link to this custom
+ ID will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the
+ value of `org-link-to-org-use-id'), a globally unique `ID'
+ property will be created and/or used to construct a link. So
+ using this command in Org buffers will potentially create two
+ links: a human-readable from the custom ID, and one that is
+ globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from file to
+ file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
+ to use.
+
+ Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus
+ Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will
+ point to the current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the
+ group. The description is constructed from the author and the
+ subject.
+
+ Web browsers: W3 and W3M
+ Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as
+ description.
+
+ Contacts: BBDB
+ Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
+
+ Chat: IRC
+ For IRC links, if you set the variable `org-irc-link-to-logs' to
+ `t', a `file:/' style link to the relevant point in the logs for
+ the current conversation is created. Otherwise an `irc:/' style
+ link to the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
+
+ Other files
+ For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a
+ search string (*note Search options::) pointing to the contents of
+ the current line. If there is an active region, the selected
+ words will form the basis of the search string. If the
+ automatically created link is not working correctly or accurately
+ enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
+ and to do the search for particular file types--see *Note Custom
+ searches::. The key binding `C-c l' is only a suggestion--see
+ *Note Installation::.
+
+ Agenda view
+ When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to
+ the entry referenced by the current line.
+
+`C-c C-l (`org-insert-link')'
+ Insert a link(1). This prompts for a link to be inserted into the
+ buffer. You can just type a link, using text for an internal
+ link, or one of the link type prefixes mentioned in the examples
+ above. The link will be inserted into the buffer(2), along with a
+ descriptive text. If some text was selected when this command is
+ called, the selected text becomes the default description.
+
+ Inserting stored links
+ All links stored during the current session are part of the
+ history for this prompt, so you can access them with <up> and
+ <down> (or `M-p/n').
+
+ Completion support
+ Completion with <TAB> will help you to insert valid link prefixes
+ like `http:' or `ftp:', including the prefixes defined through
+ link abbreviations (*note Link abbreviations::). If you press
+ <RET> after inserting only the PREFIX, Org will offer specific
+ completion support for some link types(3) For example, if you
+ type `file <RET>', file name completion (alternative access: `C-u
+ C-c C-l', see below) will be offered, and after `bbdb <RET>' you
+ can complete contact names.
+
+`C-u C-c C-l'
+ When `C-c C-l' is called with a `C-u' prefix argument, a link to a
+ file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to
+ select the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted
+ relative to the directory of the current Org file, if the linked
+ file is in the current directory or in a sub-directory of it, or
+ if the path is written relative to the current directory using
+ `../'. Otherwise an absolute path is used, if possible with `~/'
+ for your home directory. You can force an absolute path with two
+ `C-u' prefixes.
+
+`C-c C-l (with cursor on existing link)'
+ When the cursor is on an existing link, `C-c C-l' allows you to
+ edit the link and description parts of the link.
+
+`C-c C-o (`org-open-at-point')'
+ Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
+ `browse-url-at-point'), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
+ the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link.
+ When the cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the
+ corresponding search. When the cursor is on a TAG list in a
+ headline, it creates the corresponding TAGS view. If the cursor
+ is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that date.
+ Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in `file:' links
+ with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text
+ files. Classification of files is based on file extension only.
+ See option `org-file-apps'. If you want to override the default
+ application and visit the file with Emacs, use a `C-u' prefix. If
+ you want to avoid opening in Emacs, use a `C-u C-u' prefix.
+ If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links
+ in the headline and entry text.
+
+`<RET>'
+ When `org-return-follows-link' is set, `<RET>' will also follow
+ the link at point.
+
+`mouse-2'
+`mouse-1'
+ On links, `mouse-2' will open the link just as `C-c C-o' would.
+ Under Emacs 22 and later, `mouse-1' will also follow a link.
+
+`mouse-3'
+ Like `mouse-2', but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
+ internal links to be displayed in another window(4).
+
+`C-c C-x C-v (`org-toggle-inline-images')'
+ Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will
+ only inline images that have no description part in the link, i.e.
+ images that will also be inlined during export. When called with
+ a prefix argument, also display images that do have a link
+ description. You can ask for inline images to be displayed at
+ startup by configuring the variable
+ `org-startup-with-inline-images'(5).
+
+`C-c % (`org-mark-ring-push')'
+ Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
+ easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
+
+`C-c & (`org-mark-ring-goto')'
+ Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
+ commands following internal links, and by `C-c %'. Using this
+ command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
+ previously recorded positions.
+
+`C-c C-x C-n (`org-next-link')'
+`C-c C-x C-p (`org-previous-link')'
+ Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the
+ limit of the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around.
+ The key bindings for this are really too long; you might want to
+ bind this also to `C-n' and `C-p'
+ (add-hook 'org-load-hook
+ (lambda ()
+ (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
+ (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Note that you don't have to use this command to insert a link.
+Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them straight
+into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
+enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
+descriptive text.
+
+ (2) After insertion of a stored link, the link will be removed from
+the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use a
+triple `C-u' prefix argument to `C-c C-l', or configure the option
+`org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion'.
+
+ (3) This works by calling a special function
+`org-PREFIX-complete-link'.
+
+ (4) See the variable `org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer'
+
+ (5) with corresponding `#+STARTUP' keywords `inlineimages' and
+`inlineimages'
+
+
+File: org, Node: Using links outside Org, Next: Link abbreviations, Prev: Handling links, Up: Hyperlinks
+
+4.5 Using links outside Org
+===========================
+
+You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in Org,
+but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two global
+commands, like this (please select suitable global keys yourself):
+
+ (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
+ (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
+
+
+File: org, Node: Link abbreviations, Next: Search options, Prev: Using links outside Org, Up: Hyperlinks
+
+4.6 Link abbreviations
+======================
+
+Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
+needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
+abbreviated link looks like this
+
+ [[linkword:tag][description]]
+
+where the tag is optional. The linkword must be a word, starting with
+a letter, followed by letters, numbers, `-', and `_'. Abbreviations
+are resolved according to the information in the variable
+`org-link-abbrev-alist' that relates the linkwords to replacement text.
+Here is an example:
+
+ (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
+ '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
+ ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
+ ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
+ ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
+ ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
+
+ If the replacement text contains the string `%s', it will be
+replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
+in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
+be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
+
+ With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
+`[[bugzilla:129]]', search the web for `OrgMode' with
+`[[google:OrgMode]]', show the map location of the Free Software
+Foundation `[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]' or of Carsten office
+`[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]' and find out
+what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
+`[[ads:Dominik,C]]'.
+
+ If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
+can define them in the file with
+
+ #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
+ #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
+
+In-buffer completion (*note Completion::) can be used after `[' to
+complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
+`org-PREFIX-complete-link' that implements special (e.g. completion)
+support for inserting such a link with `C-c C-l'. Such a function
+should not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Search options, Next: Custom searches, Prev: Link abbreviations, Up: Hyperlinks
+
+4.7 Search options in file links
+================================
+
+File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
+particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
+line number or a search option after a double(1) colon. For example,
+when the command `C-c l' creates a link (*note Handling links::) to a
+file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search string that
+can be used to find this line back later when following the link with
+`C-c C-o'.
+
+ Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
+link, together with an explanation:
+
+ [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
+ [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
+ [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
+ [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
+ [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
+
+`255'
+ Jump to line 255.
+
+`My Target'
+ Search for a link target `<<My Target>>', or do a text search for
+ `my target', similar to the search in internal links, see *Note
+ Internal links::. In HTML export (*note HTML export::), such a
+ file link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named
+ anchor in the linked file.
+
+`*My Target'
+ In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
+
+`#my-custom-id'
+ Link to a heading with a `CUSTOM_ID' property
+
+`/regexp/'
+ Do a regular expression search for `regexp'. This uses the Emacs
+ command `occur' to list all matches in a separate window. If the
+ target file is in Org-mode, `org-occur' is used to create a sparse
+ tree with the matches.
+
+ As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
+to search the current file. For example, `[[file:::find me]]' does a
+search for `find me' in the current file, just as `[[find me]]' would.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) For backward compatibility, line numbers can also follow a
+single colon.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Custom searches, Prev: Search options, Up: Hyperlinks
+
+4.8 Custom Searches
+===================
+
+The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
+actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
+cases. For example, BibTeX database files have many entries like
+`year="1993"' which would not result in good search strings, because
+the only unique identification for a BibTeX entry is the citation key.
+
+ If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to
+set the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the
+search for the string in the file. Using `add-hook', these functions
+need to be added to the hook variables
+`org-create-file-search-functions' and
+`org-execute-file-search-functions'. See the docstring for these
+variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism for
+BibTeX database files, and you can use the corresponding code as an
+implementation example. See the file `org-bibtex.el'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: TODO Items, Next: Tags, Prev: Hyperlinks, Up: Top
+
+5 TODO items
+************
+
+Org-mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents(1).
+Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the notes file, because
+TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org mode, simply
+mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
+information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the
+TODO item emerged is always present.
+
+ Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
+throughout your notes file. Org-mode compensates for this by providing
+methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
+* TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
+* Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
+* Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
+* Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
+* Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Of course, you can make a document that contains only long lists
+of TODO items, but this is not required.
+
+
+File: org, Node: TODO basics, Next: TODO extensions, Prev: TODO Items, Up: TODO Items
+
+5.1 Basic TODO functionality
+============================
+
+Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word `TODO',
+for example:
+
+ *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
+
+The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
+
+`C-c C-t (`org-todo')'
+ Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
+
+ ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
+ '--------------------------------'
+
+ The same rotation can also be done "remotely" from the timeline and
+ agenda buffers with the `t' command key (*note Agenda commands::).
+
+`C-u C-c C-t'
+ Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set
+ up) the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to
+ assign keys to TODO states, see *Note Per-file keywords::, and
+ *Note Setting tags::, for more information.
+
+`S-<right> / S-<left>'
+ Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling.
+ Useful mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (*note
+ TODO extensions::). See also *Note Conflicts::, for a discussion
+ of the interaction with `shift-selection-mode'. See also the
+ variable `org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change'.
+
+`C-c / t (`org-show-todo-key')'
+ View TODO items in a _sparse tree_ (*note Sparse trees::). Folds
+ the entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state)
+ and the headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or
+ by using `C-c / T'), search for a specific TODO. You will be
+ prompted for the keyword, and you can also give a list of keywords
+ like `KWD1|KWD2|...' to list entries that match any one of these
+ keywords. With numeric prefix argument N, show the tree for the
+ Nth keyword in the variable `org-todo-keywords'. With two prefix
+ arguments, find all TODO states, both un-done and done.
+
+`C-c a t (`org-todo-list')'
+ Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE
+ states) from all agenda files (*note Agenda Views::) into a single
+ buffer. The new buffer will be in `agenda-mode', which provides
+ commands to examine and manipulate the TODO entries from the new
+ buffer (*note Agenda commands::). *Note Global TODO list::, for
+ more information.
+
+`S-M-<RET> (`org-insert-todo-heading')'
+ Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
+
+Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring
+of the option `org-todo-state-tags-triggers' for details.
+
+
+File: org, Node: TODO extensions, Next: Progress logging, Prev: TODO basics, Up: TODO Items
+
+5.2 Extended use of TODO keywords
+=================================
+
+By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
+DONE. Org-mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
+with _TODO keywords_ (stored in `org-todo-keywords'). With special
+setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different files.
+
+ Note that tags are another way to classify headlines in general and
+TODO items in particular (*note Tags::).
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
+* TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
+* Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
+* Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
+* Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
+* Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
+* TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
+
+
+File: org, Node: Workflow states, Next: TODO types, Prev: TODO extensions, Up: TODO extensions
+
+5.2.1 TODO keywords as workflow states
+--------------------------------------
+
+You can use TODO keywords to indicate different _sequential_ states in
+the process of working on an item, for example(1):
+
+ (setq org-todo-keywords
+ '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
+
+ The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that _need
+action_) from the DONE states (which need _no further action_). If you
+don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
+state. With this setup, the command `C-c C-t' will cycle an entry from
+TODO to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED.
+You may also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific
+state. For example `C-3 C-c C-t' will change the state immediately to
+VERIFY. Or you can use `S-<left>' to go backward through the sequence.
+If you define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion (*note
+Completion::) or even a special one-key selection scheme (*note Fast
+access to TODO states::) to insert these words into the buffer.
+Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see *Note
+Tracking TODO state changes::, for more information.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Changing this variable only becomes effective after restarting
+Org-mode in a buffer.
+
+
+File: org, Node: TODO types, Next: Multiple sets in one file, Prev: Workflow states, Up: TODO extensions
+
+5.2.2 TODO keywords as types
+----------------------------
+
+The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
+_types_ of action items. For example, you might want to indicate that
+items are for "work" or "home". Or, when you work with several people
+on a single project, you might want to assign action items directly to
+persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would be set up
+like this:
+
+ (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
+
+ In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but
+rather different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a
+task to a person, and later to mark it DONE. Org-mode supports this
+style by adapting the workings of the command `C-c C-t'(1). When used
+several times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in
+order to first select the right type for a task. But when you return
+to the item after some time and execute `C-c C-t' again, it will switch
+from any name directly to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to
+quickly select a specific name. You can also review the items of a
+specific TODO type in a sparse tree by using a numeric prefix to `C-c /
+t'. For example, to see all things Lucy has to do, you would use `C-3
+C-c / t'. To collect Lucy's items from all agenda files into a single
+buffer, you would use the numeric prefix argument as well when creating
+the global TODO list: `C-3 C-c a t'.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) This is also true for the `t' command in the timeline and agenda
+buffers.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Multiple sets in one file, Next: Fast access to TODO states, Prev: TODO types, Up: TODO extensions
+
+5.2.3 Multiple keyword sets in one file
+---------------------------------------
+
+Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
+parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic `TODO'/`DONE',
+but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a separate state indicating
+that an item has been canceled (so it is not DONE, but also does not
+require action). Your setup would then look like this:
+
+ (setq org-todo-keywords
+ '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
+ (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
+ (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
+
+ The keywords should all be different, this helps Org-mode to keep
+track of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this
+setup, `C-c C-t' only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
+`DONE' to (nothing) to `TODO', and from `FIXED' to (nothing) to
+`REPORT'. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially select the
+correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a keyword or
+using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
+
+`C-u C-u C-c C-t'
+`C-S-<right>'
+`C-S-<left>'
+ These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above
+ example, `C-u C-u C-c C-t' or `C-S-<right>' would jump from `TODO'
+ or `DONE' to `REPORT', and any of the words in the second row to
+ `CANCELED'. Note that the `C-S-' key binding conflict with
+ `shift-selection-mode' (*note Conflicts::).
+
+`S-<right>'
+`S-<left>'
+ `S-<<left>>' and `S-<<right>>' and walk through _all_ keywords
+ from all sets, so for example `S-<<right>>' would switch from
+ `DONE' to `REPORT' in the example above. See also *Note
+ Conflicts::, for a discussion of the interaction with
+ `shift-selection-mode'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Fast access to TODO states, Next: Per-file keywords, Prev: Multiple sets in one file, Up: TODO extensions
+
+5.2.4 Fast access to TODO states
+--------------------------------
+
+If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
+instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
+single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
+key after each keyword, in parentheses. For example:
+
+ (setq org-todo-keywords
+ '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
+ (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
+ (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
+
+ If you then press `C-c C-t' followed by the selection key, the entry
+will be switched to this state. <SPC> can be used to remove any TODO
+keyword from an entry.(1)
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Check also the variable `org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo',
+it allows you to change the TODO state through the tags interface
+(*note Setting tags::), in case you like to mingle the two concepts.
+Note that this means you need to come up with unique keys across both
+sets of keywords.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Per-file keywords, Next: Faces for TODO keywords, Prev: Fast access to TODO states, Up: TODO extensions
+
+5.2.5 Setting up keywords for individual files
+----------------------------------------------
+
+It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
+different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
+to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
+only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
+need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
+file:
+
+ #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
+ (you may also write `#+SEQ_TODO' to be explicit about the
+interpretation, but it means the same as `#+TODO'), or
+ #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
+
+ A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
+
+ #+TODO: TODO | DONE
+ #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
+ #+TODO: | CANCELED
+
+To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type `#+' into the
+buffer and then use `M-<TAB>' completion.
+
+ Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last
+keyword if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE
+(although you may use a different word). After changing one of these
+lines, use `C-c C-c' with the cursor still in the line to make the
+changes known to Org-mode(1).
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Org-mode parses these lines only when Org-mode is activated
+after visiting a file. `C-c C-c' with the cursor in a line starting
+with `#+' is simply restarting Org-mode for the current buffer.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Faces for TODO keywords, Next: TODO dependencies, Prev: Per-file keywords, Up: TODO extensions
+
+5.2.6 Faces for TODO keywords
+-----------------------------
+
+Org-mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: `org-todo' for
+keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
+`org-done' for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If you
+are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use special
+faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
+`org-todo-keyword-faces'. For example:
+
+ (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
+ '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
+ ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
+
+ While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED
+_should_ work, this does not aways seem to be the case. If necessary,
+define a special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a
+color. The variable `org-faces-easy-properties' determines if that
+color is interpreted as a foreground or a background color.
+
+
+File: org, Node: TODO dependencies, Prev: Faces for TODO keywords, Up: TODO extensions
+
+5.2.7 TODO dependencies
+-----------------------
+
+The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to
+define TODO dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be
+marked DONE until all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked
+as DONE. And sometimes there is a logical sequence to a number of
+(sub)tasks, so that one task cannot be acted upon before all siblings
+above it are done. If you customize the variable
+`org-enforce-todo-dependencies', Org will block entries from changing
+state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE. Furthermore,
+if an entry has a property `ORDERED', each of its children will be
+blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an example:
+
+ * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
+ ** DONE one
+ ** TODO two
+
+ * Parent
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :ORDERED: t
+ :END:
+ ** TODO a
+ ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
+ ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
+
+`C-c C-x o (`org-toggle-ordered-property')'
+ Toggle the `ORDERED' property of the current entry. A property is
+ used for this behavior because this should be local to the current
+ entry, not inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to
+ track the value of this property with a tag for better visibility,
+ customize the variable `org-track-ordered-property-with-tag'.
+
+`C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t'
+ Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
+
+ If you set the variable `org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks', TODO entries
+that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a
+dimmed font or even made invisible in agenda views (*note Agenda
+Views::).
+
+ You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
+(*note Checkboxes::). If you set the variable
+`org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies', an entry that has unchecked
+checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
+
+ If you need more complex dependency structures, for example
+dependencies between entries in different trees or files, check out the
+contributed module `org-depend.el'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Progress logging, Next: Priorities, Prev: TODO extensions, Up: TODO Items
+
+5.3 Progress logging
+====================
+
+Org-mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
+you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
+a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
+per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
+information on how to clock working time for a task, see *Note Clocking
+work time::.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
+* Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
+* Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
+
+
+File: org, Node: Closing items, Next: Tracking TODO state changes, Prev: Progress logging, Up: Progress logging
+
+5.3.1 Closing items
+-------------------
+
+The most basic logging is to keep track of _when_ a certain TODO item
+was finished. This is achieved with(1)
+
+ (setq org-log-done 'time)
+
+Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
+of the DONE states, a line `CLOSED: [timestamp]' will be inserted just
+after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
+through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
+want to record a note along with the timestamp, use(2)
+
+ (setq org-log-done 'note)
+
+You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
+the entry with a `Closing Note' heading.
+
+ In the timeline (*note Timeline::) and in the agenda (*note
+Weekly/daily agenda::), you can then use the `l' key to display the
+TODO items with a `CLOSED' timestamp on each day, giving you an
+overview of what has been done.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) The corresponding in-buffer setting is: `#+STARTUP: logdone'
+
+ (2) The corresponding in-buffer setting is: `#+STARTUP: lognotedone'
+
+
+File: org, Node: Tracking TODO state changes, Next: Tracking your habits, Prev: Closing items, Up: Progress logging
+
+5.3.2 Tracking TODO state changes
+---------------------------------
+
+When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (*note Workflow
+states::), you might want to keep track of when a state change occurred
+and maybe take a note about this change. You can either record just a
+timestamp, or a time-stamped note for a change. These records will be
+inserted after the headline as an itemized list, newest first(1). When
+taking a lot of notes, you might want to get the notes out of the way
+into a drawer (*note Drawers::). Customize the variable
+`org-log-into-drawer' to get this behavior--the recommended drawer for
+this is called `LOGBOOK'. You can also overrule the setting of this
+variable for a subtree by setting a `LOG_INTO_DRAWER' property.
+
+ Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state,
+Org-mode expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This
+is achieved by adding special markers `!' (for a timestamp) and `@'
+(for a note) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the
+setting
+
+ (setq org-todo-keywords
+ '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@)")))
+
+you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
+request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to DONE(2), and
+that a note is recorded when switching to WAIT or CANCELED. The
+setting for WAIT is even more special: the `!' after the slash means
+that in addition to the note taken when entering the state, a timestamp
+should be recorded when leaving the WAIT state, if and only if the
+target state does not configure logging for entering it. So it has no
+effect when switching from WAIT to DONE, because DONE is configured to
+record a timestamp only. But when switching from WAIT back to TODO,
+the `/!' in the WAIT setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO
+has no logging configured.
+
+ You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences
+local to a buffer:
+ #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@)
+
+ In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
+single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
+LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
+on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
+`lognotedone' or `logrepeat', as well as adding state specific settings
+like `TODO(!)'. For example
+
+ * TODO Log each state with only a time
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
+ :END:
+ * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :LOGGING: WAIT(@) logrepeat
+ :END:
+ * TODO No logging at all
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :LOGGING: nil
+ :END:
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) See the variable `org-log-states-order-reversed'
+
+ (2) It is possible that Org-mode will record two timestamps when you
+are using both `org-log-done' and state change logging. However, it
+will never prompt for two notes--if you have configured both, the state
+change recording note will take precedence and cancel the `Closing
+Note'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Tracking your habits, Prev: Tracking TODO state changes, Up: Progress logging
+
+5.3.3 Tracking your habits
+--------------------------
+
+Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of
+TODOs, called "habits". A habit has the following properties:
+
+ 1. You have enabled the `habits' module by customizing the variable
+ `org-modules'.
+
+ 2. The habit is a TODO, with a TODO keyword representing an open
+ state.
+
+ 3. The property `STYLE' is set to the value `habit'.
+
+ 4. The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a `.+' style repeat
+ interval. A `++' style may be appropriate for habits with time
+ constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a `+' style for an
+ unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
+
+ 5. The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by
+ using the syntax `.+2d/3d', which says that you want to do the
+ task at least every three days, but at most every two days.
+
+ 6. You must also have state logging for the `DONE' state enabled, in
+ order for historical data to be represented in the consistency
+ graph. If it's not enabled it's not an error, but the consistency
+ graphs will be largely meaningless.
+
+ To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action,
+here's an actual habit with some history:
+
+ ** TODO Shave
+ SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
+ - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :STYLE: habit
+ :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
+ :END:
+
+ What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given
+by the `SCHEDULED' date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days.
+If today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on
+Oct 17, after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear
+overdue on Oct 19, after four days have elapsed.
+
+ What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along
+with a consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting
+that task done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task
+was done over the past three weeks, with colors for each day. The
+colors used are:
+
+`Blue'
+ If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
+
+`Green'
+ If the task could have been done on that day.
+
+`Yellow'
+ If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
+
+`Red'
+ If the task was overdue on that day.
+
+ In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an
+asterisk if the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation
+mark to show where the current day falls in the graph.
+
+ There are several configuration variables that can be used to change
+the way habits are displayed in the agenda.
+
+`org-habit-graph-column'
+ The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn.
+ This will overwrite any text in that column, so it's a good idea
+ to keep your habits' titles brief and to the point.
+
+`org-habit-preceding-days'
+ The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in
+ consistency graphs.
+
+`org-habit-following-days'
+ The number of days after today that will appear in consistency
+ graphs.
+
+`org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today'
+ If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set
+ to true by default.
+
+ Lastly, pressing `K' in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
+temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press `K' again
+to bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you
+have habits which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Priorities, Next: Breaking down tasks, Prev: Progress logging, Up: TODO Items
+
+5.4 Priorities
+==============
+
+If you use Org-mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items
+that it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be
+done by placing a _priority cookie_ into the headline of a TODO item,
+like this
+
+ *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
+
+By default, Org-mode supports three priorities: `A', `B', and `C'. `A'
+is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is treated just
+like priority `B'. Priorities make a difference only for sorting in
+the agenda (*note Weekly/daily agenda::); outside the agenda, they have
+no inherent meaning to Org-mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
+special faces by customizing the variable `org-priority-faces'.
+
+ Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to
+be TODO items.
+
+`C-c ,'
+ Set the priority of the current headline (`org-priority'). The
+ command prompts for a priority character `A', `B' or `C'. When
+ you press <SPC> instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
+ headline. The priorities can also be changed "remotely" from the
+ timeline and agenda buffer with the `,' command (*note Agenda
+ commands::).
+
+`S-<up> (`org-priority-up')'
+`S-<down> (`org-priority-down')'
+ Increase/decrease priority of current headline(1). Note that
+ these keys are also used to modify timestamps (*note Creating
+ timestamps::). See also *Note Conflicts::, for a discussion of
+ the interaction with `shift-selection-mode'.
+
+ You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the
+variables `org-highest-priority', `org-lowest-priority', and
+`org-default-priority'. For an individual buffer, you may set these
+values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that the
+highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest priority):
+
+ #+PRIORITIES: A C B
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) See also the option `org-priority-start-cycle-with-default'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Breaking down tasks, Next: Checkboxes, Prev: Priorities, Up: TODO Items
+
+5.5 Breaking tasks down into subtasks
+=====================================
+
+It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
+subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO
+item, with detailed subtasks on the tree(1). To keep the overview over
+the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert either
+`[/]' or `[%]' anywhere in the headline. These cookies will be updated
+each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing `C-c
+C-c' on the cookie. For example:
+
+ * Organize Party [33%]
+ ** TODO Call people [1/2]
+ *** TODO Peter
+ *** DONE Sarah
+ ** TODO Buy food
+ ** DONE Talk to neighbor
+
+ If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the
+meaning of the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
+`COOKIE_DATA' to either `checkbox' or `todo' to resolve this issue.
+
+ If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO
+entries in the subtree (not just direct children), configure the
+variable `org-hierarchical-todo-statistics'. To do this for a single
+subtree, include the word `recursive' into the value of the
+`COOKIE_DATA' property.
+
+ * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
+ :END:
+
+ If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE when
+all children are done, you can use the following setup:
+
+ (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
+ "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
+ (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
+ (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
+
+ (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
+
+ Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a
+hierarchy of) a large number of subtasks (*note Checkboxes::).
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) To keep subtasks out of the global TODO list, see the
+`org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Checkboxes, Prev: Breaking down tasks, Up: TODO Items
+
+5.6 Checkboxes
+==============
+
+Every item in a plain list(1) (*note Plain lists::) can be made into a
+checkbox by starting it with the string `[ ]'. This feature is similar
+to TODO items (*note TODO Items::), but is more lightweight.
+Checkboxes are not included into the global TODO list, so they are
+often great to split a task into a number of simple steps. Or you can
+use them in a shopping list. To toggle a checkbox, use `C-c C-c', or
+use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's `org-mouse.el').
+
+ Here is an example of a checkbox list.
+
+ * TODO Organize party [2/4]
+ - [-] call people [1/3]
+ - [ ] Peter
+ - [X] Sarah
+ - [ ] Sam
+ - [X] order food
+ - [ ] think about what music to play
+ - [X] talk to the neighbors
+
+ Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children
+that are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make
+the parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
+checked.
+
+ The `[2/4]' and `[1/3]' in the first and second line are cookies
+indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked
+off, and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an
+idea on how many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded
+entry. The cookies can be placed into a headline or into (the first
+line of) a plain list item. Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct
+children structurally below the headline/item on which the cookie
+appears(2). You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
+`[/]' or `[%]'. With `[/]' you get an `n out of m' result, as in the
+examples above. With `[%]' you get information about the percentage of
+checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be `[50%]' and
+`[33%]', respectively). In a headline, a cookie can count either
+checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it will
+display whatever was changed last. Set the property `COOKIE_DATA' to
+either `checkbox' or `todo' to resolve this issue.
+
+ If the current outline node has an `ORDERED' property, checkboxes
+must be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try
+to check off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
+
+The following commands work with checkboxes:
+
+`C-c C-c (`org-toggle-checkbox')'
+ Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at
+ point. With double prefix argument, set it to `[-]', which is
+ considered to be an intermediate state.
+
+`C-c C-x C-b (`org-toggle-checkbox')'
+ Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at
+ point. With double prefix argument, set it to `[-]', which is
+ considered to be an intermediate state.
+ - If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in
+ the region and set all remaining boxes to the same status as
+ the first. With a prefix arg, add or remove the checkbox for
+ all items in the region.
+
+ - If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the
+ region between this headline and the next (so _not_ the
+ entire subtree).
+
+ - If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at
+ point.
+
+`M-S-<RET> (`org-insert-todo-heading')'
+ Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor
+ is already in a plain list item (*note Plain lists::).
+
+`C-c C-x o (`org-toggle-ordered-property')'
+ Toggle the `ORDERED' property of the entry, to toggle if
+ checkboxes must be checked off in sequence. A property is used
+ for this behavior because this should be local to the current
+ entry, not inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to
+ track the value of this property with a tag for better visibility,
+ customize the variable `org-track-ordered-property-with-tag'.
+
+`C-c # (`org-update-statistics-cookies')'
+ Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When
+ called with a `C-u' prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox
+ statistic cookies are updated automatically if you toggle
+ checkboxes with `C-c C-c' and make new ones with `M-S-<RET>'.
+ TODO statistics cookies update when changing TODO states. If you
+ delete boxes/entries or add/change them by hand, use this command
+ to get things back into sync. Or simply toggle any entry twice
+ (checkboxes with `C-c C-c').
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) With the exception of description lists. But you can allow it by
+modifying `org-list-automatic-rules' accordingly.
+
+ (2) Set the variable `org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics' if you
+want such cookies to represent the all checkboxes below the cookie, not
+just the direct children.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Tags, Next: Properties and Columns, Prev: TODO Items, Up: Top
+
+6 Tags
+******
+
+An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
+information is to assign tags to headlines. Org-mode has extensive
+support for tags.
+
+ Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of
+the headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, `_',
+and `@'. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
+`:work:'. Several tags can be specified, as in `:work:urgent:'. Tags
+will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
+You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
+`org-tag-faces', in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
+(*note Faces for TODO keywords::).
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
+* Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
+* Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
+
+
+File: org, Node: Tag inheritance, Next: Setting tags, Prev: Tags, Up: Tags
+
+6.1 Tag inheritance
+===================
+
+Tags make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
+heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
+well. For example, in the list
+
+ * Meeting with the French group :work:
+ ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
+ *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
+
+the final heading will have the tags `:work:', `:boss:', `:notes:', and
+`:action:' even though the final heading is not explicitly marked with
+those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in a file should
+inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical level zero
+that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this(1):
+
+ #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
+
+To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely,
+use the variables `org-use-tag-inheritance' and
+`org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance'.
+
+ When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance
+is turned on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple
+match form) match as well(2). The list of matches may then become very
+long. If you only want to see the first tags match in a subtree,
+configure the variable `org-tags-match-list-sublevels' (not
+recommended).
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) As with all these in-buffer settings, pressing `C-c C-c'
+activates any changes in the line.
+
+ (2) This is only true if the search does not involve more complex
+tests including properties (*note Property searches::).
+
+
+File: org, Node: Setting tags, Next: Tag searches, Prev: Tag inheritance, Up: Tags
+
+6.2 Setting tags
+================
+
+Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
+After a colon, `M-<TAB>' offers completion on tags. There is also a
+special command for inserting tags:
+
+`C-c C-q (`org-set-tags-command')'
+ Enter new tags for the current headline. Org-mode will either
+ offer completion or a special single-key interface for setting
+ tags, see below. After pressing <RET>, the tags will be inserted
+ and aligned to `org-tags-column'. When called with a `C-u'
+ prefix, all tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that
+ column, just to make things look nice. TAGS are automatically
+ realigned after promotion, demotion, and TODO state changes (*note
+ TODO basics::).
+
+`C-c C-c (`org-set-tags-command')'
+ When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as `C-c C-q'.
+
+ Org will support tag insertion based on a _list of tags_. By
+default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
+currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
+of tags with the variable `org-tag-alist'. Finally you can set the
+default tags for a given file with lines like
+
+ #+TAGS: @work @home @tennisclub
+ #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
+
+ If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
+variable `org-tag-alist', but would like to use a dynamic tag list in a
+specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
+
+ #+TAGS:
+
+ If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in
+every file, in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS
+option lines, then you may specify a list of tags with the variable
+`org-tag-persistent-alist'. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
+by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
+
+ #+STARTUP: noptag
+
+ By default Org-mode uses the standard minibuffer completion
+facilities for entering tags. However, it also implements another,
+quicker, tag selection method called _fast tag selection_. This allows
+you to select and deselect tags with just a single key press. For this
+to work well you should assign unique letters to most of your commonly
+used tags. You can do this globally by configuring the variable
+`org-tag-alist' in your `.emacs' file. For example, you may find the
+need to tag many items in different files with `:@home:'. In this case
+you can set something like:
+
+ (setq org-tag-alist '(("@work" . ?w) ("@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
+
+If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
+can instead set the TAGS option line as:
+
+ #+TAGS: @work(w) @home(h) @tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
+
+The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash window. If
+you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert `\n' into the
+tag list
+
+ #+TAGS: @work(w) @home(h) @tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
+
+or write them in two lines:
+
+ #+TAGS: @work(w) @home(h) @tennisclub(t)
+ #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
+
+You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
+braces, as in:
+
+ #+TAGS: { @work(w) @home(h) @tennisclub(t) } laptop(l) pc(p)
+
+you indicate that at most one of `@work', `@home', and `@tennisclub'
+should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
+
+Don't forget to press `C-c C-c' with the cursor in one of these lines
+to activate any changes.
+
+To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable `org-tags-alist',
+you must use the dummy tags `:startgroup' and `:endgroup' instead of
+the braces. Similarly, you can use `:newline' to indicate a line
+break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
+configuration:
+
+ (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
+ ("@work" . ?w) ("@home" . ?h)
+ ("@tennisclub" . ?t)
+ (:endgroup . nil)
+ ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
+
+ If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing `C-c C-c' will
+automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited
+tags, the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags
+with corresponding keys(1). In this interface, you can use the
+following keys:
+
+`a-z...'
+ Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the
+ list of tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of
+ mutually exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that
+ group.
+
+`<TAB>'
+ Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the
+ predefined list. You will be able to complete on all tags present
+ in the buffer.
+
+`<SPC>'
+ Clear all tags for this line.
+
+`<RET>'
+ Accept the modified set.
+
+`C-g'
+ Abort without installing changes.
+
+`q'
+ If `q' is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like `C-g'.
+
+`!'
+ Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
+ exception) assign several tags from such a group.
+
+`C-c'
+ Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below). If you are
+ using expert mode, the first `C-c' will display the selection
+ window.
+
+This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
+the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set `@home',
+`laptop' and `pc' tags with just the following keys: `C-c C-c <SPC> h l
+p <RET>'. Switching from `@home' to `@work' would be done with `C-c
+C-c w <RET>' or alternatively with `C-c C-c C-c w'. Adding the
+non-predefined tag `Sarah' could be done with `C-c C-c <TAB> S a r a h
+<RET> <RET>'.
+
+ If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
+modify your list of tags, set the variable
+`org-fast-tag-selection-single-key'. Then you no longer have to press
+<RET> to exit fast tag selection--it will immediately exit after the
+first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press `C-c' to
+turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process (in effect:
+start selection with `C-c C-c C-c' instead of `C-c C-c'). If you set
+the variable to the value `expert', the special window is not even
+shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only when you press an
+extra `C-c'.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which have no
+configured keys.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Tag searches, Prev: Setting tags, Up: Tags
+
+6.3 Tag searches
+================
+
+Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
+information into special lists.
+
+`C-c / m or C-c ,org-match-sparse-tree (`')'
+ Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search.
+ With a `C-u' prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO
+ line.
+
+`C-c a m (`org-tags-view')'
+ Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files. *Note
+ Matching tags and properties::.
+
+`C-c a M (`org-tags-view')'
+ Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but
+ check only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
+ `org-tags-match-list-sublevels').
+
+ These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic
+Boolean logic like `+boss+urgent-project1', to find entries with tags
+`boss' and `urgent', but not `project1', or `Kathy|Sally' to find
+entries which are tagged, like `Kathy' or `Sally'. The full syntax of
+the search string is rich and allows also matching against TODO
+keywords, entry levels and properties. For a complete description with
+many examples, see *Note Matching tags and properties::.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Properties and Columns, Next: Dates and Times, Prev: Tags, Up: Top
+
+7 Properties and columns
+************************
+
+Properties are a set of key-value pairs associated with an entry. There
+are two main applications for properties in Org-mode. First, properties
+are like tags, but with a value. Second, you can use properties to
+implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. For an
+example of the first application, imagine maintaining a file where you
+document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
+using tags like `:release_1:', `:release_2:', one can use a property,
+say `:Release:', that in different subtrees has different values, such
+as `1.0' or `2.0'. For an example of the second application of
+properties, imagine keeping track of your music CDs, where properties
+could be things such as the album, artist, date of release, number of
+tracks, and so on.
+
+ Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
+(*note Column view::).
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
+* Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
+* Property searches:: Matching property values
+* Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
+* Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
+* Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
+
+
+File: org, Node: Property syntax, Next: Special properties, Prev: Properties and Columns, Up: Properties and Columns
+
+7.1 Property syntax
+===================
+
+Properties are key-value pairs. They need to be inserted into a special
+drawer (*note Drawers::) with the name `PROPERTIES'. Each property is
+specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons) first,
+and the value after it. Here is an example:
+
+ * CD collection
+ ** Classic
+ *** Goldberg Variations
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :Title: Goldberg Variations
+ :Composer: J.S. Bach
+ :Artist: Glen Gould
+ :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
+ :NDisks: 1
+ :END:
+
+ You may define the allowed values for a particular property `:Xyz:'
+by setting a property `:Xyz_ALL:'. This special property is
+_inherited_, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to the
+entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
+corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
+errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
+publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
+
+ * CD collection
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
+ :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
+ :END:
+
+ If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
+file, use a line like
+ #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
+
+ Property values set with the global variable `org-global-properties'
+can be inherited by all entries in all Org files.
+
+The following commands help to work with properties:
+
+`M-<TAB> (`org-complete')'
+ After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All
+ keys used in the current file will be offered as possible
+ completions.
+
+`C-c C-x p (`org-set-property')'
+ Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
+ necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
+
+`M-x org-insert-property-drawer'
+ Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will
+ be inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
+ information like deadlines.
+
+`C-c C-c (`org-property-action')'
+ With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property
+ commands.
+
+`C-c C-c s (`org-set-property')'
+ Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the
+ value can be inserted using completion.
+
+`S-<right> (`org-property-next-allowed-value')'
+`S-<left> (`org-property-previous-allowed-value')'
+ Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
+
+`C-c C-c d (`org-delete-property')'
+ Remove a property from the current entry.
+
+`C-c C-c D (`org-delete-property-globally')'
+ Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
+
+`C-c C-c c (`org-compute-property-at-point')'
+ Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from
+ the nearest column format definition.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Special properties, Next: Property searches, Prev: Property syntax, Up: Properties and Columns
+
+7.2 Special properties
+======================
+
+Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org-mode
+features, like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in
+the previous chapters. This interface exists so that you can include
+these states in a column view (*note Column view::), or to use them in
+queries. The following property names are special and should not be
+used as keys in the properties drawer:
+
+ TODO The TODO keyword of the entry.
+ TAGS The tags defined directly in the headline.
+ ALLTAGS All tags, including inherited ones.
+ CATEGORY The category of an entry.
+ PRIORITY The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.
+ DEADLINE The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.
+ SCHEDULED The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.
+ CLOSED When was this entry closed?
+ TIMESTAMP The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.
+ TIMESTAMP_IA The first inactive timestamp in the entry.
+ CLOCKSUM The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. `org-clock-sum'
+ must be run first to compute the values.
+ BLOCKED "t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings
+ ITEM The content of the entry.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Property searches, Next: Property inheritance, Prev: Special properties, Up: Properties and Columns
+
+7.3 Property searches
+=====================
+
+To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on
+properties, the same commands are used as for tag searches (*note Tag
+searches::).
+`C-c / m or C-c ,org-match-sparse-tree (`')'
+ Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a `C-u'
+ prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
+
+`C-c a m (`org-tags-view')'
+ Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda
+ files. *Note Matching tags and properties::.
+
+`C-c a M (`org-tags-view')'
+ Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but
+ check only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
+ `org-tags-match-list-sublevels').
+
+ The syntax for the search string is described in *Note Matching tags
+and properties::.
+
+ There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
+single property:
+
+`C-c / p'
+ Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
+ prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A
+ sparse tree is created with all entries that define this property
+ with the given value. If you enclose the value in curly braces,
+ it is interpreted as a regular expression and matched against the
+ property values.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Property inheritance, Next: Column view, Prev: Property searches, Up: Properties and Columns
+
+7.4 Property Inheritance
+========================
+
+The outline structure of Org-mode documents lends itself to an
+inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
+property, the children can inherit this property. Org-mode does not
+turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
+significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
+useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
+`org-use-property-inheritance'. It may be set to `t' to make all
+properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties that
+should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches inherited
+properties. If a property has the value `nil', this is interpreted as
+an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance search will
+stop at this value and return `nil'.
+
+ Org-mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
+least for the special applications for which they are used:
+
+`COLUMNS'
+ The `:COLUMNS:' property defines the format of column view (*note
+ Column view::). It is inherited in the sense that the level where
+ a `:COLUMNS:' property is defined is used as the starting point
+ for a column view table, independently of the location in the
+ subtree from where columns view is turned on.
+
+`CATEGORY'
+ For agenda view, a category set through a `:CATEGORY:' property
+ applies to the entire subtree.
+
+`ARCHIVE'
+ For archiving, the `:ARCHIVE:' property may define the archive
+ location for the entire subtree (*note Moving subtrees::).
+
+`LOGGING'
+ The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
+ subtree (*note Tracking TODO state changes::).
+
+
+File: org, Node: Column view, Next: Property API, Prev: Property inheritance, Up: Properties and Columns
+
+7.5 Column view
+===============
+
+A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is _column
+view_. In column view, each outline node is turned into a table row.
+Columns in this table provide access to properties of the entries.
+Org-mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure over the
+headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned into a
+table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline tree.
+For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS view
+(`S-<TAB> S-<TAB>', or simply `c' while column view is active), but you
+can still open, read, and edit the entry below each headline. Or, you
+can switch to column view after executing a sparse tree command and in
+this way get a table only for the selected items. Column view also
+works in agenda buffers (*note Agenda Views::) where queries have
+collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
+* Using column view:: How to create and use column view
+* Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
+
+
+File: org, Node: Defining columns, Next: Using column view, Prev: Column view, Up: Column view
+
+7.5.1 Defining columns
+----------------------
+
+Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
+done by defining a column format line.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
+* Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
+
+
+File: org, Node: Scope of column definitions, Next: Column attributes, Prev: Defining columns, Up: Defining columns
+
+7.5.1.1 Scope of column definitions
+...................................
+
+To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
+
+ #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
+
+ To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
+`:COLUMNS:' property to the top node of that tree, for example:
+
+ ** Top node for columns view
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
+ :END:
+
+ If a `:COLUMNS:' property is present in an entry, it defines columns
+for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
+column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
+you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
+sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
+deeper part of the tree.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Column attributes, Prev: Scope of column definitions, Up: Defining columns
+
+7.5.1.2 Column attributes
+.........................
+
+A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
+definition looks like this:
+
+ %[WIDTH]PROPERTY[(TITLE)][{SUMMARY-TYPE}]
+
+Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
+optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
+
+ WIDTH An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.
+ If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.
+ PROPERTY The property that should be edited in this column.
+ Special properties representing meta data are allowed here
+ as well (*note Special properties::)
+ TITLE The header text for the column. If omitted, the property
+ name is used.
+ {SUMMARY-TYPE} The summary type. If specified, the column values for
+ parent nodes are computed from the children.
+ Supported summary types are:
+ {+} Sum numbers in this column.
+ {+;%.1f} Like `+', but format result with `%.1f'.
+ {$} Currency, short for `+;%.2f'.
+ {:} Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.
+ {X} Checkbox status, `[X]' if all children are `[X]'.
+ {X/} Checkbox status, `[n/m]'.
+ {X%} Checkbox status, `[n%]'.
+ {min} Smallest number in column.
+ {max} Largest number.
+ {mean} Arithmetic mean of numbers.
+ {:min} Smallest time value in column.
+ {:max} Largest time value.
+ {:mean} Arithmetic mean of time values.
+ {@min} Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).
+ {@max} Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).
+ {@mean} Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).
+ {est+} Add low-high estimates.
+
+Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
+include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all
+display the same summary information.
+
+ The `est+' summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
+combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
+of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it
+as 5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is
+required, or 1-10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done.
+Both ranges average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more
+predictable delivery.
+
+ When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and
+highs produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, `est+' adds the
+statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final
+estimate from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of
+which was estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition
+produces an estimate of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if
+everything goes either extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast,
+`est+' estimates the full job more realistically, at 10-15 days.
+
+ Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with
+allowed values.
+
+ :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?){X} %Owner %11Status \(1)
+ %10Time_Estimate{:} %CLOCKSUM
+ :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
+ :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
+ :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
+
+The first column, `%25ITEM', means the first 25 characters of the item
+itself, i.e. of the headline. You probably always should start the
+column definition with the `ITEM' specifier. The other specifiers
+create columns `Owner' with a list of names as allowed values, for
+`Status' with four different possible values, and for a checkbox field
+`Approved'. When no width is given after the `%' character, the column
+will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order to fully display all
+values. The `Approved' column does have a modified title (`Approved?',
+with a question mark). Summaries will be created for the
+`Time_Estimate' column by adding time duration expressions like HH:MM,
+and for the `Approved' column, by providing an `[X]' status if all
+children have been checked. The `CLOCKSUM' column is special, it lists
+the sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single
+line--it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Using column view, Next: Capturing column view, Prev: Defining columns, Up: Column view
+
+7.5.2 Using column view
+-----------------------
+
+Turning column view on and off
+..............................
+
+`C-c C-x C-c (`org-columns')'
+ Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline
+ in the file, column view is turned on for the entire file, using
+ the `#+COLUMNS' definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the
+ outline, this command searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a
+ `:COLUMNS:' property that defines a format. When one is found,
+ the column view table is established for the tree starting at the
+ entry that contains the `:COLUMNS:' property. If no such property
+ is found, the format is taken from the `#+COLUMNS' line or from
+ the variable `org-columns-default-format', and column view is
+ established for the current entry and its subtree.
+
+`r (`org-columns-redo')'
+ Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the
+ buffer.
+
+`g (`org-columns-redo')'
+ Same as `r'.
+
+`q (`org-columns-quit')'
+ Exit column view.
+
+Editing values
+..............
+
+`<left> <right> <up> <down>'
+ Move through the column view from field to field.
+
+`S-<left>/<right>'
+ Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this,
+ you have to have specified allowed values for a property.
+
+`1..9,0'
+ Directly select the Nth allowed value, `0' selects the 10th value.
+
+`n (`org-columns-next-allowed-value')'
+`p (`org-columns-previous-allowed-value')'
+ Same as `S-<left>/<right>'
+
+`e (`org-columns-edit-value')'
+ Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
+ invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
+ property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag
+ completion or fast selection interface will pop up.
+
+`C-c C-c (`org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle')'
+ When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
+
+`v (`org-columns-show-value')'
+ View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width
+ of the column is smaller than that of the value.
+
+`a (`org-columns-edit-allowed')'
+ Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is
+ found in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If
+ no list is found, the new value is stored in the first entry that
+ is part of the current column view.
+
+Modifying the table structure
+.............................
+
+`< (`org-columns-narrow')'
+`> (`org-columns-widen')'
+ Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
+
+`S-M-<right> (`org-columns-new')'
+ Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
+
+`S-M-<left> (`org-columns-delete')'
+ Delete the current column.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Capturing column view, Prev: Using column view, Up: Column view
+
+7.5.3 Capturing column view
+---------------------------
+
+Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
+exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
+a `columnview' dynamic block (*note Dynamic blocks::). The frame of
+this block looks like this:
+
+ * The column view
+ #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
+
+ #+END:
+
+This dynamic block has the following parameters:
+
+`:id'
+ This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature
+ that is often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture
+ block might be at a different location in the file. To identify
+ the tree whose view to capture, you can use 4 values:
+ local use the tree in which the capture block is located
+ global make a global view, including all headings in the file
+ "file:PATH-TO-FILE"
+ run column view at the top of this file
+ "ID" call column view in the tree that has an `:ID:'
+ property with the value label. You can use
+ `M-x org-id-copy' to create a globally unique ID for
+ the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.
+
+`:hlines'
+ When `t', insert an hline after every line. When a number N,
+ insert an hline before each headline with level `<= N'.
+
+`:vlines'
+ When set to `t', force column groups to get vertical lines.
+
+`:maxlevel'
+ When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
+
+`:skip-empty-rows'
+ When set to `t', skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of
+ the column view is `ITEM'.
+
+
+The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
+
+`C-c C-x i (`org-insert-columns-dblock')'
+ Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be
+ prompted for the scope or ID of the view.
+
+`C-c C-c or C-c C-x C-u (`org-dblock-update')'
+ Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
+ `#+BEGIN' line of the dynamic block.
+
+`C-u C-c C-x C-u (`org-update-all-dblocks')'
+ Update all dynamic blocks (*note Dynamic blocks::). This is
+ useful if you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing
+ blocks or other dynamic blocks in a buffer.
+
+ You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add
+plotting instructions in front of the table--these will survive an
+update of the block. If there is a `#+TBLFM:' after the table, the
+table will actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
+
+ An alternative way to capture and process property values into a
+table is provided by Eric Schulte's `org-collector.el' which is a
+contributed package(1). It provides a general API to collect
+properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp
+expressions to process these values before inserting them into a table
+or a dynamic block.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are distributed
+with the main distribution of Org (visit `http://orgmode.org').
+
+
+File: org, Node: Property API, Prev: Column view, Up: Properties and Columns
+
+7.6 The Property API
+====================
+
+There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
+be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
+features based on them. For more information see *Note Using the
+property API::.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Dates and Times, Next: Capture - Refile - Archive, Prev: Properties and Columns, Up: Top
+
+8 Dates and times
+*****************
+
+To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
+a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
+information is called a _timestamp_ in Org-mode. This may be a little
+confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when something
+was created or last changed. However, in Org-mode this term is used in
+a much wider sense.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
+* Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
+* Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
+* Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
+* Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
+* Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
+* Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
+
+
+File: org, Node: Timestamps, Next: Creating timestamps, Prev: Dates and Times, Up: Dates and Times
+
+8.1 Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
+=========================================
+
+A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a
+range of times) in a special format, either `<2003-09-16 Tue>' or
+`<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>' or `<2003-09-16 Tue 12:00-12:30>'(1). A
+timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree
+entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in
+the agenda (*note Weekly/daily agenda::). We distinguish:
+
+PLAIN TIMESTAMP; EVENT; APPOINTMENT
+ A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is
+ just like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda.
+ In the timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry
+ associated with a plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that
+ date.
+
+ * Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
+ * Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
+
+TIMESTAMP WITH REPEATER INTERVAL
+ A timestamp may contain a _repeater interval_, indicating that it
+ applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a
+ certain interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years
+ (y). The following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
+
+ * Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
+
+DIARY-STYLE SEXP ENTRIES
+ For more complex date specifications, Org-mode supports using the
+ special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
+ package. For example
+
+ * The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
+ <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
+
+TIME/DATE RANGE
+ Two timestamps connected by `--' denote a range. The headline
+ will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any
+ dates that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an
+ example:
+
+ ** Meeting in Amsterdam
+ <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
+
+INACTIVE TIMESTAMP
+ Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
+ angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that
+ they do _not_ trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
+
+ * Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
+
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601 date/time format. To
+use an alternative format, see *Note Custom time format::.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Creating timestamps, Next: Deadlines and scheduling, Prev: Timestamps, Up: Dates and Times
+
+8.2 Creating timestamps
+=======================
+
+For Org-mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
+format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
+format.
+
+`C-c . (`org-time-stamp')'
+ Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the
+ cursor is at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is
+ used to modify this timestamp instead of inserting a new one.
+ When this command is used twice in succession, a time range is
+ inserted.
+
+`C-c ! (`org-time-stamp-inactive')'
+ Like `C-c .', but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
+ an agenda entry.
+
+`C-u C-c .'
+`C-u C-c !'
+ Like `C-c .' and `C-c !', but use the alternative format which
+ contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to
+ multiples of 5 minutes, see the option
+ `org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes'.
+
+`C-c < (`org-date-from-calendar')'
+ Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the
+ Calendar.
+
+`C-c > (`org-goto-calendar')'
+ Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
+ timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
+ instead.
+
+`C-c C-o (`org-open-at-point')'
+ Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
+ point (*note Weekly/daily agenda::).
+
+`S-<left> (`org-timestamp-down-day')'
+`S-<right> (`org-timestamp-up-day')'
+ Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
+ shift-selection and related modes (*note Conflicts::).
+
+`S-<up> (`org-timestamp-up')'
+`S-<down> (`org-timestamp-down-down')'
+ Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can
+ be on a year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp
+ contains a time range like `15:30-16:30', modifying the first time
+ will also shift the second, shifting the time block with constant
+ length. To change the length, modify the second time. Note that
+ if the cursor is in a headline and not at a timestamp, these same
+ keys modify the priority of an item. (*note Priorities::). The
+ key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and related modes
+ (*note Conflicts::).
+
+`C-c C-y (`org-evaluate-time-range')'
+ Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start
+ and end. With a prefix argument, insert result after the time
+ range (in a table: into the following column).
+
+* Menu:
+
+* The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
+* Custom time format:: Making dates look different
+
+
+File: org, Node: The date/time prompt, Next: Custom time format, Prev: Creating timestamps, Up: Creating timestamps
+
+8.2.1 The date/time prompt
+--------------------------
+
+When Org-mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
+date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
+format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date
+and/or time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your
+input. You can, for example, use `C-y' to paste a (possibly
+multi-line) string copied from an email message. Org-mode will find
+whatever information is in there and derive anything you have not
+specified from the _default date and time_. The default is usually the
+current date and time, but when modifying an existing timestamp, or
+when entering the second stamp of a range, it is taken from the stamp
+in the buffer. When filling in information, Org-mode assumes that most
+of the time you will want to enter a date in the future: if you omit
+the month/year and the given day/month is before today, it will assume
+that you mean a future date(1). If the date has been automatically
+shifted into the future, the time prompt will show this with `(=>F).'
+
+ For example, let's assume that today is June 13, 2006. Here is how
+various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org-mode are
+in bold.
+
+ 3-2-5 --> 2003-02-05
+ 2/5/3 --> 2003-02-05
+ 14 --> 2006-06-14
+ 12 --> 2006-07-12
+ 2/5 --> 2007-02-05
+ Fri --> nearest Friday (default date or later)
+ sep 15 --> 2006-09-15
+ feb 15 --> 2007-02-15
+ sep 12 9 --> 2009-09-12
+ 12:45 --> 2006-06-13 12:45
+ 22 sept 0:34 --> 2006-09-22 0:34
+ w4 --> ISO week for of the current year 2006
+ 2012 w4 fri --> Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
+ 2012-w04-5 --> Same as above
+
+ Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
+_first_ thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a letter
+([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
+single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
+double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
+a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
+the Nth such day. E.g.
+
+ +0 --> today
+ . --> today
+ +4d --> four days from today
+ +4 --> same as above
+ +2w --> two weeks from today
+ ++5 --> five days from default date
+ +2tue --> second Tuesday from now.
+
+ The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
+you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
+the variables `parse-time-months' and `parse-time-weekdays'.
+
+ You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by
+giving a start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use `-' or `-{}-'
+as the separator in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the
+latter case. E.g.
+
+ 11am-1:15pm --> 11:00-13:15
+ 11am--1:15pm --> same as above
+ 11am+2:15 --> same as above
+
+ Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up(2). When
+you exit the date prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar,
+or by pressing <RET>, the date selected in the calendar will be
+combined with the information entered at the prompt. You can control
+the calendar fully from the minibuffer:
+
+ <RET> Choose date at cursor in calendar.
+ mouse-1 Select date by clicking on it.
+ S-<right>/<left> One day forward/backward.
+ S-<down>/<up> One week forward/backward.
+ M-S-<right>/<left> One month forward/backward.
+ > / < Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.
+ M-v / C-v Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.
+
+ The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure
+you they will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty
+much any other way of entering a date/time out there. To help you
+understand what is going on, the current interpretation of your input
+will be displayed live in the minibuffer(3).
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) See the variable `org-read-date-prefer-future'. You may set
+that variable to the symbol `time' to even make a time before now shift
+the date to tomorrow.
+
+ (2) If you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
+`org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt'.
+
+ (3) If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
+`org-read-date-display-live'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Custom time format, Prev: The date/time prompt, Up: Creating timestamps
+
+8.2.2 Custom time format
+------------------------
+
+Org-mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
+defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
+representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
+customizing the variables `org-display-custom-times' and
+`org-time-stamp-custom-formats'.
+
+`C-c C-x C-t (`org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays')'
+ Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
+
+Org-mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
+format does not _replace_ the default format--instead it is put _over_
+the default format using text properties. This has the following
+consequences:
+ * You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before
+ or after.
+
+ * The `S-<up>/<down>' keys can no longer be used to adjust each
+ component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
+ the stamp, `S-<up>/<down>' will change the stamp by one day, just
+ like `S-<left>/<right>'. At the end of the stamp, the time will
+ be changed by one minute.
+
+ * If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater,
+ these will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
+
+ * When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
+ disappear from the buffer after _all_ (invisible) characters
+ belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
+
+ * If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you
+ are using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If
+ the custom format is shorter, things do work as expected.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Deadlines and scheduling, Next: Clocking work time, Prev: Creating timestamps, Up: Dates and Times
+
+8.3 Deadlines and scheduling
+============================
+
+A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
+
+DEADLINE
+ Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not
+ necessarily) is supposed to be finished on that date.
+
+ On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
+ addition, the agenda for _today_ will carry a warning about the
+ approaching or missed deadline, starting
+ `org-deadline-warning-days' before the due date, and continuing
+ until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
+
+ *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
+ The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
+ DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
+
+ You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
+ deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a
+ warning period of 5 days `DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>'.
+
+SCHEDULED
+ Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the
+ given date.
+
+ The headline will be listed under the given date(1). In addition,
+ a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present in
+ the compilation for _today_, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.
+ the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
+
+ *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
+ SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
+
+ Important: Scheduling an item in Org-mode should not be understood
+ in the same way that we understand scheduling a meeting. Setting
+ a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should mark
+ this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
+ on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding
+ by Org users. In Org-mode, scheduling means setting a date when
+ you want to start working on an action item.
+
+ You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
+entries. Org-mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
+assumption that the timestamp represents the nearest instance of the
+repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like `<%%(diary-float
+t 42)>' in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org-mode
+does not know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue
+early and late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day
+where the sexp entry matches.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
+* Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) It will still be listed on that date after it has been marked
+DONE. If you don't like this, set the variable
+`org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Inserting deadline/schedule, Next: Repeated tasks, Prev: Deadlines and scheduling, Up: Deadlines and scheduling
+
+8.3.1 Inserting deadlines or schedules
+--------------------------------------
+
+The following commands allow you to quickly insert a deadline or to
+schedule an item:
+
+`C-c C-d (`org-deadline')'
+ Insert `DEADLINE' keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
+ happen in the line directly following the headline. When called
+ with a prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed from the
+ entry. Depending on the variable `org-log-redeadline'(1), a note
+ will be taken when changing an existing deadline.
+
+`C-c C-s (`org-schedule')'
+ Insert `SCHEDULED' keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
+ happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED
+ timestamp will be removed. When called with a prefix argument,
+ remove the scheduling date from the entry. Depending on the
+ variable `org-log-reschedule'(2), a note will be taken when
+ changing an existing scheduling time.
+
+`C-c C-x C-k (`org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action')'
+ Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked
+ the entry like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to
+ find an appropriate date. With the cursor on the selected date,
+ press `k s' or `k d' to schedule the marked item.
+
+`C-c / d (`org-check-deadlines')'
+ Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due,
+ or which will become due within `org-deadline-warning-days'. With
+ `C-u' prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
+ prefix, check that many days. For example, `C-1 C-c / d' shows
+ all deadlines due tomorrow.
+
+`C-c / b (`org-check-before-date')'
+ Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
+
+`C-c / a (`org-check-after-date')'
+ Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) with corresponding `#+STARTUP' keywords `logredeadline',
+`lognoteredeadline', and `nologredeadline'
+
+ (2) with corresponding `#+STARTUP' keywords `logredeadline',
+`lognoteredeadline', and `nologredeadline'
+
+
+File: org, Node: Repeated tasks, Prev: Inserting deadline/schedule, Up: Deadlines and scheduling
+
+8.3.2 Repeated tasks
+--------------------
+
+Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org-mode helps to
+organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
+or plain timestamp. In the following example
+ ** TODO Pay the rent
+ DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
+ the `+1m' is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
+has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month
+starting from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special
+warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater should come first and
+the warning period last: `DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>'.
+
+ Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when
+they are over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry
+as completed once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a
+SCHEDULE with the TODO keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries
+in the agenda. The problem with this is, however, that then also the
+_next_ instance of the repeated entry will not be active. Org-mode
+deals with this in the following way: When you try to mark such an
+entry DONE (using `C-c C-t'), it will shift the base date of the
+repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and immediately set the
+entry state back to TODO(1). In the example above, setting the state
+to DONE would actually switch the date like this:
+
+ ** TODO Pay the rent
+ DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
+
+ A timestamp(2) will be added under the deadline, to keep a record
+that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
+
+ As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no
+longer be visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all
+future instances will be visible.
+
+ With the `+1m' cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
+month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
+entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
+task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
+forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
+him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
+like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time after
+the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org-mode has special
+repeaters `++' and `.+'. For example:
+
+ ** TODO Call Father
+ DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
+ Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
+ but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
+ the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
+ and marked it done on Saturday.
+ ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
+ DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
+ Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
+ today.
+
+ You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
+task--just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
+
+ An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies
+of a task subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command `C-c
+C-x c' was created for this purpose, it is described in *Note Structure
+editing::.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) In fact, the target state is taken from, in this sequence, the
+`REPEAT_TO_STATE' property or the variable `org-todo-repeat-to-state'.
+If neither of these is specified, the target state defaults to the
+first state of the TODO state sequence.
+
+ (2) You can change this using the option `org-log-repeat', or the
+`#+STARTUP' options `logrepeat', `lognoterepeat', and `nologrepeat'.
+With `lognoterepeat', you will also be prompted for a note.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Clocking work time, Next: Effort estimates, Prev: Deadlines and scheduling, Up: Dates and Times
+
+8.4 Clocking work time
+======================
+
+Org-mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
+project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock.
+When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the
+clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It
+also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project. And it
+remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump
+quickly between a number of tasks absorbing your time.
+
+ To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
+ (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
+ (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
+ When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
+clock(1) will be found (*note Resolving idle time::) and you will be
+prompted about what to do with it.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
+* The clock table:: Detailed reports
+* Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked on
+this task while outside Emacs, use `(setq org-clock-persist t)'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Clocking commands, Next: The clock table, Prev: Clocking work time, Up: Clocking work time
+
+8.4.1 Clocking commands
+-----------------------
+
+`C-c C-x C-i (`org-clock-in')'
+ Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the
+ CLOCK keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first
+ clocking of this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped
+ into a `:LOGBOOK:' drawer (see also the variable
+ `org-clock-into-drawer'). When called with a `C-u' prefix
+ argument, select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
+ With two `C-u C-u' prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark
+ it as the default task. The default task will always be available
+ when selecting a clocking task, with letter `d'.
+ While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in
+ the mode line, along with the title of the task. The clock time
+ shown will be all time ever clocked for this task and its
+ children. If the task has an effort estimate (*note Effort
+ estimates::), the mode line displays the current clocking time
+ against it(1) If the task is a repeating one (*note Repeated
+ tasks::), only the time since the last reset of the task (2) will
+ be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised
+ with the `CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL' property. It may have the values
+ `current' to show only the current clocking instance, `today' to
+ show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
+ `org-extend-today-until'), `all' to include all time, or `auto'
+ which is the default(3).
+ Clicking with `mouse-1' onto the mode line entry will pop up a
+ menu with clocking options.
+
+`C-c C-x C-o (`org-clock-out')'
+ Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the
+ same location where the clock was last started. It also directly
+ computes the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as
+ `=> HH:MM'. See the variable `org-log-note-clock-out' for the
+ possibility to record an additional note together with the
+ clock-out timestamp(4).
+
+`C-c C-x C-e (`org-clock-modify-effort-estimate')'
+ Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
+
+`C-c C-c or C-c C-y (`org-evaluate-time-range')'
+ Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps.
+ This is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If
+ you change them with `S-<cursor>' keys, the update is automatic.
+
+`C-c C-t (`org-todo')'
+ Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the
+ clock if it is running in this same item.
+
+`C-c C-x C-x (`org-clock-cancel')'
+ Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
+ mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
+
+`C-c C-x C-j (`org-clock-goto')'
+ Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a
+ `C-u' prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently
+ clocked tasks.
+
+`C-c C-x C-d (`org-clock-display')'
+ Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer.
+ This puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total
+ time recorded under that heading, including the time of any
+ subheadings. You can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but
+ the overlays disappear when you change the buffer (see variable
+ `org-remove-highlights-with-change') or press `C-c C-c'.
+
+ The `l' key may be used in the timeline (*note Timeline::) and in
+the agenda (*note Weekly/daily agenda::) to show which tasks have been
+worked on or closed during a day.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) To add an effort estimate "on the fly", hook a function doing
+this to `org-clock-in-prepare-hook'.
+
+ (2) as recorded by the `LAST_REPEAT' property
+
+ (3) See also the variable `org-clock-modeline-total'.
+
+ (4) The corresponding in-buffer setting is: `#+STARTUP:
+lognoteclock-out'
+
+
+File: org, Node: The clock table, Next: Resolving idle time, Prev: Clocking commands, Up: Clocking work time
+
+8.4.2 The clock table
+---------------------
+
+Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
+information. Such a report is called a _clock table_, because it is
+formatted as one or several Org tables.
+
+`C-c C-x C-r (`org-clock-report')'
+ Insert a dynamic block (*note Dynamic blocks::) containing a clock
+ report as an Org-mode table into the current file. When the
+ cursor is at an existing clock table, just update it. When called
+ with a prefix argument, jump to the first clock report in the
+ current document and update it.
+
+`C-c C-c or C-c C-x C-u (`org-dblock-update')'
+ Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
+ `#+BEGIN' line of the dynamic block.
+
+`C-u C-c C-x C-u'
+ Update all dynamic blocks (*note Dynamic blocks::). This is
+ useful if you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
+
+`S-<left>'
+`S-<right> (`org-clocktable-try-shift')'
+ Shift the current `:block' interval and update the table. The
+ cursor needs to be in the `#+BEGIN: clocktable' line for this
+ command. If `:block' is `today', it will be shifted to `today-1'
+ etc.
+
+ Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted
+into the buffer with the `C-c C-x C-r' command:
+
+ #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
+ #+END: clocktable
+ The `BEGIN' line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
+structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these
+options can be configured in the variable `org-clocktable-defaults'.
+
+First there are options that determine which clock entries are to be
+selected:
+ :maxlevel Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.
+ Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.
+ :scope The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:
+ nil the current buffer or narrowed region
+ file the full current buffer
+ subtree the subtree where the clocktable is located
+ treeN the surrounding level N tree, for example `tree3'
+ tree the surrounding level 1 tree
+ agenda all agenda files
+ ("file"..) scan these files
+ file-with-archives current file and its archives
+ agenda-with-archives all agenda files, including archives
+ :block The time block to consider. This block is specified either
+ absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of
+ these formats:
+ 2007-12-31 New year eve 2007
+ 2007-12 December 2007
+ 2007-W50 ISO-week 50 in 2007
+ 2007-Q2 2nd quarter in 2007
+ 2007 the year 2007
+ today, yesterday, today-N a relative day
+ thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-N a relative week
+ thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-N a relative month
+ thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-N a relative year
+ Use `S-<left>/<right>' keys to shift the time interval.
+ :tstart A time string specifying when to start considering times.
+ :tend A time string specifying when to stop considering times.
+ :step `week' or `day', to split the table into chunks.
+ To use this, `:block' or `:tstart', `:tend' are needed.
+ :stepskip0 Do not show steps that have zero time.
+ :fileskip0 Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.
+ :tags A tags match to select entries that should contribute.
+
+ Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table.
+There options are interpreted by the function
+`org-clocktable-write-default', but you can specify your own function
+using the `:formatter' parameter.
+ :emphasize When `t', emphasize level one and level two items.
+ :link Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.
+ :narrow An integer to limit the width of the headline column in
+ the org table. If you write it like `50!', then the
+ headline will also be shortened in export.
+ :indent Indent each headline field according to its level.
+ :tcolumns Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller
+ than `:maxlevel', lower levels will be lumped into one column.
+ :level Should a level number column be included?
+ :compact Abbreviation for `:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1'
+ All are overwritten except if there is an explicit `:narrow'
+ :timestamp A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,
+ DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.
+ :formula Content of a `#+TBLFM' line to be added and evaluated.
+ As a special case, `:formula %' adds a column with % time.
+ If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula
+ below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.
+ :formatter A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.
+ To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
+day, you could write
+ #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
+ #+END: clocktable
+ and to use a specific time range you could write(1)
+ #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
+ :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
+ #+END: clocktable
+ A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
+ #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
+ #+END: clocktable
+ A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during
+last week would be
+ #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
+ #+END: clocktable
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Note that all parameters must be specified in a single line--the
+line is broken here only to fit it into the manual.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Resolving idle time, Prev: The clock table, Up: Clocking work time
+
+8.4.3 Resolving idle time
+-------------------------
+
+If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
+computer--perhaps to take a phone call--you often need to "resolve" the
+time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
+applying it to another one.
+
+ By customizing the variable `org-clock-idle-time' to some integer,
+such as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your
+computer after being idle for that many minutes(1), and ask what you
+want to do with the idle time. There will be a question waiting for
+you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has passed
+(constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of
+choices to correct the discrepancy:
+
+`k'
+ To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press `k'.
+ Org will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press <RET> to
+ keep them all, effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to
+ keep that many minutes.
+
+`K'
+ If you use the shift key and press `K', it will keep however many
+ minutes you request and then immediately clock out of that task.
+ If you keep all of the minutes, this is the same as just clocking
+ out of the current task.
+
+`s'
+ To keep none of the minutes, use `s' to subtract all the away time
+ from the clock, and then check back in from the moment you
+ returned.
+
+`S'
+ To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the
+ away time, use the shift key and press `S'. Remember that using
+ shift will always leave you clocked out, no matter which option
+ you choose.
+
+`C'
+ To cancel the clock altogether, use `C'. Note that if instead of
+ canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock
+ amount is less than a minute, the clock will still be canceled
+ rather than clutter up the log with an empty entry.
+
+ What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock,
+and now want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task
+immediately after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have
+subtracted time "on the books", so to speak, and will ask if you want
+to apply those minutes to the next task you clock in on.
+
+ There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs.
+Say you were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased
+a mouse who scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button!
+You suddenly lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still
+have your recent Org mode changes, including your last clock in.
+
+ If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that
+you have a dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last
+session. Using that clock's starting time as the beginning of the
+unaccounted-for period, Org will ask how you want to resolve that time.
+The logic and behavior is identical to dealing with away time due to
+idleness; it's just happening due to a recovery event rather than a set
+amount of idle time.
+
+ You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for
+dangling clocks at any time using `M-x org-resolve-clocks'.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) On computers using Mac OS X, idleness is based on actual user
+idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For X11, you can install a
+utility program `x11idle.c', available in the UTILITIES directory of
+the Org git distribution, to get the same general treatment of
+idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time only.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Effort estimates, Next: Relative timer, Prev: Clocking work time, Up: Dates and Times
+
+8.5 Effort estimates
+====================
+
+If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
+produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may
+want to assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking
+your work, you may later want to compare the planned effort with the
+actual working time, a great way to improve planning estimates. Effort
+estimates are stored in a special property `Effort'(1). You can set
+the effort for an entry with the following commands:
+
+`C-c C-x e (`org-set-effort')'
+ Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric
+ prefix argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below).
+ This command is also accessible from the agenda with the `e' key.
+
+`C-c C-x C-e (`org-clock-modify-effort-estimate')'
+ Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
+
+ Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column
+view (*note Column view::). You should start by setting up discrete
+values for effort estimates, and a `COLUMNS' format that displays these
+values together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For
+a specific buffer you can use
+
+ #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 8:00
+ #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort){:} %CLOCKSUM
+
+or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
+variables `org-global-properties' and `org-columns-default-format'. In
+particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
+setup may be advised.
+
+ The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to
+column mode, and to use `S-<right>' and `S-<left>' to change the value.
+The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
+In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
+
+ If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort
+column will summarize the estimated work effort for each day(2), and
+you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get an overview of
+the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the option
+`org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum'. The appointments
+on a day that take place over a specified time interval will then also
+be added to the load estimate of the day.
+
+ Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is
+triggered with the `/' key in the agenda (*note Agenda commands::). If
+you have these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses
+will narrow down the list to stuff that fits into an available time
+slot.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) You may change the property being used with the variable
+`org-effort-property'.
+
+ (2) Please note the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat
+list (*note Agenda column view::).
+
+
+File: org, Node: Relative timer, Next: Countdown timer, Prev: Effort estimates, Up: Dates and Times
+
+8.6 Taking notes with a relative timer
+======================================
+
+When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it
+can be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org
+provides such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
+
+`C-c C-x . (`org-timer')'
+ Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use
+ this, the timer will be started. When called with a prefix
+ argument, the timer is restarted.
+
+`C-c C-x - (`org-timer-item')'
+ Insert a description list item with the current relative time.
+ With a prefix argument, first reset the timer to 0.
+
+`M-<RET> (`org-insert-heading')'
+ Once the timer list is started, you can also use `M-<RET>' to
+ insert new timer items.
+
+`C-c C-x ,'
+ Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
+ (`org-timer-pause-or-continue').
+
+`C-u C-c C-x ,'
+ Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not
+ continue the old one. This command also removes the timer from
+ the mode line.
+
+`C-c C-x 0 (`org-timer-start')'
+ Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By
+ default, the timer is reset to 0. When called with a `C-u'
+ prefix, reset the timer to specific starting offset. The user is
+ prompted for the offset, with a default taken from a timer string
+ at point, if any, So this can be used to restart taking notes
+ after a break in the process. When called with a double prefix
+ argument `C-u C-u', change all timer strings in the active region
+ by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the
+ timer was not started at exactly the right moment.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Countdown timer, Prev: Relative timer, Up: Dates and Times
+
+8.7 Countdown timer
+===================
+
+Calling `org-timer-set-timer' from an Org-mode buffer runs a countdown
+timer. Use <;> from agenda buffers, <C-c C-x ;> everwhere else.
+
+ `org-timer-set-timer' prompts the user for a duration and displays a
+countdown timer in the modeline. `org-timer-default-timer' sets the
+default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides
+this default value.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Capture - Refile - Archive, Next: Agenda Views, Prev: Dates and Times, Up: Top
+
+9 Capture - Refile - Archive
+****************************
+
+An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
+capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with
+them. Org does this using a process called capture. It also can store
+files related to a task (attachments) in a special directory. Once in
+the system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving
+completed project trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and
+fast.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Capture:: Capturing new stuff
+* Attachments:: Add files to tasks
+* RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
+* Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
+* Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
+* Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
+
+
+File: org, Node: Capture, Next: Attachments, Prev: Capture - Refile - Archive, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive
+
+9.1 Capture
+===========
+
+Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
+excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
+for `remember.el'. `org-remember.el' is still part of Org-mode for
+backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the
+documentation for org-remember at `http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf'.
+
+ The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be
+used by new users. To convert your `org-remember-templates', run the
+command
+ M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates <RET>
+ and then customize the new variable with `M-x customize-variable
+org-capture-templates', check the result, and save the customization.
+You can then use both remember and capture until you are familiar with
+the new mechanism.
+
+ Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of
+your work flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to
+remember, but Org does enhance it with templates and more.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
+* Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
+* Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
+
+
+File: org, Node: Setting up capture, Next: Using capture, Prev: Capture, Up: Capture
+
+9.1.1 Setting up capture
+------------------------
+
+The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and
+defines a global key(1) for capturing new material.
+
+ (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
+ (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Please select your own key, `C-c c' is only a suggestion.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Using capture, Next: Capture templates, Prev: Setting up capture, Up: Capture
+
+9.1.2 Using capture
+-------------------
+
+`C-c c (`org-capture')'
+ Call the command `org-capture'. Note that this keybinding is
+ global and not active by default - you need to install it. If you
+ have templates defined *note Capture templates::, it will offer
+ these templates for selection or use a new Org outline node as the
+ default template. It will insert the template into the target
+ file and switch to an indirect buffer narrowed to this new node.
+ You may then insert the information you want.
+
+`C-c C-c (`org-capture-finalize')'
+ Once you have finished entering information into the capture
+ buffer, `C-c C-c' will return you to the window configuration
+ before the capture process, so that you can resume your work
+ without further distraction. When called with a prefix arg,
+ finalize and then jump to the captured item.
+
+`C-c C-w (`org-capture-refile')'
+ Finalize the capture process by refiling (*note Refiling notes::)
+ the note to a different place. Please realize that this is a
+ normal refiling command that will be executed--so the cursor
+ position at the moment you run this command is important. If you
+ have inserted a tree with a parent and children, first move the
+ cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument given to this
+ command will be passed on to the `org-refile' command.
+
+`C-c C-k (`org-capture-kill')'
+ Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
+
+
+ You can also call `org-capture' in a special way from the agenda,
+using the `k c' key combination. With this access, any timestamps
+inserted by the selected capture template will default to the cursor
+date in the agenda, rather than to the current date.
+
+ To find the locations of the last stored capture, use `org-capture'
+with prefix commands:
+
+`C-u C-c c'
+ Visit the target location of a cpature template. You get to
+ select the template in the usual way.
+
+`C-u C-u C-c c'
+ Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Capture templates, Prev: Using capture, Up: Capture
+
+9.1.3 Capture templates
+-----------------------
+
+You can use templates for different types of capture items, and for
+different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
+through the customize interface.
+
+`C-c c C'
+ Customize the variable `org-capture-templates'.
+
+ Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's
+look at an example. Say you would like to use one template to create
+general TODO entries, and you want to put these entries under the
+heading `Tasks' in your file `~/org/gtd.org'. Also, a date tree in the
+file `journal.org' should capture journal entries. A possible
+configuration would look like:
+
+ (setq org-capture-templates
+ '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
+ "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
+ ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
+ "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
+
+If you then press `C-c c t', Org will prepare the template for you like
+this:
+ * TODO
+ [[file:LINK TO WHERE YOU INITIATED CAPTURE]]
+
+During expansion of the template, `%a' has been replaced by a link to
+the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
+extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill
+in the task definition, press `C-c C-c' and Org returns you to the same
+place where you started the capture process.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
+* Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
+
+
+File: org, Node: Template elements, Next: Template expansion, Prev: Capture templates, Up: Capture templates
+
+9.1.3.1 Template elements
+.........................
+
+Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
+`org-capture-templates' is a list with the following items:
+
+KEYS
+ The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
+ only, for example `"a"' for a template to be selected with a
+ single key, or `"bt"' for selection with two keys. When using
+ several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential in
+ the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the prefix
+ key, for example
+ ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
+ If you do not define a template for the `C' key, this key will be
+ used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
+
+DESCRIPTION
+ A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
+ selection.
+
+TYPE
+ The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
+ `entry'
+ An Org-mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child
+ of the target entry or as a top-level entry. The target file
+ should be an Org-mode file.
+
+ `item'
+ A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the
+ target location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
+
+ `checkitem'
+ A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item
+ by the default template.
+
+ `table-line'
+ a new line in the first table at the target location. Where
+ exactly the line will be inserted depends on the properties
+ `:prepend' and `:table-line-pos' (see below).
+
+ `plain'
+ Text to be inserted as it is.
+
+TARGET
+ Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In
+ Org-mode files, targets usually define a node. Entries will
+ become children of this node. Other types will be added to the
+ table or list in the body of this node. Most target
+ specifications contain a file name. If that file name is the
+ empty string, it defaults to `org-default-notes-file'.
+
+ Valid values are:
+ `(file "path/to/file")'
+ Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
+
+ `(id "id of existing org entry")'
+ Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
+
+ `(file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")'
+ Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the
+ file.
+
+ `(file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)'
+ For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
+
+ `(file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")'
+ Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
+
+ `(file+datetree "path/to/file")'
+ Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
+
+ `(file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")'
+ Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the
+ date.
+
+ `(file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)'
+ A function to find the right location in the file.
+
+ `(clock)'
+ File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
+
+ `(function function-finding-location)'
+ Most general way, write your own function to find both file
+ and location.
+
+TEMPLATE
+ The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this
+ empty, an appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise
+ this is a string with escape codes, which will be replaced
+ depending on time and context of the capture call. The string
+ with escapes may be loaded from a template file, using the special
+ syntax `(file "path/to/template")'. See below for more details.
+
+PROPERTIES
+ The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
+ Recognized properties are:
+ `:prepend'
+ Normally new captured information will be appended at the
+ target location (last child, last table line, last list
+ item...). Setting this property will change that.
+
+ `:immediate-finish'
+ When set, do not offer to edit the information, just file it
+ away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
+ information that can be added automatically.
+
+ `:empty-lines'
+ Set this to the number of lines to insert before and after
+ the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
+
+ `:clock-in'
+ Start the clock in this item.
+
+ `:clock-resume'
+ If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that
+ clock when finished with the capture.
+
+ `:unnarrowed'
+ Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer.
+ Default is to narrow it so that you only see the new
+ material.
+
+ `:kill-buffer'
+ If the target file was not yet visited when capture was
+ invoked, kill the buffer again after capture is completed.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Template expansion, Prev: Template elements, Up: Capture templates
+
+9.1.3.2 Template expansion
+..........................
+
+In the template itself, special `%'-escapes(1) allow dynamic insertion
+of content:
+
+ %^{PROMPT} prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.
+ You may specify a default value and a completion table with
+ %^{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...}
+ The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.
+ %a annotation, normally the link created with `org-store-link'
+ %A like `%a', but prompt for the description part
+ %i initial content, the region when capture is called while the
+ region is active.
+ The entire text will be indented like `%i' itself.
+ %t timestamp, date only
+ %T timestamp with date and time
+ %u, %U like the above, but inactive timestamps
+ %^t like `%t', but prompt for date. Similarly `%^T', `%^u', `%^U'
+ You may define a prompt like `%^{Birthday}t'
+ %n user name (taken from `user-full-name')
+ %c Current kill ring head.
+ %x Content of the X clipboard.
+ %^C Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.
+ %^L Like `%^C', but insert as link.
+ %k title of the currently clocked task
+ %K link to the currently clocked task
+ %^g prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.
+ %^G prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.
+ %^{PROP}p Prompt the user for a value for property PROP
+ %:keyword specific information for certain link types, see below
+ %[FILE] insert the contents of the file given by FILE
+ %(SEXP) evaluate Elisp SEXP and replace with the result
+
+For specific link types, the following keywords will be defined(2):
+
+ Link type | Available keywords
+ -------------------+----------------------------------------------
+ bbdb | %:name %:company
+ irc | %:server %:port %:nick
+ vm, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
+ | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
+ | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
+ | %:date (message date header field)
+ | %:date-timestamp (date as active timestamp)
+ | %:date-timestamp-inactive (date as inactive timestamp)
+ | %:fromto (either "to NAME" or "from NAME")(3)
+ gnus | %:group, for messages also all email fields
+ w3, w3m | %:url
+ info | %:file %:node
+ calendar | %:date
+
+To place the cursor after template expansion use:
+
+ %? After completing the template, position cursor here.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) If you need one of these sequences literally, escape the `%'
+with a backslash.
+
+ (2) If you define your own link types (*note Adding hyperlink
+types::), any property you store with `org-store-link-props' can be
+accessed in capture templates in a similar way.
+
+ (3) This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable
+`org-from-is-user-regexp'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Attachments, Next: RSS Feeds, Prev: Capture, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive
+
+9.2 Attachments
+===============
+
+It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline
+node/task. Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the
+subtree of a project. Hyperlinks (*note Hyperlinks::) can establish
+associations with files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the
+cloud, like emails or source code files belonging to a project.
+Another method is attachments, which are files located in a directory
+belonging to an outline node. Org uses directories named by the unique
+ID of each entry. These directories are located in the `data'
+directory which lives in the same directory where your Org file
+lives(1). If you initialize this directory with `git init', Org will
+automatically commit changes when it sees them. The attachment system
+has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
+
+ In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a
+directory of your choice to an entry. You can also make children
+inherit the attachment directory from a parent, so that an entire
+subtree uses the same attached directory.
+
+The following commands deal with attachments:
+
+`C-c C-a (`org-attach')'
+ The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system.
+ After these keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must
+ press an additional key to select a command:
+
+ `a (`org-attach-attach')'
+ Select a file and move it into the task's attachment
+ directory. The file will be copied, moved, or linked,
+ depending on `org-attach-method'. Note that hard links are
+ not supported on all systems.
+
+ `c/m/l'
+ Attach a file using the copy/move/link method. Note that
+ hard links are not supported on all systems.
+
+ `n (`org-attach-new')'
+ Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
+
+ `z (`org-attach-sync')'
+ Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory,
+ in case you added attachments yourself.
+
+ `p (`org-attach-open')'
+ Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one,
+ prompt for a file name first. Opening will follow the rules
+ set by `org-file-apps'. For more details, see the
+ information on following hyperlinks (*note Handling links::).
+
+ `O (`org-attach-open-in-emacs')'
+ Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
+
+ `f (`org-attach-reveal')'
+ Open the current task's attachment directory.
+
+ `F (`org-attach-reveal-in-emacs')'
+ Also open the directory, but force using `dired' in Emacs.
+
+ `d (`org-attach-delete-one')'
+ Select and delete a single attachment.
+
+ `D (`org-attach-delete-all')'
+ Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open
+ the directory in `dired' and delete from there.
+
+ `s (`org-attach-set-directory')'
+ Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory.
+ This works by putting the directory path into the
+ `ATTACH_DIR' property.
+
+ `i (`org-attach-set-inherit')'
+ Set the `ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT' property, so that children will
+ use the same directory for attachments as the parent does.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) If you move entries or Org files from one directory to another,
+you may want to configure `org-attach-directory' to contain an absolute
+path.
+
+
+File: org, Node: RSS Feeds, Next: Protocols, Prev: Attachments, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive
+
+9.3 RSS feeds
+=============
+
+Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds
+and Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new
+podcast in a podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based
+note-creating service on the web to import tasks into Org. To access
+feeds, configure the variable `org-feed-alist'. The docstring of this
+variable has detailed information. Here is just an example:
+
+ (setq org-feed-alist
+ '(("Slashdot"
+ "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
+ "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
+
+will configure that new items from the feed provided by
+`rss.slashdot.org' will result in new entries in the file
+`~/org/feeds.org' under the heading `Slashdot Entries', whenever the
+following command is used:
+
+`C-c C-x g (`org-feed-update-all')'
+
+`C-c C-x g'
+ Collect items from the feeds configured in `org-feed-alist' and
+ act upon them.
+
+`C-c C-x G (`org-feed-goto-inbox')'
+ Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this
+ feed.
+
+ Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer `FEEDSTATUS' in
+which it will store information about the status of items in the feed,
+to avoid adding the same item several times. You should add
+`FEEDSTATUS' to the list of drawers in that file:
+
+ #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
+
+ For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
+`org-feed.el' and the docstring of `org-feed-alist'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Protocols, Next: Refiling notes, Prev: RSS Feeds, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive
+
+9.4 Protocols for external access
+=================================
+
+You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside
+applications that are passed to Emacs through the `emacsserver'. For
+example, you can configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link
+to the current page to Org and create a note from it using capture
+(*note Capture::). Or you could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs
+to open the local source file of a remote website you are looking at
+with the browser. See
+`http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php' for detailed
+documentation and setup instructions.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Refiling notes, Next: Archiving, Prev: Protocols, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive
+
+9.5 Refiling notes
+==================
+
+When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the
+entries into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting,
+finding the right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome.
+To simplify this process, you can use the following special command:
+
+`C-c C-w (`org-refile')'
+ Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible
+ locations for refiling the entry and lets you select one with
+ completion. The item (or all items in the region) is filed below
+ the target heading as a subitem. Depending on
+ `org-reverse-note-order', it will be either the first or last
+ subitem.
+ By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are
+ considered to be targets, but you can have more complex
+ definitions across a number of files. See the variable
+ `org-refile-targets' for details. If you would like to select a
+ location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path,
+ see the variables `org-refile-use-outline-path' and
+ `org-outline-path-complete-in-steps'. If you would like to be
+ able to create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly,
+ check the variable `org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes'. When
+ the variable `org-log-refile'(1) is set, a time stamp or a note
+ will be recorded when an entry has been refiled.
+
+`C-u C-c C-w'
+ Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
+
+`C-u C-u C-c C-w (`org-refile-goto-last-stored')'
+ Jump to the location where `org-refile' last moved a tree to.
+
+`C-2 C-c C-w'
+ Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
+
+`C-0 C-c C-w or C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w'
+
+`C-0 C-c C-w or C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w (`org-refile-cache-clear')'
+ Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned
+ on by setting `org-refile-use-cache'. To make the command see new
+ possible targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) with corresponding `#+STARTUP' keywords `logrefile',
+`lognoterefile', and `nologrefile'
+
+
+File: org, Node: Archiving, Prev: Refiling notes, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive
+
+9.6 Archiving
+=============
+
+When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want to
+move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
+agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and
+global searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
+
+`C-c C-x C-a (`org-archive-subtree-default')'
+ Archive the current entry using the command specified in the
+ variable `org-archive-default-command'.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
+* Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
+
+
+File: org, Node: Moving subtrees, Next: Internal archiving, Prev: Archiving, Up: Archiving
+
+9.6.1 Moving a tree to the archive file
+---------------------------------------
+
+The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another
+file, the archive file.
+
+`C-c C-x C-s or short C-c $ (`org-archive-subtree')'
+ Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
+ given by `org-archive-location'.
+
+`C-u C-c C-x C-s'
+ Check if any direct children of the current headline could be
+ moved to the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for
+ open TODO entries. If none are found, the command offers to move
+ it to the archive location. If the cursor is _not_ on a headline
+ when this command is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
+
+ The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
+current file, with the name derived by appending `_archive' to the
+current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
+see the documentation string of the variable `org-archive-location'.
+There is also an in-buffer option for setting this variable, for
+example(1):
+
+ #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
+
+If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
+or a (sub)tree, give the entry an `:ARCHIVE:' property with the
+location as the value (*note Properties and Columns::).
+
+ When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties
+that record context information like the file from where the entry
+came, its outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
+`org-archive-save-context-info' to adjust the amount of information
+added.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) For backward compatibility, the following also works: If there
+are several such lines in a file, each specifies the archive location
+for the text below it. The first such line also applies to any text
+before its definition. However, using this method is _strongly_
+deprecated as it is incompatible with the outline structure of the
+document. The correct method for setting multiple archive locations in
+a buffer is using properties.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Internal archiving, Prev: Moving subtrees, Up: Archiving
+
+9.6.2 Internal archiving
+------------------------
+
+If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees
+without moving them to a different file, you can use the `ARCHIVE tag'.
+
+ A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (*note Tags::) stays
+at its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
+ - It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility
+ cycling command (*note Visibility cycling::). You can force
+ cycling archived subtrees with `C-<TAB>', or by setting the option
+ `org-cycle-open-archived-trees'. Also normal outline commands like
+ `show-all' will open archived subtrees.
+
+ - During sparse tree construction (*note Sparse trees::), matches in
+ archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
+ `org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees'.
+
+ - During agenda view construction (*note Agenda Views::), the
+ content of archived trees is ignored unless you configure the
+ option `org-agenda-skip-archived-trees', in which case these trees
+ will always be included. In the agenda you can press `v a' to get
+ archives temporarily included.
+
+ - Archived trees are not exported (*note Exporting::), only the
+ headline is. Configure the details using the variable
+ `org-export-with-archived-trees'.
+
+ - Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
+ `org-columns-skip-archived-trees' is configured to `nil'.
+
+ The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
+
+`C-c C-x a (`org-toggle-archive-tag')'
+ Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is
+ set, the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree
+ below it is hidden.
+
+`C-u C-c C-x a'
+ Check if any direct children of the current headline should be
+ archived. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO
+ entries. If none are found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE
+ tag for the child. If the cursor is _not_ on a headline when this
+ command is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
+
+`C-TAB (`org-force-cycle-archived')'
+ Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
+
+`C-c C-x A (`org-archive-to-archive-sibling')'
+ Move the current entry to the _Archive Sibling_. This is a
+ sibling of the entry with the heading `Archive' and the tag
+ `ARCHIVE'. The entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this
+ way retains a lot of its original context, including inherited
+ tags and approximate position in the outline.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Agenda Views, Next: Markup, Prev: Capture - Refile - Archive, Up: Top
+
+10 Agenda views
+***************
+
+Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and tagged
+headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of files.
+To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
+important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
+sorted and displayed in an organized way.
+
+ Org can select items based on various criteria and display them in a
+separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
+
+ * an _agenda_ that is like a calendar and shows information for
+ specific dates,
+
+ * a _TODO list_ that covers all unfinished action items,
+
+ * a _match view_, showings headlines based on the tags, properties,
+ and TODO state associated with them,
+
+ * a _timeline view_ that shows all events in a single Org file, in
+ time-sorted view,
+
+ * a _text search view_ that shows all entries from multiple files
+ that contain specified keywords,
+
+ * a _stuck projects view_ showing projects that currently don't move
+ along, and
+
+ * _custom views_ that are special searches and combinations of
+ different views.
+
+The extracted information is displayed in a special _agenda buffer_.
+This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
+corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to edit
+these files remotely.
+
+ Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether
+the window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
+`org-agenda-window-setup' and `org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit'.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
+* Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
+* Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
+* Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
+* Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
+* Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
+* Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
+* Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
+
+
+File: org, Node: Agenda files, Next: Agenda dispatcher, Prev: Agenda Views, Up: Agenda Views
+
+10.1 Agenda files
+=================
+
+The information to be shown is normally collected from all _agenda
+files_, the files listed in the variable `org-agenda-files'(1). If a
+directory is part of this list, all files with the extension `.org' in
+this directory will be part of the list.
+
+ Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
+be put into the list(2). You can customize `org-agenda-files', but the
+easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
+
+`C-c [ (`org-agenda-to-front')'
+ Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
+ the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved
+ to the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the
+ end.
+
+`C-c ] (`org-remove-file')'
+ Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
+
+`C-' (`org-cycle-agenda-files')'
+`C-,'
+ Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
+
+`M-x org-iswitchb'
+ Command to use an `iswitchb'-like interface to switch to and
+ between Org buffers.
+
+The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used to
+visit any of them.
+
+ If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
+this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree
+in a file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single
+agenda command, you may press `<' once or several times in the
+dispatcher (*note Agenda dispatcher::). To restrict the agenda scope
+for an extended period, use the following commands:
+
+`C-c C-x < (`org-agenda-set-restriction-lock')'
+ Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with
+ a prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in
+ a file, the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This
+ restriction remains in effect until removed with `C-c C-x >', or
+ by typing either `<' or `>' in the agenda dispatcher. If there is
+ a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
+ effect immediately.
+
+`C-c C-x > (`org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock')'
+ Remove the permanent restriction created by `C-c C-x <'.
+
+When working with `speedbar.el', you can use the following commands in
+the Speedbar frame:
+`< in the speedbar frame (`org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction')'
+ Permanently restrict the agenda to the item--either an Org file or
+ a subtree in such a file--at the cursor in the Speedbar frame. If
+ there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction
+ takes effect immediately.
+
+`> in the speedbar frame (`org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock')'
+ Lift the restriction.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) If the value of that variable is not a list, but a single file
+name, then the list of agenda files will be maintained in that external
+file.
+
+ (2) When using the dispatcher, pressing `<' before selecting a
+command will actually limit the command to the current file, and ignore
+`org-agenda-files' until the next dispatcher command.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Agenda dispatcher, Next: Built-in agenda views, Prev: Agenda files, Up: Agenda Views
+
+10.2 The agenda dispatcher
+==========================
+
+The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
+global key--for example `C-c a' (*note Installation::). In the
+following we will assume that `C-c a' is indeed how the dispatcher is
+accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
+pressing `C-c a', an additional letter is required to execute a
+command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
+`a'
+ Create the calendar-like agenda (*note Weekly/daily agenda::).
+
+`t / T'
+ Create a list of all TODO items (*note Global TODO list::).
+
+`m / M'
+ Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (*note
+ Matching tags and properties::).
+
+`L'
+ Create the timeline view for the current buffer (*note Timeline::).
+
+`s'
+ Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of
+ keywords and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in
+ the entry.
+
+`/'
+ Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and
+ additionally in the files listed in
+ `org-agenda-text-search-extra-files'. This uses the Emacs command
+ `multi-occur'. A prefix argument can be used to specify the
+ number of context lines for each match, default is 1.
+
+`# / !'
+ Create a list of stuck projects (*note Stuck projects::).
+
+`<'
+ Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer(1). After
+ pressing `<', you still need to press the character selecting the
+ command.
+
+`< <'
+ If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda
+ command to the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current
+ subtree(2). After pressing `< <', you still need to press the
+ character selecting the command.
+
+ You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through
+the dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
+possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
+blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
+a number of special tags matches. *Note Custom agenda views::.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) For backward compatibility, you can also press `1' to restrict
+to the current buffer.
+
+ (2) For backward compatibility, you can also press `0' to restrict
+to the current region/subtree.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Built-in agenda views, Next: Presentation and sorting, Prev: Agenda dispatcher, Up: Agenda Views
+
+10.3 The built-in agenda views
+==============================
+
+In this section we describe the built-in views.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
+* Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
+* Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
+* Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
+* Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
+* Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
+
+
+File: org, Node: Weekly/daily agenda, Next: Global TODO list, Prev: Built-in agenda views, Up: Built-in agenda views
+
+10.3.1 The weekly/daily agenda
+------------------------------
+
+The purpose of the weekly/daily _agenda_ is to act like a page of a
+paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
+
+`C-c a a (`org-agenda-list')'
+ Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files.
+ The agenda shows the entries for each day. With a numeric
+ prefix(1) (like `C-u 2 1 C-c a a') you may set the number of days
+ to be displayed.
+
+ The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the
+variable `org-agenda-span' (or the obsolete `org-agenda-ndays'). This
+variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in
+the agenda, or to a span name, such a `day', `week', `month' or `year'.
+
+ Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you
+can change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda
+buffer. The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in
+*Note Agenda commands::.
+
+Calendar/Diary integration
+..........................
+
+Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
+calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
+countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
+anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
+(weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
+Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with the diary.
+
+ In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org-mode's
+agenda, you only need to customize the variable
+
+ (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
+
+After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary entries
+including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the agenda
+buffer created by Org-mode. <SPC>, <TAB>, and <RET> can be used from
+the agenda buffer to jump to the diary file in order to edit existing
+diary entries. The `i' command to insert new entries for the current
+date works in the agenda buffer, as well as the commands `S', `M', and
+`C' to display Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert
+to other calendars, respectively. `c' can be used to switch back and
+forth between calendar and agenda.
+
+ If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
+faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
+the entries into an Org file. Org-mode evaluates diary-style sexp
+entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
+creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
+the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
+the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries will
+be made in the agenda:
+
+ * Birthdays and similar stuff
+ #+CATEGORY: Holiday
+ %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
+ #+CATEGORY: Ann
+ %%(diary-anniversary 5 14 1956)(2) Arthur Dent is %d years old
+ %%(diary-anniversary 10 2 1869) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
+
+Anniversaries from BBDB
+.......................
+
+If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you
+will very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
+separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
+anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
+following to one your your agenda files:
+
+ * Anniversaries
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :CATEGORY: Anniv
+ :END:
+ %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
+
+ You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record.
+Basically, you need to press `C-o anniversary <RET>' with the cursor in
+a BBDB record and then add the date in the format `YYYY-MM-DD',
+followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (`birthday' or
+`wedding', or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default
+to `birthday'. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
+`org-bbdb.el' contains more detailed information.
+
+ 1973-06-22
+ 1955-08-02 wedding
+ 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org-mode, %d years ago
+
+ After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an
+Emacs session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org
+updates its hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will
+be very fast--much faster in fact than a long list of
+`%%(diary-anniversary)' entries in an Org or Diary file.
+
+Appointment reminders
+.....................
+
+Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add
+all the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
+`org-agenda-to-appt'. This command also lets you filter through the
+list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific
+category or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for
+details.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) For backward compatibility, the universal prefix `C-u' causes
+all TODO entries to be listed before the agenda. This feature is
+deprecated, use the dedicated TODO list, or a block agenda instead
+(*note Block agenda::).
+
+ (2) Note that the order of the arguments (month, day, year) depends
+on the setting of `calendar-date-style'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Global TODO list, Next: Matching tags and properties, Prev: Weekly/daily agenda, Up: Built-in agenda views
+
+10.3.2 The global TODO list
+---------------------------
+
+The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
+collected into a single place.
+
+`C-c a t (`org-todo-list')'
+ Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all
+ agenda files (*note Agenda Views::) into a single buffer. By
+ default, this lists items with a state the is not a DONE state.
+ The buffer is in `agenda-mode', so there are commands to examine
+ and manipulate the TODO entries directly from that buffer (*note
+ Agenda commands::).
+
+`C-c a T (`org-todo-list')'
+ Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword.
+ You can also do this by specifying a prefix argument to `C-c a t'.
+ You are prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several
+ keywords by separating them with `|' as the boolean OR operator.
+ With a numeric prefix, the Nth keyword in `org-todo-keywords' is
+ selected. The `r' key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and
+ you can give a prefix argument to this command to change the
+ selected TODO keyword, for example `3 r'. If you often need a
+ search for a specific keyword, define a custom command for it
+ (*note Agenda dispatcher::).
+ Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
+ search (*note Tag searches::).
+
+ Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
+TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the TODO
+list are described in *Note Agenda commands::.
+
+ Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
+keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
+it more compact:
+ - Some people view a TODO item that has been _scheduled_ for
+ execution or have a _deadline_ (*note Timestamps::) as no longer
+ _open_. Configure the variables
+ `org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled',
+ `org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines',
+ `org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp' and/or
+ `org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date' to exclude such items from the
+ global TODO list.
+
+ - TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks.
+ In such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO
+ headline and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure
+ the variable `org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels' to get this behavior.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Matching tags and properties, Next: Timeline, Prev: Global TODO list, Up: Built-in agenda views
+
+10.3.3 Matching tags and properties
+-----------------------------------
+
+If headlines in the agenda files are marked with _tags_ (*note Tags::),
+or have properties (*note Properties and Columns::), you can select
+headlines based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda
+buffer. The match syntax described here also applies when creating
+sparse trees with `C-c / m'.
+
+`C-c a m (`org-tags-view')'
+ Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags.
+ The command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean
+ logic expression with tags, like `+work+urgent-withboss' or
+ `work|home' (*note Tags::). If you often need a specific search,
+ define a custom command for it (*note Agenda dispatcher::).
+
+`C-c a M (`org-tags-view')'
+ Like `C-c a m', but only select headlines that are also TODO items
+ in a not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
+ `org-tags-match-list-sublevels'). To exclude scheduled/deadline
+ items, see the variable
+ `org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options'. Matching specific
+ TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
+ *Note Tag searches::.
+
+ The commands available in the tags list are described in *Note
+Agenda commands::.
+
+Match syntax
+............
+
+A search string can use Boolean operators `&' for AND and `|' for OR.
+`&' binds more strongly than `|'. Parentheses are currently not
+implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
+expression matching tags, or an expression like `PROPERTY OPERATOR
+VALUE' with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each
+element may be preceded by `-', to select against it, and `+' is
+syntactic sugar for positive selection. The AND operator `&' is
+optional when `+' or `-' is present. Here are some examples, using
+only tags.
+
+`+work-boss'
+ Select headlines tagged `:work:', but discard those also tagged
+ `:boss:'.
+
+`work|laptop'
+ Selects lines tagged `:work:' or `:laptop:'.
+
+`work|laptop+night'
+ Like before, but require the `:laptop:' lines to be tagged also
+ `:night:'.
+
+ Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed
+in curly braces. For example, `work+{^boss.*}' matches headlines that
+contain the tag `:work:' and any tag starting with `boss'.
+
+ You may also test for properties (*note Properties and Columns::) at
+the same time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties,
+or special properties that represent other metadata (*note Special
+properties::). For example, the "property" `TODO' represents the TODO
+keyword of the entry. Or, the "property" `LEVEL' represents the level
+of an entry. So a search `+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"' lists all level
+three headlines that have the tag `boss' and are _not_ marked with the
+TODO keyword DONE. In buffers with `org-odd-levels-only' set, `LEVEL'
+does not count the number of stars, but `LEVEL=2' will correspond to 3
+stars etc.
+
+ Here are more examples:
+`work+TODO="WAITING"'
+ Select `:work:'-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO keyword
+ `WAITING'.
+
+`work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"'
+ Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
+
+ When matching properties, a number of different operators can be
+used to test the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
+
+ +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
+ +With={Sarah\|Denny}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
+
+The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is
+written:
+ - If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison
+ is done, and the allowed operators are `<', `=', `>', `<=', `>=',
+ and `<>'.
+
+ - If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes, a string
+ comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
+
+ - If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes _and_ angular
+ brackets (like `DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"'), both values are
+ assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way,
+ and the comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that
+ will be recognized are `"<now>"' for now (including time), and
+ `"<today>"', and `"<tomorrow>"' for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e.
+ without a time specification. Also strings like `"<+5d>"' or
+ `"<-2m>"' with units `d', `w', `m', and `y' for day, week, month,
+ and year, respectively, can be used.
+
+ - If the comparison value is enclosed in curly braces, a regexp
+ match is performed, with `=' meaning that the regexp matches the
+ property value, and `<>' meaning that it does not match.
+
+ So the search string in the example finds entries tagged `:work:' but
+not `:boss:', which also have a priority value `A', a `:Coffee:'
+property with the value `unlimited', an `Effort' property that is
+numerically smaller than 2, a `:With:' property that is matched by the
+regular expression `Sarah\|Denny', and that are scheduled on or after
+October 11, 2008.
+
+ Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast.
+Accessing any other properties will slow down the search. However,
+once you have paid the price by accessing one property, testing
+additional properties is cheap again.
+
+ You can configure Org-mode to use property inheritance during a
+search, but beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See
+*Note Property inheritance::, for details.
+
+ For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also
+a different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate
+the tags/property part of the search string (which may include several
+terms connected with `|') with a `/' and then specify a Boolean
+expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that
+for tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive
+selection on several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with
+boolean AND. However, _negative selection_ combined with AND can be
+meaningful. To make sure that only lines are checked that actually
+have any TODO keyword (resulting in a speed-up), use `C-c a M', or
+equivalently start the TODO part after the slash with `!'. Using `C-c
+a M' or `/!' will not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
+
+`work/WAITING'
+ Same as `work+TODO="WAITING"'
+
+`work/!-WAITING-NEXT'
+ Select `:work:'-tagged TODO lines that are neither `WAITING' nor
+ `NEXT'
+
+`work/!+WAITING|+NEXT'
+ Select `:work:'-tagged TODO lines that are either `WAITING' or
+ `NEXT'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Timeline, Next: Search view, Prev: Matching tags and properties, Up: Built-in agenda views
+
+10.3.4 Timeline for a single file
+---------------------------------
+
+The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org-mode
+file in a _time-sorted view_. The main purpose of this command is to
+give an overview over events in a project.
+
+`C-c a L (`org-timeline')'
+ Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped
+ items. When called with a `C-u' prefix, all unfinished TODO
+ entries (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
+
+The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in *Note
+Agenda commands::.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Search view, Next: Stuck projects, Prev: Timeline, Up: Built-in agenda views
+
+10.3.5 Search view
+------------------
+
+This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org-mode entries.
+It is particularly useful to find notes.
+
+`C-c a s (`org-search-view')'
+ This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching
+ a substring or specific words using a boolean logic.
+ For example, the search string `computer equipment' will find entries
+that contain `computer equipment' as a substring. If the two words are
+separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
+Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using
+Boolean logic. The search string `+computer +wifi -ethernet
+-{8\.11[bg]}' will search for note entries that contain the keywords
+`computer' and `wifi', but not the keyword `ethernet', and which are
+also not matched by the regular expression `8\.11[bg]', meaning to
+exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first `+' is necessary to turn on
+word search, other `+' characters are optional. For more details, see
+the docstring of the command `org-search-view'.
+
+ Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also
+search the files listed in `org-agenda-text-search-extra-files'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Stuck projects, Prev: Search view, Up: Built-in agenda views
+
+10.3.6 Stuck projects
+---------------------
+
+If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
+work, one of the "duties" you have is a regular review to make sure
+that all projects move along. A _stuck_ project is a project that has
+no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
+Org-mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
+projects and define next actions for them.
+
+`C-c a # (`org-agenda-list-stuck-projects')'
+ List projects that are stuck.
+
+`C-c a !'
+ Customize the variable `org-stuck-projects' to define what a stuck
+ project is and how to find it.
+
+ You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
+work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
+level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
+one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
+
+ Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org-mode, identify
+projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
+indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
+assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
+and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @SHOP indicates shopping and
+is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
+contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
+either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
+with a tags/todo match(1) `+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE', and then check for
+TODO, NEXT, @SHOP, and IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that
+are not stuck. The correct customization for this is
+
+ (setq org-stuck-projects
+ '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@SHOP")
+ "\\<IGNORE\\>"))
+
+ Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of
+this entry will still be searched for stuck projects.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) *Note Tag searches::.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Presentation and sorting, Next: Agenda commands, Prev: Built-in agenda views, Up: Agenda Views
+
+10.4 Presentation and sorting
+=============================
+
+Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org-mode visually prepares
+the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line
+starts with a _prefix_ that contains the _category_ (*note
+Categories::) of the item and other important information. You can
+customize the prefix using the option `org-agenda-prefix-format'. The
+prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
+associated with the item.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
+* Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
+* Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
+
+
+File: org, Node: Categories, Next: Time-of-day specifications, Prev: Presentation and sorting, Up: Presentation and sorting
+
+10.4.1 Categories
+-----------------
+
+The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
+the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
+specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this(1):
+
+ #+CATEGORY: Thesis
+
+If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
+(sub)tree, give the entry a `:CATEGORY:' property with the special
+category you want to apply as the value.
+
+The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
+longer than 10 characters.
+
+You can set up icons for category by customizing the
+`org-agenda-category-icon-alist' variable.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) For backward compatibility, the following also works: if there
+are several such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the
+text below it. The first category also applies to any text before the
+first CATEGORY line. However, using this method is _strongly_
+deprecated as it is incompatible with the outline structure of the
+document. The correct method for setting multiple categories in a
+buffer is using a property.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Time-of-day specifications, Next: Sorting of agenda items, Prev: Categories, Up: Presentation and sorting
+
+10.4.2 Time-of-day specifications
+---------------------------------
+
+Org-mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
+time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
+agenda, for example as in `<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>'. Time ranges can be
+specified with two timestamps, like
+`<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>'.
+
+ In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
+plain text (like `12:45' or a `8:30-1pm'). If the agenda integrates
+the Emacs diary (*note Weekly/daily agenda::), time specifications in
+diary entries are recognized as well.
+
+ For agenda display, Org-mode extracts the time and displays it in a
+standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
+the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
+
+ 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
+ 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
+ 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
+ 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
+
+ If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
+timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
+
+ 8:00...... ------------------
+ 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
+ 10:00...... ------------------
+ 12:00...... ------------------
+ 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
+ 14:00...... ------------------
+ 16:00...... ------------------
+ 18:00...... ------------------
+ 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
+ 20:00...... ------------------
+ 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
+
+ The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
+`org-agenda-use-time-grid', and can be configured with
+`org-agenda-time-grid'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Sorting of agenda items, Prev: Time-of-day specifications, Up: Presentation and sorting
+
+10.4.3 Sorting of agenda items
+------------------------------
+
+Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
+done depends on the type of view.
+ * For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted.
+ The default order is to first collect all items containing an
+ explicit time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown
+ at the beginning of the list, as a _schedule_ for the day. After
+ that, items remain grouped in categories, in the sequence given by
+ `org-agenda-files'. Within each category, items are sorted by
+ priority (*note Priorities::), which is composed of the base
+ priority (2000 for priority `A', 1000 for `B', and 0 for `C'),
+ plus additional increments for overdue scheduled or deadline items.
+
+ * For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but
+ within each category, sorting takes place according to priority
+ (*note Priorities::). The priority used for sorting derives from
+ the priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item
+ is to its due or scheduled date.
+
+ * For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in
+ the sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
+
+ Sorting can be customized using the variable
+`org-agenda-sorting-strategy', and may also include criteria based on
+the estimated effort of an entry (*note Effort estimates::).
+
+
+File: org, Node: Agenda commands, Next: Custom agenda views, Prev: Presentation and sorting, Up: Agenda Views
+
+10.5 Commands in the agenda buffer
+==================================
+
+Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
+file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
+buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
+original entry location, and to edit the Org files "remotely" from the
+agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
+removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
+
+ Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
+the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
+
+Motion
+......
+
+`n (`org-agenda-next-line')'
+ Next line (same as <up> and `C-p').
+
+`p (`org-agenda-previous-line')'
+ Previous line (same as <down> and `C-n').
+
+View/Go to Org file
+...................
+
+`<SPC> or mouse-3 (`org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up')'
+ Display the original location of the item in another window. With
+ prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
+ outline, not only the heading.
+
+`L (`org-agenda-recenter')'
+ Display original location and recenter that window.
+
+`<TAB> or mouse-2 (`org-agenda-goto')'
+ Go to the original location of the item in another window.
+
+`<RET> (`org-agenda-switch-to')'
+ Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
+
+`F (`org-agenda-follow-mode')'
+ Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
+ the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
+ location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
+ agenda buffers can be set with the variable
+ `org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode'.
+
+`C-c C-x b (`org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer')'
+ Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect
+ buffer. With a numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and
+ then take that tree. If N is negative, go up that many levels.
+ With a `C-u' prefix, do not remove the previously used indirect
+ buffer.
+
+`C-c C-o (`org-agenda-open-link')'
+ Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any
+ links in the text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there
+ is only one link, it will be followed without a selection prompt.
+
+Change display
+..............
+
+`o'
+ Delete other windows.
+
+`v d or short d (`org-aganda-day-view')'
+`v w or short w (`org-aganda-day-view')'
+`v m (`org-agenda-month-view')'
+`v y (`org-agenda-month-year')'
+ Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week
+ view, this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda
+ commands. Since month and year views are slow to create, they do
+ not become the default. A numeric prefix argument may be used to
+ jump directly to a specific day of the year, ISO week, month, or
+ year, respectively. For example, `32 d' jumps to February 1st, `9
+ w' to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or month view, a
+ year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For example,
+ `200712 w' will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year
+ specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the
+ interval 1938-2037.
+
+`f (`org-agenda-later')'
+ Go forward in time to display the following
+ `org-agenda-current-span' days. For example, if the display
+ covers a week, switch to the following week. With prefix arg, go
+ forward that many times `org-agenda-current-span' days.
+
+`b (`org-agenda-earlier')'
+ Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
+
+`. (`org-agenda-goto-today')'
+ Go to today.
+
+`j (`org-agenda-goto-date')'
+ Prompt for a date and go there.
+
+`J (`org-agenda-clock-goto')'
+ Go to the currently clocked-in task in the agenda buffer.
+
+`D (`org-agenda-toggle-diary')'
+ Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See *Note Weekly/daily
+ agenda::.
+
+`v l or short l (`org-agenda-log-mode')'
+ Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked
+ DONE while logging was on (variable `org-log-done') are shown in
+ the agenda, as are entries that have been clocked on that day.
+ You can configure the entry types that should be included in log
+ mode using the variable `org-agenda-log-mode-items'. When called
+ with a `C-u' prefix, show all possible logbook entries, including
+ state changes. When called with two prefix args `C-u C-u', show
+ only logging information, nothing else. `v L' is equivalent to
+ `C-u v l'.
+
+`v [ or short [ (`org-agenda-manipulate-query-add')'
+ Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for
+ weekly/daily agenda and timeline views.
+
+`v a (`org-agenda-archives-mode')'
+`v A (`org-agenda-archives-mode 'files')'
+ Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
+ `ARCHIVED' are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you
+ use the capital `A', even all archive files are included. To exit
+ archives mode, press `v a' again.
+
+`v R or short R (`org-agenda-clockreport-mode')'
+ Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly
+ agenda will always show a table with the clocked times for the
+ timespan and file scope covered by the current agenda view. The
+ initial setting for this mode in new agenda buffers can be set
+ with the variable `org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode'. By
+ using a prefix argument when toggling this mode (i.e. `C-u R'),
+ the clock table will not show contributions from entries that are
+ hidden by agenda filtering(1).
+
+`v E or short E (`org-agenda-entry-text-mode')'
+ Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines
+ from the Org outline node referenced by an agenda line will be
+ displayed below the line. The maximum number of lines is given by
+ the variable `org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines'. Calling this
+ command with a numeric prefix argument will temporarily modify
+ that number to the prefix value.
+
+`G (`org-agenda-toggle-time-grid')'
+ Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
+ `org-agenda-use-time-grid' and `org-agenda-time-grid'.
+
+`r (`org-agenda-rodo')'
+ Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes
+ after modification of the timestamps of items with `S-<left>' and
+ `S-<right>'. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
+ argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific
+ TODO keyword.
+
+`g (`org-agenda-rodo')'
+ Same as `r'.
+
+`C-x C-s or short s (`org-save-all-org-buffers')'
+ Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the
+ locations of IDs.
+
+`C-c C-x C-c (`org-agenda-columns')'
+ Invoke column view (*note Column view::) in the agenda buffer.
+ The column view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if
+ there is no entry at point), from the first entry in the agenda
+ view. So whatever the format for that entry would be in the
+ original buffer (taken from a property, from a `#+COLUMNS' line,
+ or from the default variable `org-columns-default-format'), will
+ be used in the agenda.
+
+`C-c C-x > (`org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock')'
+ Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently
+ restricted to a file or subtree (*note Agenda files::).
+
+Secondary filtering and query editing
+.....................................
+
+`/ (`org-agenda-filter-by-tag')'
+ Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort
+ estimates. The difference between this and a custom agenda
+ command is that filtering is very fast, so that you can switch
+ quickly between different filters without having to recreate the
+ agenda.(2)
+
+ You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; <SPC> will mean
+ any tag at all. Pressing <TAB> at that prompt will offer use
+ completion to select a tag (including any tags that do not have a
+ selection character). The command then hides all entries that do
+ not contain or inherit this tag. When called with prefix arg,
+ remove the entries that _do_ have the tag. A second `/' at the
+ prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries. If
+ the first key you press is either `+' or `-', the previous filter
+ will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected
+ additional tag. Instead of pressing `+' or `-' after `/', you can
+ also immediately use the `\' command.
+
+ In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
+ efforts globally, for example
+ (setq org-global-properties
+ '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
+ You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one
+ of `<', `>', and `=', and then the one-digit index of an effort
+ estimate in your array of allowed values, where `0' means the 10th
+ value. The filter will then restrict to entries with effort
+ smaller-or-equal, equal, or larger-or-equal than the selected
+ value. If the digits 0-9 are not used as fast access keys to
+ tags, you can also simply press the index digit directly without
+ an operator. In this case, `<' will be assumed. For application
+ of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
+ according to the value of `org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high'. To
+ filter for tasks without effort definition, press `?' as the
+ operator.
+
+ Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the
+ variable `org-agenda-auto-exclude-function' is set to a
+ user-defined function, that function can decide which tags should
+ be excluded from the agenda automatically. Once this is set, the
+ `/' command then accepts `RET' as a sub-option key and runs the
+ auto exclusion logic. For example, let's say you use a `Net' tag
+ to identify tasks which need network access, an `Errand' tag for
+ errands in town, and a `Call' tag for making phone calls. You
+ could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
+ Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
+
+ (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
+ (and (cond
+ ((string= tag "Net")
+ (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
+ "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
+ ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
+ (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
+ (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
+ (concat "-" tag)))
+
+ (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
+
+`,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine (`')'
+ Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When
+ called with prefix arg, remove the entries that _do_ have the tag,
+ or that do match the effort criterion. You can achieve the same
+ effect by pressing `+' or `-' as the first key after the `/'
+ command.
+
+`[ ] { }'
+
+ in search view
+ add new search words (`[' and `]') or new regular expressions
+ (`{' and `}') to the query string. The opening bracket/brace
+ will add a positive search term prefixed by `+', indicating
+ that this search term must occur/match in the entry. The
+ closing bracket/brace will add a negative search term which
+ must not occur/match in the entry for it to be selected.
+
+Remote editing
+..............
+
+`0-9'
+ Digit argument.
+
+`C-_ (`org-agenda-undo')'
+ Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is
+ undone both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
+
+`t (`org-agenda-todo')'
+ Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
+ original org file.
+
+`C-S-<right> (`org-agenda-todo-nextset')'
+
+`C-S-<left> (`org-agenda-todo-previousset')'
+ Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
+
+`C-k (`org-agenda-kill')'
+ Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree
+ belonging to it in the original Org file. If the text to be
+ deleted remotely is longer than one line, the kill needs to be
+ confirmed by the user. See variable `org-agenda-confirm-kill'.
+
+`C-c C-w (`org-agenda-refile')'
+ Refile the entry at point.
+
+`C-c C-x C-a or short a (`org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation')'
+ Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the
+ default archiving command set in `org-archive-default-command'.
+ When using the `a' key, confirmation will be required.
+
+`C-c C-x a (`org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag')'
+ Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
+
+`C-c C-x A (`org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling')'
+ Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its _archive
+ sibling_.
+
+`C-c C-x C-s or short $ (`org-agenda-archive')'
+ Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This
+ means the entry will be moved to the configured archive location,
+ most likely a different file.
+
+`T (`org-agenda-show-tags')'
+ Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if
+ you have turned off `org-agenda-show-inherited-tags', but still
+ want to see all tags of a headline occasionally.
+
+`: (`org-agenda-set-tags')'
+ Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region
+ in the agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
+
+`,'
+ Set the priority for the current item (`org-agenda-priority').
+ Org-mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with
+ <SPC>, the priority cookie is removed from the entry.
+
+`P (`org-agenda-show-priority')'
+ Display weighted priority of current item.
+
+`+ or S-<up> (`org-agenda-priority-up')'
+ Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is
+ changed in the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted.
+ Use the `r' key for this.
+
+`- or S-<down> (`org-agenda-priority-down')'
+ Decrease the priority of the current item.
+
+`z or C-c C-z (`org-agenda-add-note')'
+ Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then
+ filed to the same location where state change notes are put.
+ Depending on `org-log-into-drawer', this may be inside a drawer.
+
+`C-c C-a (`org-attach')'
+ Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
+
+`C-c C-s (`org-agenda-schedule')'
+ Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling
+ timestamp
+
+`C-c C-d (`org-agenda-deadline')'
+ Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
+
+`k (`org-agenda-action')'
+ Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
+ This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for
+ an additional key:
+ m Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries
+ in Org files with `C-c C-x C-k'.
+ d Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.
+ s Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.
+ r Call `org-capture' with the cursor date as default date.
+ Press `r' afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
+ command.
+
+`S-<right> (`org-agenda-do-date-later')'
+ Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
+ into the future. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by
+ that many days. For example, `3 6 5 S-<right>' will change it by
+ a year. With a `C-u' prefix, change the time by one hour. If you
+ immediately repeat the command, it will continue to change hours
+ even without the prefix arg. With a double `C-u C-u' prefix, do
+ the same for changing minutes. The stamp is changed in the
+ original Org file, but the change is not directly reflected in the
+ agenda buffer. Use `r' or `g' to update the buffer.
+
+`S-<left> (`org-agenda-do-date-earlier')'
+ Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
+ into the past.
+
+`> (`org-agenda-date-prompt')'
+ Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key
+ `>' has been chosen, because it is the same as `S-.' on my
+ keyboard.
+
+`I (`org-agenda-clock-in')'
+ Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running
+ already, it is stopped first.
+
+`O (`org-agenda-clock-out')'
+ Stop the previously started clock.
+
+`X (`org-agenda-clock-cancel')'
+ Cancel the currently running clock.
+
+`J (`org-agenda-clock-goto')'
+ Jump to the running clock in another window.
+
+Bulk remote editing selected entries
+....................................
+
+`m (`org-agenda-bulk-mark')'
+ Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark
+ that many successive entries.
+
+`u (`org-agenda-bulk-unmark')'
+ Unmark entry for bulk action.
+
+`U (`org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks')'
+ Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
+
+`B (`org-agenda-bulk-action')'
+ Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will
+ prompt for another key to select the action to be applied. The
+ prefix arg to `B' will be passed through to the `s' and `d'
+ commands, to bulk-remove these special timestamps.
+ r Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries
+ will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (`g') to bring them back.
+ $ Archive all selected entries.
+ A Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.
+ t Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and
+ changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and
+ suppressing logging notes (but not time stamps).
+ + Add a tag to all selected entries.
+ - Remove a tag from all selected entries.
+ s Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates
+ by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus
+ at the prompt, for example `++8d' or `++2w'.
+ S Reschedule randomly by N days. N will be prompted for. With prefix
+ arg (`C-u B S'), scatter only accross weekdays.
+ d Set deadline to a specific date.
+
+Calendar commands
+.................
+
+`c (`org-agenda-goto-calendar')'
+ Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
+
+`c (`org-calendar-goto-agenda')'
+ When in the calendar, compute and show the Org-mode agenda for the
+ date at the cursor.
+
+`i (`org-agenda-diary-entry')'
+ Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor
+ and (for block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to
+ the Emacs diary file(3), in a way similar to the `i' command in
+ the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
+ you can add the entry.
+
+ If you configure `org-agenda-diary-file' to point to an Org-mode
+ file, Org will create entries (in org-mode syntax) in that file
+ instead. Most entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree
+ that will later make it easy to archive appointments from previous
+ months/years. The tree will be built under an entry with a
+ `DATE_TREE' property, or else with years as top-level entries.
+ Emacs will prompt you for the entry text--if you specify it, the
+ entry will be created in `org-agenda-diary-file' without further
+ interaction. If you directly press <RET> at the prompt without
+ typing text, the target file will be shown in another window for
+ you to finish the entry there. See also the `k r' command.
+
+`M (`org-agenda-phases-of-moon')'
+ Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current
+ date.
+
+`S (`org-agenda-sunrise-sunset')'
+ Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be
+ set with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs
+ calendar.
+
+`C (`org-agenda-convert-date')'
+ Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
+ calendars.
+
+`H (`org-agenda-holidays')'
+ Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
+
+`M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files'
+ Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda
+ files. This is a globally available command, and also available
+ in the agenda menu.
+
+Exporting to a file
+...................
+
+`C-x C-w (`org-write-agenda')'
+ Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of
+ the selected file name, the view will be exported as HTML
+ (extension `.html' or `.htm'), Postscript (extension `.ps'), PDF
+ (extension `.pdf'), and plain text (any other extension). When
+ called with a `C-u' prefix argument, immediately open the newly
+ created file. Use the variable `org-agenda-exporter-settings' to
+ set options for `ps-print' and for `htmlize' to be used during
+ export.
+
+Quit and Exit
+.............
+
+`q (`org-agenda-quit')'
+ Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
+
+`x (`org-agenda-exit')'
+ Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by
+ Emacs for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the
+ user to visit Org files will not be removed.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Only tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is
+ignored.
+
+ (2) Custom commands can preset a filter by binding the variable
+`org-agenda-filter-preset' as an option. This filter will then be
+applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through refreshes and
+more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of the
+entire agenda view--in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
+global options section, not in the section of an individual block.
+
+ (3) This file is parsed for the agenda when
+`org-agenda-include-diary' is set.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Custom agenda views, Next: Exporting Agenda Views, Prev: Agenda commands, Up: Agenda Views
+
+10.6 Custom agenda views
+========================
+
+Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
+frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
+agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
+dispatcher (*note Agenda dispatcher::), just like the default commands.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Storing searches:: Type once, use often
+* Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
+* Setting Options:: Changing the rules
+
+
+File: org, Node: Storing searches, Next: Block agenda, Prev: Custom agenda views, Up: Custom agenda views
+
+10.6.1 Storing searches
+-----------------------
+
+The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
+shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
+buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
+buffer). Custom commands are configured in the variable
+`org-agenda-custom-commands'. You can customize this variable, for
+example by pressing `C-c a C'. You can also directly set it with Emacs
+Lisp in `.emacs'. The following example contains all valid search
+types:
+
+ (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
+ '(("w" todo "WAITING")
+ ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
+ ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
+ ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
+ ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
+ ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
+ ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
+ ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
+ ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
+ ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
+
+The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
+after the dispatcher command `C-c a' in order to access the command.
+Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
+similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
+first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
+prefix key(1). The second parameter is the search type, followed by
+the string or regular expression to be used for the matching. The
+example above will therefore define:
+
+`C-c a w'
+ as a global search for TODO entries with `WAITING' as the TODO
+ keyword
+
+`C-c a W'
+ as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying
+ the results as a sparse tree
+
+`C-c a u'
+ as a global tags search for headlines marked `:boss:' but not
+ `:urgent:'
+
+`C-c a v'
+ as the same search as `C-c a u', but limiting the search to
+ headlines that are also TODO items
+
+`C-c a U'
+ as the same search as `C-c a u', but only in the current buffer and
+ displaying the result as a sparse tree
+
+`C-c a f'
+ to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all
+ entries containing the word `FIXME'
+
+`C-c a h'
+ as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press
+ an additional key (`l', `p' or `k') to select a name (Lisa, Peter,
+ or Kim) as additional tag to match.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) You can provide a description for a prefix key by inserting a
+cons cell with the prefix and the description.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Block agenda, Next: Setting Options, Prev: Storing searches, Up: Custom agenda views
+
+10.6.2 Block agenda
+-------------------
+
+Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
+the results of _several_ commands, each of which creates a block in the
+agenda buffer. The available commands include `agenda' for the daily
+or weekly agenda (as created with `C-c a a'), `alltodo' for the global
+TODO list (as constructed with `C-c a t'), and the matching commands
+discussed above: `todo', `tags', and `tags-todo'. Here are two
+examples:
+
+ (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
+ '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
+ ((agenda "")
+ (tags-todo "home")
+ (tags "garden")))
+ ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
+ ((agenda "")
+ (tags-todo "work")
+ (tags "office")))))
+
+This will define `C-c a h' to create a multi-block view for stuff you
+need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
+your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
+`home', and also all lines tagged with `garden'. Finally the command
+`C-c a o' provides a similar view for office tasks.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Setting Options, Prev: Block agenda, Up: Custom agenda views
+
+10.6.3 Setting options for custom commands
+------------------------------------------
+
+Org-mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
+and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
+commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
+some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
+options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
+right spot in `org-agenda-custom-commands'. For example:
+
+ (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
+ '(("w" todo "WAITING"
+ ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
+ (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
+ ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
+ ((org-show-following-heading nil)
+ (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
+ ("N" search ""
+ ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
+ (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
+
+Now the `C-c a w' command will sort the collected entries only by
+priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say ` Mixed: '
+instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
+`C-c a U' will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the headline
+hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match will be
+shown. The command `C-c a N' will do a text search limited to only a
+single file.
+
+ For command sets creating a block agenda,
+`org-agenda-custom-commands' has two separate spots for setting
+options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
+command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
+the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
+must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
+agenda example (*note Block agenda::), let's change the sorting strategy
+for the `C-c a h' commands to `priority-down', but let's sort the
+results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order, `priority-up'.
+This would look like this:
+
+ (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
+ '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
+ ((agenda)
+ (tags-todo "home")
+ (tags "garden"
+ ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
+ ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
+ ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
+ ((agenda)
+ (tags-todo "work")
+ (tags "office")))))
+
+ As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
+When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable--it
+fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
+this interface, the _values_ are just Lisp expressions. So if the
+value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
+yourself.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Exporting Agenda Views, Next: Agenda column view, Prev: Custom agenda views, Up: Agenda Views
+
+10.7 Exporting Agenda Views
+===========================
+
+If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a
+printed version of some agenda views to carry around. Org-mode can
+export custom agenda views as plain text, HTML(1), Postscript, PDF(2),
+and iCalendar files. If you want to do this only occasionally, use the
+command
+
+`C-x C-w (`org-write-agenda')'
+ Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of
+ the selected file name, the view will be exported as HTML
+ (extension `.html' or `.htm'), Postscript (extension `.ps'),
+ iCalendar (extension `.ics'), or plain text (any other extension).
+ Use the variable `org-agenda-exporter-settings' to set options
+ for `ps-print' and for `htmlize' to be used during export, for
+ example
+
+ (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
+ '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
+ (ps-landscape-mode t)
+ (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
+ (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
+
+ If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can
+associate any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
+(3). Here is an example that first defines custom commands for the
+agenda and the global TODO list, together with a number of files to
+which to export them. Then we define two block agenda commands and
+specify file names for them as well. File names can be relative to the
+current working directory, or absolute.
+
+ (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
+ '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
+ ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
+ ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
+ ((agenda "")
+ (tags-todo "home")
+ (tags "garden"))
+ nil
+ ("~/views/home.html"))
+ ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
+ ((agenda)
+ (tags-todo "work")
+ (tags "office"))
+ nil
+ ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
+
+ The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it
+is `.html', Org-mode will use the `htmlize.el' package to convert the
+buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
+`.ps', `ps-print-buffer-with-faces' is used to produce Postscript
+output. If the extension is `.ics', iCalendar export is run export
+over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and limit the
+export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other extension produces a
+plain ASCII file.
+
+ The export files are _not_ created when you use one of those
+commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
+Instead, there is a special command to produce _all_ specified files in
+one step:
+
+`C-c a e (`org-store-agenda-views')'
+ Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
+ them.
+
+ You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
+set options for the export commands. For example:
+
+ (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
+ '(("X" agenda ""
+ ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
+ (ps-landscape-mode t)
+ (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
+ (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
+ (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
+ ("theagenda.ps"))))
+
+This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
+print in two columns in landscape format--the resulting page can be cut
+in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
+the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
+instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
+to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
+black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
+`org-agenda-exporter-settings' will also apply, but the settings in
+`org-agenda-custom-commands' take precedence.
+
+From the command line you may also use
+ emacs -f org-batch-store-agenda-views -kill
+ or, if you need to modify some parameters(4)
+ emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
+ org-agenda-span month \
+ org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
+ org-agenda-include-diary nil \
+ org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
+ -kill
+ which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
+`~/org/project.org', without diary entries and with a 30-day extent.
+
+ You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
+processing by other programs. See *Note Extracting agenda
+information::, for more information.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's `htmlize.el'.
+
+ (2) To create PDF output, the ghostscript `ps2pdf' utility must be
+installed on the system. Selecting a PDF file with also create the
+postscript file.
+
+ (3) If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda or
+the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
+them in order to be able to specify file names.
+
+ (4) Quoting depends on the system you use, please check the FAQ for
+examples.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Agenda column view, Prev: Exporting Agenda Views, Up: Agenda Views
+
+10.8 Using column view in the agenda
+====================================
+
+Column view (*note Column view::) is normally used to view and edit
+properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It
+can be quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where
+entries are collected by certain criteria.
+
+`C-c C-x C-c (`org-agenda-columns')'
+ Turn on column view in the agenda.
+
+ To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize
+that the entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline
+environment. This causes the following issues:
+
+ 1. Org needs to make a decision which `COLUMNS' format to use. Since
+ the entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and
+ different files may have different `COLUMNS' formats, this is a
+ non-trivial problem. Org first checks if the variable
+ `org-overriding-columns-format' is currently set, and if so, takes
+ the format from there. Otherwise it takes the format associated
+ with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item does not have
+ a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it uses
+ `org-columns-default-format'.
+
+ 2. If any of the columns has a summary type defined (*note Column
+ attributes::), turning on column view in the agenda will visit all
+ relevant agenda files and make sure that the computations of this
+ property are up to date. This is also true for the special
+ `CLOCKSUM' property. Org will then sum the values displayed in
+ the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will cover a
+ single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
+ vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry _twice_
+ (for example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two
+ entries from the same hierarchy (for example a _parent_ and its
+ _child_). In these cases, the summation in the agenda will lead
+ to incorrect results because some values will count double.
+
+ 3. When the column view in the agenda shows the `CLOCKSUM', that is
+ always the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the
+ daily/weekly agenda, the clocksum listed in column view may
+ originate from times outside the current view. This has the
+ advantage that you can compare these values with a column listing
+ the planned total effort for a task--one of the major applications
+ for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
+ clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press
+ `R' in the agenda).
+
+
+File: org, Node: Markup, Next: Exporting, Prev: Agenda Views, Up: Top
+
+11 Markup for rich export
+*************************
+
+When exporting Org-mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
+structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend.
+Since export targets like HTML, LaTeX, or DocBook allow much richer
+formatting, Org-mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export.
+This section summarizes the markup rules used in an Org-mode buffer.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
+* Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
+* Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
+* Include files:: Include additional files into a document
+* Index entries:: Making an index
+* Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
+* Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
+
+
+File: org, Node: Structural markup elements, Next: Images and tables, Prev: Markup, Up: Markup
+
+11.1 Structural markup elements
+===============================
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Document title:: Where the title is taken from
+* Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
+* Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
+* Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
+* Lists:: Lists
+* Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
+* Footnote markup:: Footnotes
+* Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
+* Horizontal rules:: Make a line
+* Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
+
+
+File: org, Node: Document title, Next: Headings and sections, Prev: Structural markup elements, Up: Structural markup elements
+
+Document title
+--------------
+
+The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
+
+ #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
+
+If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first
+non-empty, non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or
+if you have turned off exporting of the text before the first headline
+(see below), the title will be the file name without extension.
+
+ If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the
+heading of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the
+subtree has a property `EXPORT_TITLE', that will take precedence.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Headings and sections, Next: Table of contents, Prev: Document title, Up: Structural markup elements
+
+Headings and sections
+---------------------
+
+The outline structure of the document as described in *Note Document
+Structure::, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported
+document. However, since the outline structure is also used for (for
+example) lists of tasks, only the first three outline levels will be
+used as headings. Deeper levels will become itemized lists. You can
+change the location of this switch globally by setting the variable
+`org-export-headline-levels', or on a per-file basis with a line
+
+ #+OPTIONS: H:4
+
+
+File: org, Node: Table of contents, Next: Initial text, Prev: Headings and sections, Up: Structural markup elements
+
+Table of contents
+-----------------
+
+The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first
+headline of the file. If you would like to get it to a different
+location, insert the string `[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]' on a line by itself
+at the desired location. The depth of the table of contents is by
+default the same as the number of headline levels, but you can choose a
+smaller number, or turn off the table of contents entirely, by
+configuring the variable `org-export-with-toc', or on a per-file basis
+with a line like
+
+ #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
+ #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
+
+
+File: org, Node: Initial text, Next: Lists, Prev: Table of contents, Up: Structural markup elements
+
+Text before the first headline
+------------------------------
+
+Org-mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even
+uses the first line as the document title. The text will be fully
+marked up. If you need to include literal HTML, LaTeX, or DocBook
+code, use the special constructs described below in the sections for
+the individual exporters.
+
+ Some people like to use the space before the first headline for
+setup and internal links and therefore would like to control the
+exported text before the first headline in a different way. You can do
+so by setting the variable `org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading' to
+`t'. On a per-file basis, you can get the same effect with `#+OPTIONS:
+skip:t'.
+
+If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
+`#+TEXT' construct:
+
+ #+OPTIONS: skip:t
+ #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
+ #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
+ #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the first headline
+
+
+File: org, Node: Lists, Next: Paragraphs, Prev: Initial text, Up: Structural markup elements
+
+Lists
+-----
+
+Plain lists as described in *Note Plain lists::, are translated to the
+backend's syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered,
+ordered, and description lists.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Paragraphs, Next: Footnote markup, Prev: Lists, Up: Structural markup elements
+
+Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
+------------------------------------
+
+Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to
+enforce a line break within a paragraph, use `\\' at the end of a line.
+
+ To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal
+formatting, you can use this construct, which can also be used to
+format poetry.
+
+ #+BEGIN_VERSE
+ Great clouds overhead
+ Tiny black birds rise and fall
+ Snow covers Emacs
+
+ -- AlexSchroeder
+ #+END_VERSE
+
+ When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to
+format this as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the
+right margin. You can include quotations in Org-mode documents like
+this:
+
+ #+BEGIN_QUOTE
+ Everything should be made as simple as possible,
+ but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
+ #+END_QUOTE
+
+ If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
+ #+BEGIN_CENTER
+ Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
+ but not any simpler
+ #+END_CENTER
+
+
+File: org, Node: Footnote markup, Next: Emphasis and monospace, Prev: Paragraphs, Up: Structural markup elements
+
+Footnote markup
+---------------
+
+Footnotes defined in the way described in *Note Footnotes::, will be
+exported by all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same
+note, and different backends support this to varying degrees.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Emphasis and monospace, Next: Horizontal rules, Prev: Footnote markup, Up: Structural markup elements
+
+Emphasis and monospace
+----------------------
+
+You can make words *bold*, /italic/, _underlined_, `=code=' and
+`~verbatim~', and, if you must, `+strike-through+'. Text in the code
+and verbatim string is not processed for Org-mode specific syntax; it
+is exported verbatim.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Horizontal rules, Next: Comment lines, Prev: Emphasis and monospace, Up: Structural markup elements
+
+Horizontal rules
+----------------
+
+A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be
+exported as a horizontal line (`<hr/>' in HTML).
+
+
+File: org, Node: Comment lines, Prev: Horizontal rules, Up: Structural markup elements
+
+Comment lines
+-------------
+
+Lines starting with `#' in column zero are treated as comments and will
+never be exported. If you want an indented line to be treated as a
+comment, start it with `#+ '. Also entire subtrees starting with the
+word `COMMENT' will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
+`#+BEGIN_COMMENT' ... `#+END_COMMENT' will not be exported.
+
+`C-c ;'
+ Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Images and tables, Next: Literal examples, Prev: Structural markup elements, Up: Markup
+
+11.2 Images and Tables
+======================
+
+Both the native Org-mode tables (*note Tables::) and tables formatted
+with the `table.el' package will be exported properly. For Org-mode
+tables, the lines before the first horizontal separator line will
+become table header lines. You can use the following lines somewhere
+before the table to assign a caption and a label for cross references,
+and in the text you can refer to the object with `\ref{tab:basic-data}':
+
+ #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
+ #+LABEL: tbl:basic-data
+ | ... | ...|
+ |-----|----|
+
+ Some backends (HTML, LaTeX, and DocBook) allow you to directly
+include images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to
+an image files does not have a description part, for example
+`[[./img/a.jpg]]'. If you wish to define a caption for the image and
+maybe a label for internal cross references, make sure that the link is
+on a line by itself and precede it with `#+CAPTION' and `#+LABEL' as
+follows:
+
+ #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
+ #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
+ [[./img/a.jpg]]
+
+ You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
+backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for
+more information.
+
+ *Note the discussion of image links: Handling links.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Literal examples, Next: Include files, Prev: Images and tables, Up: Markup
+
+11.3 Literal examples
+=====================
+
+You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
+markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well
+suited for source code and similar examples.
+
+ #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
+ Some example from a text file.
+ #+END_EXAMPLE
+
+ Note that such blocks may be indented in order to align nicely with
+indented text and in particular with plain list structure (*note Plain
+lists::). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start
+the example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be
+additional whitespace before the colon:
+
+ Here is an example
+ : Some example from a text file.
+
+ If the example is source code from a programming language, or any
+other text that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for
+the example to look like the fontified Emacs buffer(1). This is done
+with the `src' block, where you also need to specify the name of the
+major mode that should be used to fontify the example:
+
+ #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
+ (defun org-xor (a b)
+ "Exclusive or."
+ (if a (not b) b))
+ #+END_SRC
+
+ Both in `example' and in `src' snippets, you can add a `-n' switch
+to the end of the `BEGIN' line, to get the lines of the example
+numbered. If you use a `+n' switch, the numbering from the previous
+numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal
+examples, Org will interpret strings like `(ref:name)' as labels, and
+use them as targets for special hyperlinks like `[[(name)]]' (i.e. the
+reference name enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the
+mouse over such a link will remote-highlight the corresponding code
+line, which is kind of cool.
+
+ You can also add a `-r' switch which removes the labels from the
+source code(2). With the `-n' switch, links to these references will
+be labeled by the line numbers from the code listing, otherwise links
+will use the labels with no parentheses. Here is an example:
+
+ #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
+ (save-excursion (ref:sc)
+ (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
+ #+END_SRC
+ In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
+ jumps to point-min.
+
+ If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language
+syntax, use a `-l' switch to change the format, for example
+`#+BEGIN_SRC pascal -n -r -l "((%s))"'. See also the variable
+`org-coderef-label-format'.
+
+ HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas,
+*Note Text areas in HTML export::.
+
+`C-c ''
+ Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This
+ works by switching to a temporary buffer with the source code.
+ You need to exit by pressing `C-c '' again(3). The edited version
+ will then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width
+ regions (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space)
+ will be edited using `artist-mode'(4) to allow creating ASCII
+ drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create
+ a new fixed-width region.
+
+`C-c l'
+ Calling `org-store-link' while editing a source code example in a
+ temporary buffer created with `C-c '' will prompt for a label.
+ Make sure that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it
+ with the proper formatting like `(ref:label)' at the end of the
+ current line. Then the label is stored as a link `(label)', for
+ retrieval with `C-c C-l'.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) This works automatically for the HTML backend (it requires
+version 1.34 of the `htmlize.el' package, which is distributed with
+Org). Fontified code chunks in LaTeX can be achieved using either the
+listings or the minted (http://code.google.com/p/minted) package. To
+use listings, turn on the variable `org-export-latex-listings' and
+ensure that the listings package is included by the LaTeX header (e.g.
+by configuring `org-export-latex-packages-alist'). See the listings
+documentation for configuration options, including obtaining colored
+output. For minted it is necessary to install the program pygments
+(http://pygments.org), in addition to setting
+`org-export-latex-minted', ensuring that the minted package is included
+by the LaTeX header, and ensuring that the `-shell-escape' option is
+passed to `pdflatex' (see `org-latex-to-pdf-process'). See the
+documentation of the variables `org-export-latex-listings' and
+`org-export-latex-minted' for further details.
+
+ (2) Adding `-k' to `-n -r' will keep the labels in the source code
+while using line numbers for the links, which might be useful to
+explain those in an org-mode example code.
+
+ (3) Upon exit, lines starting with `*' or `#' will get a comma
+prepended, to keep them from being interpreted by Org as outline nodes
+or special comments. These commas will be stripped for editing with
+`C-c '', and also for export.
+
+ (4) You may select a different-mode with the variable
+`org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Include files, Next: Index entries, Prev: Literal examples, Up: Markup
+
+11.4 Include files
+==================
+
+During export, you can include the content of another file. For
+example, to include your `.emacs' file, you could use:
+
+ #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
+ The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g. `quote',
+`example', or `src'), and, if the markup is `src', the language for
+formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not given,
+the text will be assumed to be in Org-mode format and will be processed
+normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
+parameters `:prefix1' and `:prefix' to specify prefixes for the first
+line and for each following line, `:minlevel' in order to get org-mode
+content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options accepted
+by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item, use
+
+ #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
+
+`C-c ''
+ Visit the include file at point.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Index entries, Next: Macro replacement, Prev: Include files, Up: Markup
+
+11.5 Index entries
+==================
+
+You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
+publishing. This is done by lines starting with `#+INDEX'. An entry
+the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See *Note
+Generating an index:: for more information.
+
+ * Curriculum Vitae
+ #+INDEX: CV
+ #+INDEX: Application!CV
+
+
+File: org, Node: Macro replacement, Next: Embedded LaTeX, Prev: Index entries, Up: Markup
+
+11.6 Macro replacement
+======================
+
+You can define text snippets with
+
+ #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
+
+which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in code
+examples) with `{{{name(arg1,arg2)}}}'. In addition to defined macros,
+`{{{title}}}', `{{{author}}}', etc., will reference information set by
+the `#+TITLE:', `#+AUTHOR:', and similar lines. Also,
+`{{{date(FORMAT)}}}' and `{{{modification-time(FORMAT)}}}' refer to
+current date time and to the modification time of the file being
+exported, respectively. FORMAT should be a format string understood by
+`format-time-string'.
+
+ Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
+construct complex HTML code.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Embedded LaTeX, Prev: Macro replacement, Up: Markup
+
+11.7 Embedded LaTeX
+===================
+
+Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking.
+Exceptions include scientific notes, which often require mathematical
+symbols and the occasional formula. LaTeX(1) is widely used to
+typeset scientific documents. Org-mode supports embedding LaTeX code
+into its files, because many academics are used to writing and reading
+LaTeX source code, and because it can be readily processed to produce
+pretty output for a number of export backends.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
+* Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
+* LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
+* Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
+* CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) LaTeX is a macro system based on Donald E. Knuth's TeX system.
+Many of the features described here as "LaTeX" are really from TeX, but
+for simplicity I am blurring this distinction.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Special symbols, Next: Subscripts and superscripts, Prev: Embedded LaTeX, Up: Embedded LaTeX
+
+11.7.1 Special symbols
+----------------------
+
+You can use LaTeX macros to insert special symbols like `\alpha' to
+indicate the Greek letter, or `\to' to indicate an arrow. Completion
+for these macros is available, just type `\' and maybe a few letters,
+and press `M-<TAB>' to see possible completions. Unlike LaTeX code,
+Org-mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
+delimiters, for example:
+
+ Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
+
+ During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native
+format of the exporter backend. Strings like `\alpha' will be exported
+as `&alpha;' in the HTML output, and as `$\alpha$' in the LaTeX output.
+Similarly, `\nbsp' will become `&nbsp;' in HTML and `~' in LaTeX. If
+you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it like this:
+`\Aacute{}stor'.
+
+ A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both
+HTML and LaTeX; see the variable `org-entities' for the complete list.
+`\-' is treated as a shy hyphen, and `--', `---', and `...' are all
+converted into special commands creating hyphens of different lengths
+or a compact set of dots.
+
+ If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use
+the following command(1):
+
+`C-c C-x \'
+ Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not
+ change the buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it
+ overlays the UTF-8 character for display purposes only.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) You can turn this on by default by setting the variable
+`org-pretty-entities', or on a per-file base with the `#+STARTUP'
+option `entitiespretty'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Subscripts and superscripts, Next: LaTeX fragments, Prev: Special symbols, Up: Embedded LaTeX
+
+11.7.2 Subscripts and superscripts
+----------------------------------
+
+Just like in LaTeX, `^' and `_' are used to indicate super- and
+subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
+math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
+not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
+with curly braces. For example
+
+ The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
+ the sun is R_{sun} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
+
+ To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote `^'
+and `_' with a backslash: `\^' and `\_'. If you write a text where the
+underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention to
+always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
+variable `org-export-with-sub-superscripts' to globally change this
+convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
+
+ #+OPTIONS: ^:{}
+
+With this setting, `a_b' will not be interpreted as a subscript, but
+`a_{b}' will.
+
+`C-c C-x \'
+ In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command
+ will also format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
+
+
+File: org, Node: LaTeX fragments, Next: Previewing LaTeX fragments, Prev: Subscripts and superscripts, Up: Embedded LaTeX
+
+11.7.3 LaTeX fragments
+----------------------
+
+Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language
+is needed. Org-mode can contain LaTeX math fragments, and it supports
+ways to process these for several export backends. When exporting to
+LaTeX, the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML,
+Org invokes the MathJax library (http://www.mathjax.org) (*note Math
+formatting in HTML export::) to process and display the math(1).
+Finally, it can also process the mathematical expressions into
+images(2) that can be displayed in a browser or in DocBook documents.
+
+ LaTeX fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
+snippets will be identified as LaTeX source code:
+ * Environments of any kind(3). The only requirement is that the
+ `\begin' statement appears on a new line, preceded by only
+ whitespace.
+
+ * Text within the usual LaTeX math delimiters. To avoid conflicts
+ with currency specifications, single `$' characters are only
+ recognized as math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at
+ most two line breaks, is directly attached to the `$' characters
+ with no whitespace in between, and if the closing `$' is followed
+ by whitespace, punctuation or a dash. For the other delimiters,
+ there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use `\(...\)' as
+ inline math delimiters.
+
+For example:
+
+ \begin{equation} % arbitrary environments,
+ x=\sqrt{b} % even tables, figures
+ \end{equation} % etc
+
+ If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
+ either $$ a=+\sqrt{2} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt{2} \].
+
+If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
+can configure the option `org-format-latex-options' to deselect the
+ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the LaTeX converter.
+
+ LaTeX processing can be configured with the variable
+`org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments'. The default setting is `t' which
+means `MathJax' for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
+LaTeX backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis
+using one of these lines:
+
+ #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)
+ #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng Force using dvipng images
+ #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil Do not process LaTeX fragments at all
+ #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim Verbatim export, for jsMath or so
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
+page views, you should install `MathJax' on your own server in order to
+limit the load of our server.
+
+ (2) For this to work you need to be on a system with a working LaTeX
+installation. You also need the `dvipng' program, available at
+`http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/'. The LaTeX header that will
+be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
+`org-format-latex-header'.
+
+ (3) When `MathJax' is used, only the environment recognized by
+`MathJax' will be processed. When `dvipng' is used to create images,
+any LaTeX environments will be handled.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Previewing LaTeX fragments, Next: CDLaTeX mode, Prev: LaTeX fragments, Up: Embedded LaTeX
+
+11.7.4 Previewing LaTeX fragments
+---------------------------------
+
+If you have `dvipng' installed, LaTeX fragments can be processed to
+produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
+
+`C-c C-x C-l'
+ Produce a preview image of the LaTeX fragment at point and overlay
+ it over the source code. If there is no fragment at point,
+ process all fragments in the current entry (between two
+ headlines). When called with a prefix argument, process the
+ entire subtree. When called with two prefix arguments, or when
+ the cursor is before the first headline, process the entire buffer.
+
+`C-c C-c'
+ Remove the overlay preview images.
+
+ You can customize the variable `org-format-latex-options' to
+influence some aspects of the preview. In particular, the `:scale' (and
+for HTML export, `:html-scale') property can be used to adjust the size
+of the preview images.
+
+
+File: org, Node: CDLaTeX mode, Prev: Previewing LaTeX fragments, Up: Embedded LaTeX
+
+11.7.5 Using CDLaTeX to enter math
+----------------------------------
+
+CDLaTeX mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
+major LaTeX mode like AUCTeX in order to speed-up insertion of
+environments and math templates. Inside Org-mode, you can make use of
+some of the features of CDLaTeX mode. You need to install `cdlatex.el'
+and `texmathp.el' (the latter comes also with AUCTeX) from
+`http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex'. Don't use CDLaTeX
+mode itself under Org-mode, but use the light version
+`org-cdlatex-mode' that comes as part of Org-mode. Turn it on for the
+current buffer with `M-x org-cdlatex-mode', or for all Org files with
+
+ (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
+
+ When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for
+more details see the documentation of CDLaTeX mode):
+ * Environment templates can be inserted with `C-c {'.
+
+ * The <TAB> key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
+ LaTeX fragment(1). For example, <TAB> will expand `fr' to
+ `\frac{}{}' and position the cursor correctly inside the first
+ brace. Another <TAB> will get you into the second brace. Even
+ outside fragments, <TAB> will expand environment abbreviations at
+ the beginning of a line. For example, if you write `equ' at the
+ beginning of a line and press <TAB>, this abbreviation will be
+ expanded to an `equation' environment. To get a list of all
+ abbreviations, type `M-x cdlatex-command-help'.
+
+ * Pressing `_' and `^' inside a LaTeX fragment will insert these
+ characters together with a pair of braces. If you use <TAB> to
+ move out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single
+ character or macro, they are removed again (depending on the
+ variable `cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts').
+
+ * Pressing the backquote ``' followed by a character inserts math
+ macros, also outside LaTeX fragments. If you wait more than 1.5
+ seconds after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
+
+ * Pressing the single-quote `'' followed by another character
+ modifies the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you
+ wait more than 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window
+ will pop up. Character modification will work only inside LaTeX
+ fragments; outside the quote is normal.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Org-mode has a method to test if the cursor is inside such a
+fragment, see the documentation of the function
+`org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Exporting, Next: Publishing, Prev: Markup, Up: Top
+
+12 Exporting
+************
+
+Org-mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
+printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and
+simple version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a
+notes file on the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for
+exchange with a broad range of other applications. LaTeX export lets
+you use Org-mode and its structured editing functions to easily create
+LaTeX files. DocBook export makes it possible to convert Org files to
+many other formats using DocBook tools. For project management you can
+create gantt and resource charts by using TaskJuggler export. To
+incorporate entries with associated times like deadlines or
+appointments into a desktop calendar program like iCal, Org-mode can
+also produce extracts in the iCalendar format. Currently Org-mode only
+supports export, not import of these different formats.
+
+ Org supports export of selected regions when `transient-mark-mode' is
+enabled (default in Emacs 23).
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
+* Export options:: Per-file export settings
+* The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
+* ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
+* HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
+* LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to LaTeX, and processing to PDF
+* DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
+* TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
+* Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
+* XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
+* iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
+
+
+File: org, Node: Selective export, Next: Export options, Prev: Exporting, Up: Exporting
+
+12.1 Selective export
+=====================
+
+You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be
+exported, or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed
+by two variables: `org-export-select-tags' and
+`org-export-exclude-tags'.
+
+ Org first checks if any of the _select_ tags is present in the
+buffer. If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be
+excluded. If a selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above
+it will also be selected for export, but not the text below those
+headings.
+
+If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected
+for export.
+
+Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the _exclude_ tags will
+be removed from the export buffer.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Export options, Next: The export dispatcher, Prev: Selective export, Up: Exporting
+
+12.2 Export options
+===================
+
+The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
+additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
+The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with `C-c C-e
+t'. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
+correct is to type `#+' and then use `M-<TAB>' completion (*note
+Completion::). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
+specifically related to export, see *Note In-buffer settings::. In
+particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in a
+separate file which can be included using `#+SETUPFILE'.
+
+`C-c C-e t (`org-insert-export-options-template')'
+ Insert template with export options, see example below.
+
+ #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
+ #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from `user-full-name')
+ #+DATE: a date, fixed, or a format string for `format-time-string'
+ #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from `user-mail-address')
+ #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
+ #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
+ #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g. `en' (`org-export-default-language')
+ #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
+ #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
+ #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
+ #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.: org-export-latex-low-levels itemize
+ You need to confirm using these, or configure `org-export-allow-BIND'
+ #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
+ #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
+ #+LATEX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the LaTeX header, like \usepackage{xyz}
+ #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
+ #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
+ #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
+
+The OPTIONS line is a compact(1) form to specify export settings. Here
+you can:
+ H: set the number of headline levels for export
+ num: turn on/off section-numbers
+ toc: turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)
+ \n: turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)
+ @: turn on/off quoted HTML tags
+ :: turn on/off fixed-width sections
+ |: turn on/off tables
+ ^: turn on/off TeX-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If
+ you write "^:{}", `a_{b}' will be interpreted, but
+ the simple `a_b' will be left as it is.
+ -: turn on/off conversion of special strings.
+ f: turn on/off footnotes like this[1].
+ todo: turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text
+ pri: turn on/off priority cookies
+ tags: turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be `not-in-toc'
+ <: turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES
+ *: turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)
+ TeX: turn on/off simple TeX macros in plain text
+ LaTeX: configure export of LaTeX fragments. Default `auto'
+ skip: turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading
+ author: turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file
+ email: turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file
+ creator: turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file
+ timestamp: turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file
+ d: turn on/off inclusion of drawers
+ These options take effect in both the HTML and LaTeX export, except
+for `TeX' and `LaTeX', which are respectively `t' and `nil' for the
+LaTeX export. The default values for these and many other options are
+given by a set of variables. For a list of such variables, the
+corresponding OPTIONS keys and also the publishing keys (*note Project
+alist::), see the constant `org-export-plist-vars'.
+
+ When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with `C-c @'
+before calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the
+file's export settings with properties `EXPORT_FILE_NAME',
+`EXPORT_TITLE', `EXPORT_TEXT', `EXPORT_AUTHOR', `EXPORT_DATE', and
+`EXPORT_OPTIONS'.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) If you want to configure many options this way, you can use
+several OPTIONS lines.
+
+
+File: org, Node: The export dispatcher, Next: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Prev: Export options, Up: Exporting
+
+12.3 The export dispatcher
+==========================
+
+All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which
+is a prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the
+command. Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an
+active region that contains one outline tree, the first heading is used
+as document title and the subtrees are exported.
+
+`C-c C-e (`org-export')'
+ Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a
+ help-window listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an
+ export or publishing command. The prefix arg is passed through to
+ the exporter. A double prefix `C-u C-u' causes most commands to
+ be executed in the background, in a separate Emacs process(1).
+
+`C-c C-e v (`org-export-visible')'
+ Like `C-c C-e', but only export the text that is currently visible
+ (i.e. not hidden by outline visibility).
+
+`C-u C-u C-c C-e (`org-export')'
+ Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
+ `org-export-run-in-background', i.e. request background processing
+ if not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if
+ set.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) To make this behavior the default, customize the variable
+`org-export-run-in-background'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Next: HTML export, Prev: The export dispatcher, Up: Exporting
+
+12.4 ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
+===============================
+
+ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org-mode
+file, containing only plain ASCII. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment
+the file with special characters and symbols available in these
+encodings.
+
+`C-c C-e a (`org-export-as-ascii')'
+ Export as ASCII file. For an Org file, `myfile.org', the ASCII
+ file will be `myfile.txt'. The file will be overwritten without
+ warning. If there is an active region(1), only the region will be
+ exported. If the selected region is a single tree(2), the tree
+ head will become the document title. If the tree head entry has
+ or inherits an `EXPORT_FILE_NAME' property, that name will be used
+ for the export.
+
+`C-c C-e A (`org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer')'
+ Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
+
+`C-c C-e n (`org-export-as-latin1')'
+`C-c C-e N (`org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer')'
+ Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
+
+`C-c C-e u (`org-export-as-utf8')'
+`C-c C-e U (`org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer')'
+ Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
+
+`C-c C-e v a/n/u'
+ Export only the visible part of the document.
+
+ In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
+headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
+will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to
+occur at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For
+example,
+
+ C-1 C-c C-e a
+
+creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When
+headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
+the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
+the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation
+of the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to
+preserve the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines
+with less indentation than the first, these are left alone.
+
+ Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the
+descriptive part in the text and the link in a note before the next
+heading. See the variable `org-export-ascii-links-to-notes' for
+details and other options.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) This requires `transient-mark-mode' be turned on.
+
+ (2) To select the current subtree, use `C-c @'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: HTML export, Next: LaTeX and PDF export, Prev: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Up: Exporting
+
+12.5 HTML export
+================
+
+Org-mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
+HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's _markdown_ language,
+but with additional support for tables.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
+* Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
+* Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
+* Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
+* Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
+* Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
+* Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
+* CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
+* JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
+
+
+File: org, Node: HTML Export commands, Next: Quoting HTML tags, Prev: HTML export, Up: HTML export
+
+12.5.1 HTML export commands
+---------------------------
+
+`C-c C-e h (`org-export-as-html')'
+ Export as HTML file `myfile.html'. For an Org file `myfile.org',
+ the ASCII file will be `myfile.html'. The file will be overwritten
+ without warning. If there is an active region(1), only the region
+ will be exported. If the selected region is a single tree(2), the
+ tree head will become the document title. If the tree head entry
+ has, or inherits, an `EXPORT_FILE_NAME' property, that name will
+ be used for the export.
+
+`C-c C-e b (`org-export-as-html-and-open')'
+ Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
+
+`C-c C-e H (`org-export-as-html-to-buffer')'
+ Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
+
+`C-c C-e R (`org-export-region-as-html')'
+ Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix
+ argument, do not produce the file header and footer, but just the
+ plain HTML section for the region. This is good for cut-and-paste
+ operations.
+
+`C-c C-e v h/b/H/R'
+ Export only the visible part of the document.
+
+`M-x org-export-region-as-html'
+ Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was
+ Org-mode syntax before. This is a global command that can be
+ invoked in any buffer.
+
+`M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML'
+ Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by
+ HTML code.
+
+ In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
+headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
+will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to
+occur at a different level, specify it with a numeric prefix argument.
+For example,
+
+ C-2 C-c C-e b
+
+creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) This requires `transient-mark-mode' be turned on.
+
+ (2) To select the current subtree, use `C-c @'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Quoting HTML tags, Next: Links in HTML export, Prev: HTML Export commands, Up: HTML export
+
+12.5.2 Quoting HTML tags
+------------------------
+
+Plain `<' and `>' are always transformed to `&lt;' and `&gt;' in HTML
+export. If you want to include simple HTML tags which should be
+interpreted as such, mark them with `@' as in `@<b>bold text@</b>'.
+Note that this really works only for simple tags. For more extensive
+HTML that should be copied verbatim to the exported file use either
+
+ #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
+
+or
+
+ #+BEGIN_HTML
+ All lines between these markers are exported literally
+ #+END_HTML
+
+
+File: org, Node: Links in HTML export, Next: Tables in HTML export, Prev: Quoting HTML tags, Up: HTML export
+
+12.5.3 Links in HTML export
+---------------------------
+
+Internal links (*note Internal links::) will continue to work in HTML.
+This includes automatic links created by radio targets (*note Radio
+targets::). Links to external files will still work if the target file
+is on the same relative path as the published Org file. Links to other
+`.org' files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
+that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same
+relative path. `id:' links can then be used to jump to specific
+entries across files. For information related to linking files while
+publishing them to a publishing directory see *Note Publishing links::.
+
+ If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a
+special `#+ATTR_HTML' line to define attributes that will be added to
+the `<a>' or `<img>' tags. Here is an example that sets `title' and
+`style' attributes for a link:
+
+ #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org-mode homepage" style="color:red;"
+ [[http://orgmode.org]]
+
+
+File: org, Node: Tables in HTML export, Next: Images in HTML export, Prev: Links in HTML export, Up: HTML export
+
+12.5.4 Tables
+-------------
+
+Org-mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
+`org-export-html-table-tag'. The default setting makes tables without
+cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
+tables, place something like the following before the table:
+
+ #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
+ #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="all"
+
+
+File: org, Node: Images in HTML export, Next: Math formatting in HTML export, Prev: Tables in HTML export, Up: HTML export
+
+12.5.5 Images in HTML export
+----------------------------
+
+HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and it
+can make an image the clickable part of a link. By default(1), images
+are inlined if a link does not have a description. So
+`[[file:myimg.jpg]]' will be inlined, while `[[file:myimg.jpg][the
+image]]' will just produce a link `the image' that points to the image.
+If the description part itself is a `file:' link or a `http:' URL
+pointing to an image, this image will be inlined and activated so that
+clicking on the image will activate the link. For example, to include
+a thumbnail that will link to a high resolution version of the image,
+you could use:
+
+ [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
+
+ If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a
+`#+ATTR_HTML'. In the example below we specify the `alt' and `title'
+attributes to support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to
+the right.
+
+ #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
+ #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
+ [[./img/a.jpg]]
+
+and you could use `http' addresses just as well.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) But see the variable `org-export-html-inline-images'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Math formatting in HTML export, Next: Text areas in HTML export, Prev: Images in HTML export, Up: HTML export
+
+12.5.6 Math formatting in HTML export
+-------------------------------------
+
+LaTeX math snippets (*note LaTeX fragments::) can be displayed in two
+different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the MathJax system
+(http://www.mathjax.org) which should work out of the box with Org mode
+installation because `http://orgmode.org' serves `MathJax' for Org-mode
+users for small applications and for testing purposes. If you plan to
+use this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should
+install(1) MathJax on your own server in order to limit the load of our
+server. To configure `MathJax', use the variable
+`org-export-html-mathjax-options' or insert something like the
+following into the buffer:
+
+ #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
+
+See the docstring of the variable `org-export-html-mathjax-options' for
+the meaning of the parameters in this line.
+
+ If you prefer, you can also request that LaTeX fragments are
+processed into small images that will be inserted into the browser
+page. Before the availability of MathJax, this was the default method
+for Org files. This method requires that the `dvipng' program is
+available on your system. You can still get this processing with
+
+ #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Installation instructions can be found on the MathJax website,
+see `http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Text areas in HTML export, Next: CSS support, Prev: Math formatting in HTML export, Up: HTML export
+
+12.5.7 Text areas in HTML export
+--------------------------------
+
+An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use
+text areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into
+an application. It is triggered by a `-t' switch at an `example' or
+`src' block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
+label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may
+also use `-h' and `-w' switches to specify the height and width of the
+text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
+respectively. For example
+
+ #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
+ (defun org-xor (a b)
+ "Exclusive or."
+ (if a (not b) b))
+ #+END_EXAMPLE
+
+
+File: org, Node: CSS support, Next: JavaScript support, Prev: Text areas in HTML export, Up: HTML export
+
+12.5.8 CSS support
+------------------
+
+You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML
+exporter assigns the following special CSS classes(1) to appropriate
+parts of the document--your style specifications may change these, in
+addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
+ p.author author information, including email
+ p.date publishing date
+ p.creator creator info, about org-mode version
+ .title document title
+ .todo TODO keywords, all not-done states
+ .done the DONE keywords, all stated the count as done
+ .WAITING each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself
+ .timestamp timestamp
+ .timestamp-kwd keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED
+ .timestamp-wrapper span around keyword plus timestamp
+ .tag tag in a headline
+ ._HOME each tag uses itself as a class, "@" replaced by "_"
+ .target target for links
+ .linenr the line number in a code example
+ .code-highlighted for highlighting referenced code lines
+ div.outline-N div for outline level N (headline plus text))
+ div.outline-text-N extra div for text at outline level N
+ .section-number-N section number in headlines, different for each level
+ div.figure how to format an inlined image
+ pre.src formatted source code
+ pre.example normal example
+ p.verse verse paragraph
+ div.footnotes footnote section headline
+ p.footnote footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote
+ .footref a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)
+ .footnum footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)
+
+ Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines
+these classes in a basic way(2). You may overwrite these settings, or
+add to them by using the variables `org-export-html-style' (for
+Org-wide settings) and `org-export-html-style-extra' (for more
+fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter
+variable individually for each file, you can use
+
+ #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
+
+For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You
+could also directly write a `<style>' `</style>' section in this way,
+without referring to an external file.
+
+ In order to add styles to a subtree, use the `:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:'
+property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles
+for a particular headline, you can use the id specified in a
+`:CUSTOM_ID:' property.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) If the classes on TODO keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use
+the variables `org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix' and
+`org-export-html-tag-class-prefix' to make them unique.
+
+ (2) This style is defined in the constant
+`org-export-html-style-default', which you should not modify. To turn
+inclusion of these defaults off, customize
+`org-export-html-style-include-default'
+
+
+File: org, Node: JavaScript support, Prev: CSS support, Up: HTML export
+
+12.5.9 JavaScript supported display of web pages
+------------------------------------------------
+
+Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
+enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
+program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The
+first one is an _Info_-like mode where each section is displayed
+separately and navigation can be done with the `n' and `p' keys (and
+some other keys as well, press `?' for an overview of the available
+keys). The second view type is a _folding_ view much like Org provides
+inside Emacs. The script is available at
+`http://orgmode.org/org-info.js' and you can find the documentation for
+it at `http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/'. We host the script
+at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might not want to be
+dependent on `orgmode.org' and prefer to install a local copy on your
+own web server.
+
+ To use the script, you need to make sure that the `org-jsinfo.el'
+module gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try
+`M-x customize-variable <RET> org-modules <RET>' to convince yourself
+that this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the
+program is adding a single line to the Org file:
+
+ #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
+
+If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the
+code needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set
+the following viewing options:
+
+ path: The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from
+ `http://orgmode.org/org-info.js', but you might want to have
+ a local copy and use a path like `../scripts/org-info.js'.
+ view: Initial view when website is first shown. Possible values are:
+ info Info-like interface with one section per page.
+ overview Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.
+ content Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.
+ showall Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.
+ sdepth: Maximum headline level that will still become an independent
+ section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from
+ `org-export-headline-levels' (= the `H' switch in `#+OPTIONS').
+ If this is smaller than in `org-export-headline-levels', each
+ info/folding section can still contain child headlines.
+ toc: Should the table of contents _initially_ be visible?
+ Even when `nil', you can always get to the "toc" with `i'.
+ tdepth: The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from
+ the variables `org-export-headline-levels' and `org-export-with-toc'.
+ ftoc: Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?
+ If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.
+ ltoc: Should there be short contents (children) in each section?
+ Make this `above' if the section should be above initial text.
+ mouse: Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be
+ `underline' (default) or a background color like `#cccccc'.
+ buttons: Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When `nil' (the
+ default), only one such button will be present.
+ You can choose default values for these options by customizing the
+variable `org-infojs-options'. If you always want to apply the script
+to your pages, configure the variable `org-export-html-use-infojs'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: LaTeX and PDF export, Next: DocBook export, Prev: HTML export, Up: Exporting
+
+12.6 LaTeX and PDF export
+=========================
+
+Org-mode contains a LaTeX exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
+further processing(1), this backend is also used to produce PDF output.
+Since the LaTeX output uses `hyperref' to implement links and cross
+references, the PDF output file will be fully linked.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
+* Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
+* Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal LaTeX code
+* Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to LaTeX
+* Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into LaTeX output
+* Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) The default LaTeX output is designed for processing with pdftex
+or latex. It includes packages that are not compatible with xetex and
+possibly luatex. See the variables
+`org-export-latex-default-packages-alist' and
+`org-export-latex-packages-alist'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: LaTeX/PDF export commands, Next: Header and sectioning, Prev: LaTeX and PDF export, Up: LaTeX and PDF export
+
+12.6.1 LaTeX export commands
+----------------------------
+
+`C-c C-e l (`org-export-as-latex')'
+ Export as LaTeX file `myfile.tex'. For an Org file `myfile.org',
+ the ASCII file will be `myfile.tex'. The file will be overwritten
+ without warning. If there is an active region(1), only the region
+ will be exported. If the selected region is a single tree(2), the
+ tree head will become the document title. If the tree head entry
+ has or inherits an `EXPORT_FILE_NAME' property, that name will be
+ used for the export.
+
+`C-c C-e L (`org-export-as-latex-to-buffer')'
+ Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
+
+`C-c C-e v l/L'
+ Export only the visible part of the document.
+
+`M-x org-export-region-as-latex'
+ Convert the region to LaTeX under the assumption that it was
+ Org-mode syntax before. This is a global command that can be
+ invoked in any buffer.
+
+`M-x org-replace-region-by-latex'
+ Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by
+ LaTeX code.
+
+`C-c C-e p (`org-export-as-pdf')'
+ Export as LaTeX and then process to PDF.
+
+`C-c C-e d (`org-export-as-pdf-and-open')'
+ Export as LaTeX and then process to PDF, then open the resulting
+ PDF file.
+
+ In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
+headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
+will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
+convert them to a custom string depending on `org-latex-low-levels'.
+
+ If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
+with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
+
+ C-2 C-c C-e l
+
+creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) This requires `transient-mark-mode' be turned on.
+
+ (2) To select the current subtree, use `C-c @'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Header and sectioning, Next: Quoting LaTeX code, Prev: LaTeX/PDF export commands, Up: LaTeX and PDF export
+
+12.6.2 Header and sectioning structure
+--------------------------------------
+
+By default, the LaTeX output uses the class `article'.
+
+ You can change this globally by setting a different value for
+`org-export-latex-default-class' or locally by adding an option like
+`#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass' in your file, or with a `:LaTeX_CLASS:'
+property that applies when exporting a region containing only this
+(sub)tree. The class must be listed in `org-export-latex-classes'.
+This variable defines a header template for each class(1), and allows
+you to define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also
+define your own classes there. `#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS' or a
+`LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS' property can specify the options for the
+`\documentclass' macro. You can also use `#+LATEX_HEADER:
+\usepackage{xyz}' to add lines to the header. See the docstring of
+`org-export-latex-classes' for more information.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Into which the values of
+`org-export-latex-default-packages-alist' and
+`org-export-latex-packages-alist' are spliced.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Quoting LaTeX code, Next: Tables in LaTeX export, Prev: Header and sectioning, Up: LaTeX and PDF export
+
+12.6.3 Quoting LaTeX code
+-------------------------
+
+Embedded LaTeX as described in *Note Embedded LaTeX::, will be correctly
+inserted into the LaTeX file. This includes simple macros like
+`\ref{LABEL}' to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
+you can add special code that should only be present in LaTeX export
+with the following constructs:
+
+ #+LaTeX: Literal LaTeX code for export
+
+or
+
+ #+BEGIN_LaTeX
+ All lines between these markers are exported literally
+ #+END_LaTeX
+
+
+File: org, Node: Tables in LaTeX export, Next: Images in LaTeX export, Prev: Quoting LaTeX code, Up: LaTeX and PDF export
+
+12.6.4 Tables in LaTeX export
+-----------------------------
+
+For LaTeX export of a table, you can specify a label and a caption
+(*note Images and tables::). You can also use the `ATTR_LaTeX' line to
+request a `longtable' environment for the table, so that it may span
+several pages, or provide the `multicolumn' keyword that will make the
+table span the page in a multicolumn environment (`table*' environment).
+Finally, you can set the alignment string:
+
+ #+CAPTION: A long table
+ #+LABEL: tbl:long
+ #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp{3cm}r|l
+ | ..... | ..... |
+ | ..... | ..... |
+
+
+File: org, Node: Images in LaTeX export, Next: Beamer class export, Prev: Tables in LaTeX export, Up: LaTeX and PDF export
+
+12.6.5 Images in LaTeX export
+-----------------------------
+
+Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
+`[[file:img.jpg]]' or `[[./img.jpg]]' will be inserted into the PDF
+output file resulting from LaTeX processing. Org will use an
+`\includegraphics' macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
+caption and/or a label as described in *Note Images and tables::, the
+figure will be wrapped into a `figure' environment and thus become a
+floating element. You can use an `#+ATTR_LaTeX:' line to specify the
+various options that can be used in the optional argument of the
+`\includegraphics' macro. To modify the placement option of the
+`figure' environment, add something like `placement=[h!]' to the
+Attributes.
+
+ If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word
+`wrap' to the `#+ATTR_LaTeX:' line, which will make the figure occupy
+the left half of the page. To fine-tune, the `placement' field will be
+the set of additional arguments needed by the `wrapfigure' environment.
+Note that if you change the size of the image, you need to use
+compatible settings for `\includegraphics' and `wrapfigure'.
+
+ #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
+ #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
+ #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
+ [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
+
+ #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement={r}{0.4\textwidth}
+ [[./img/hst.png]]
+
+ If you need references to a label created in this way, write
+`\ref{fig:SED-HR4049}' just like in LaTeX.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Beamer class export, Prev: Images in LaTeX export, Up: LaTeX and PDF export
+
+12.6.6 Beamer class export
+--------------------------
+
+The LaTeX class `beamer' allows production of high quality presentations
+using LaTeX and pdf processing. Org-mode has special support for
+turning an Org-mode file or tree into a `beamer' presentation.
+
+ When the LaTeX class for the current buffer (as set with
+`#+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer') or subtree (set with a `LaTeX_CLASS' property)
+is `beamer', a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a
+beamer presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should
+in principle be exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the
+top-level entries (or the first level below the selected subtree
+heading) will be turned into frames, and the outline structure below
+this level will become itemize lists. You can also configure the
+variable `org-beamer-frame-level' to a different level--then the
+hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning structure of the
+presentation.
+
+ A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be
+inserted into the buffer with `M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template'.
+Among other things, this will install a column view format which is
+very handy for editing special properties used by beamer.
+
+ You can influence the structure of the presentation using the
+following properties:
+
+`BEAMER_env'
+ The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid
+ environments are defined in the constant
+ `org-beamer-environments-default', and you can define more in
+ `org-beamer-environments-extra'. If this property is set, the
+ entry will also get a `:B_environment:' tag to make this visible.
+ This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
+
+`BEAMER_envargs'
+ The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the
+ environment, like `[t]' or `[<+->]' of `<2-3>'. If the
+ `BEAMER_col' property is also set, something like `C[t]' can be
+ added here as well to set an options argument for the implied
+ `columns' environment. `c[t]' or `c<2->' will set an options for
+ the implied `column' environment.
+
+`BEAMER_col'
+ The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this
+ property is set, the entry will also get a `:BMCOL:' property to
+ make this visible. Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this
+ is a plain number, it will be interpreted as a fraction of
+ `\textwidth'. Otherwise it will be assumed that you have
+ specified the units, like `3cm'. The first such property in a
+ frame will start a `columns' environment to surround the columns.
+ This environment is closed when an entry has a `BEAMER_col'
+ property with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the
+ frame.
+
+`BEAMER_extra'
+ Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment
+ has been opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be
+ used to specify transitions.
+
+ Frames will automatically receive a `fragile' option if they contain
+source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special `beamer'
+specific code can be inserted using `#+BEAMER:' and
+`#+BEGIN_beamer...#+end_beamer' constructs, similar to other export
+backends, but with the difference that `#+LaTeX:' stuff will be included
+in the presentation as well.
+
+ Outline nodes with `BEAMER_env' property value `note' or `noteNH'
+will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped into
+`\note{...}'. The former will include the heading as part of the note
+text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
+generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a _tag_ (either
+`:B_note:' or `:B_noteNH:') instead of creating the `BEAMER_env'
+property.
+
+ You can turn on a special minor mode `org-beamer-mode' for editing
+support with
+
+ #+STARTUP: beamer
+
+`C-c C-b (`org-beamer-select-environment')'
+ In `org-beamer-mode', this key offers fast selection of a beamer
+ environment or the `BEAMER_col' property.
+
+ Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node
+and other important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN
+format that is geared toward this special purpose. The command `M-x
+org-insert-beamer-options-template' defines such a format.
+
+ Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer
+export.
+
+ #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
+ #+TITLE: Example Presentation
+ #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
+ #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
+ #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
+ #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme{Madrid}\usecolortheme{default}
+ #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
+
+ * This is the first structural section
+
+ ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
+ *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :BEAMER_env: block
+ :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
+ :BEAMER_col: 0.5
+ :END:
+ for the first viable beamer setup in Org
+ *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :BEAMER_col: 0.5
+ :BEAMER_env: block
+ :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
+ :END:
+ for contributing to the discussion
+ **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
+ ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
+ *** Request :B_block:
+ Please test this stuff!
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :BEAMER_env: block
+ :END:
+
+ For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
+
+
+File: org, Node: DocBook export, Next: TaskJuggler export, Prev: LaTeX and PDF export, Up: Exporting
+
+12.7 DocBook export
+===================
+
+Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org
+file is exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to
+produce other formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many
+available DocBook tools and stylesheets.
+
+ Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
+* Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
+* Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
+* Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
+* Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
+* Special characters:: How to handle special characters
+
+
+File: org, Node: DocBook export commands, Next: Quoting DocBook code, Prev: DocBook export, Up: DocBook export
+
+12.7.1 DocBook export commands
+------------------------------
+
+`C-c C-e D (`org-export-as-docbook')'
+ Export as DocBook file. For an Org file, `myfile.org', the
+ DocBook XML file will be `myfile.xml'. The file will be
+ overwritten without warning. If there is an active region(1),
+ only the region will be exported. If the selected region is a
+ single tree(2), the tree head will become the document title. If
+ the tree head entry has, or inherits, an `EXPORT_FILE_NAME'
+ property, that name will be used for the export.
+
+`C-c C-e V (`org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open')'
+ Export as DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting
+ PDF file.
+
+ Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on exported
+ DocBook file, you need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor
+ software installed on your system. Check variables
+ `org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command' and
+ `org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command'.
+
+ The stylesheet argument `%s' in variable
+ `org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command' is replaced by the value of
+ variable `org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet', which needs to be
+ set by the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a
+ per-file basis by adding an in-buffer setting `#+XSLT:' to the Org
+ file.
+
+`C-c C-e v D'
+ Export only the visible part of the document.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) This requires `transient-mark-mode' to be turned on
+
+ (2) To select the current subtree, use `C-c @'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Quoting DocBook code, Next: Recursive sections, Prev: DocBook export commands, Up: DocBook export
+
+12.7.2 Quoting DocBook code
+---------------------------
+
+You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into
+exported DocBook file with the following constructs:
+
+ #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
+
+or
+
+ #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
+ All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
+ literally.
+ #+END_DOCBOOK
+
+ For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook
+warning admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay
+attention to the document context when quoting DocBook code in Org
+files. You may make exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting
+DocBook code correctly.
+
+ #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
+ <warning>
+ <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
+ in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
+ DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
+ </warning>
+ #+END_DOCBOOK
+
+
+File: org, Node: Recursive sections, Next: Tables in DocBook export, Prev: Quoting DocBook code, Up: DocBook export
+
+12.7.3 Recursive sections
+-------------------------
+
+DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the `article'
+element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e. `section' elements, are
+used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are
+exported as top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported
+as nested sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported
+completely, no matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
+
+ Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported
+DocBook code in other DocBook document types like `book' or `set'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Tables in DocBook export, Next: Images in DocBook export, Prev: Recursive sections, Up: DocBook export
+
+12.7.4 Tables in DocBook export
+-------------------------------
+
+Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been
+supported since DocBook V4.3.
+
+ If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated
+using the `informaltable' element; otherwise, a formal table will be
+generated using the `table' element.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Images in DocBook export, Next: Special characters, Prev: Tables in DocBook export, Up: DocBook export
+
+12.7.5 Images in DocBook export
+-------------------------------
+
+Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
+`[[file:img.jpg]]' or `[[./img.jpg]]', will be exported to DocBook
+using `mediaobject' elements. Each `mediaobject' element contains an
+`imageobject' that wraps an `imagedata' element. If you have specified
+a caption for an image as described in *Note Images and tables::, a
+`caption' element will be added in `mediaobject'. If a label is also
+specified, it will be exported as an `xml:id' attribute of the
+`mediaobject' element.
+
+ Image attributes supported by the `imagedata' element, like `align'
+or `width', can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
+variable `org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes' or use the
+`#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:' line. Attributes specified in variable
+`org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes' are applied to all inline
+images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by
+image attributes specified in `#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:' lines).
+
+ The `#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:' line can be used to specify additional image
+attributes or override default image attributes for individual images.
+If the same attribute appears in both the `#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:' line and
+variable `org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes', the former
+takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
+set:
+
+ #+CAPTION: The logo of Org-mode
+ #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
+ #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
+ [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
+
+ By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file
+types: `jpeg', `jpg', `png', `gif', and `svg'. You can customize
+variable `org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions' to add more types
+to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Special characters, Prev: Images in DocBook export, Up: DocBook export
+
+12.7.6 Special characters in DocBook export
+-------------------------------------------
+
+Special characters that are written in TeX-like syntax, such as
+`\alpha', `\Gamma', and `\Zeta', are supported by DocBook exporter.
+These characters are rewritten to XML entities, like `&alpha;',
+`&Gamma;', and `&Zeta;', based on the list saved in variable
+`org-entities'. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
+corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
+
+ You can customize variable `org-export-docbook-doctype' to include
+the entities you need. For example, you can set variable
+`org-export-docbook-doctype' to the following value to recognize all
+special characters included in XHTML entities:
+
+ "<!DOCTYPE article [
+ <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
+ \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
+ \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
+ >
+ %xhtml1-symbol;
+ ]>
+ "
+
+
+File: org, Node: TaskJuggler export, Next: Freemind export, Prev: DocBook export, Up: Exporting
+
+12.8 TaskJuggler export
+=======================
+
+TaskJuggler (http://www.taskjuggler.org/) is a project management tool.
+It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time
+lines and resource assignments based on the project outline and the
+constraints that you have provided.
+
+ The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters,
+such as the HTML and LaTeX exporters for example, in that it does not
+export all the nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the
+nodes in the document.
+
+ Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the
+tasks and a optionally tree that defines the resources for this
+project. It then creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and
+the attributes defined in all the nodes.
+
+12.8.1 TaskJuggler export commands
+----------------------------------
+
+`C-c C-e j (`org-export-as-taskjuggler')'
+ Export as TaskJuggler file.
+
+`C-c C-e J (`org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open')'
+ Export as TaskJuggler file and then open the file with
+ TaskJugglerUI.
+
+12.8.2 Tasks
+------------
+
+Create your tasks as you usually do with Org-mode. Assign efforts to
+each task using properties (it's easiest to do this in the column
+view). You should end up with something similar to the example by Peter
+Jones in
+`http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org'.
+Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
+`:taskjuggler_project:' (or whatever you customized
+`org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag' to). You are now ready to export
+the project plan with `C-c C-e J' which will export the project plan and
+open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
+
+12.8.3 Resources
+----------------
+
+Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific
+tasks. You can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of
+the resources with `:taskjuggler_resource:' (or whatever you customized
+`org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag' to). You can optionally assign an
+identifier (named `resource_id') to the resources (using the standard
+Org properties commands, *note Property syntax::) or you can let the
+exporter generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the
+first word of the headline as the identifier as long as it is
+unique--see the documentation of `org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id').
+Using that identifier you can then allocate resources to tasks. This is
+again done with the `allocate' property on the tasks. Do this in column
+view or when on the task type `C-c C-x p allocate <RET> <resource_id>
+<RET>'.
+
+ Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler
+and check in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on
+what task at what time.
+
+12.8.4 Export of properties
+---------------------------
+
+The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e.
+if a task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
+TaskJuggler (`complete 100'). Also it will export any property on a task
+resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
+`limits', `vacation', `shift', `booking', `efficiency', `journalentry',
+`rate' for resources or `account', `start', `note', `duration', `end',
+`journalentry', `milestone', `reference', `responsible', `scheduling',
+etc for tasks.
+
+12.8.5 Dependencies
+-------------------
+
+The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks
+either with the `ORDERED' attribute (*note TODO dependencies::), with
+the `BLOCKER' attribute (see `org-depend.el') or alternatively with a
+`depends' attribute. Both the `BLOCKER' and the `depends' attribute can
+be either `previous-sibling' or a reference to an identifier (named
+`task_id') which is defined for another task in the project. `BLOCKER'
+and the `depends' attribute can define multiple dependencies separated
+by either space or comma. You can also specify optional attributes on
+the dependency by simply appending it. The following examples should
+illustrate this:
+
+ * Preparation
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :task_id: preparation
+ :ORDERED: t
+ :END:
+ * Training material
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :task_id: training_material
+ :ORDERED: t
+ :END:
+ ** Markup Guidelines
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :Effort: 2.0
+ :END:
+ ** Workflow Guidelines
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :Effort: 2.0
+ :END:
+ * Presentation
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :Effort: 2.0
+ :BLOCKER: training_material { gapduration 1d } preparation
+ :END:
+
+12.8.6 Reports
+--------------
+
+TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g. gantt chart,
+resource allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should
+be generated for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will
+automatically insert some default reports in the file. These defaults
+are defined in `org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports'. They can be
+modified using customize along with a number of other options. For a
+more complete list, see `M-x customize-group <RET>
+org-export-taskjuggler <RET>'.
+
+ For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
+`http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.php'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Freemind export, Next: XOXO export, Prev: TaskJuggler export, Up: Exporting
+
+12.9 Freemind export
+====================
+
+The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
+
+`C-c C-e m (`org-export-as-freemind')'
+ Export as Freemind mind map `myfile.mm'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: XOXO export, Next: iCalendar export, Prev: Freemind export, Up: Exporting
+
+12.10 XOXO export
+=================
+
+Org-mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
+Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
+does not interpret any additional Org-mode features.
+
+`C-c C-e x (`org-export-as-xoxo')'
+ Export as XOXO file `myfile.html'.
+
+`C-c C-e v x'
+ Export only the visible part of the document.
+
+
+File: org, Node: iCalendar export, Prev: XOXO export, Up: Exporting
+
+12.11 iCalendar export
+======================
+
+Some people use Org-mode for keeping track of projects, but still
+prefer a standard calendar application for anniversaries and
+appointments. In this case it can be useful to show deadlines and
+other time-stamped items in Org files in the calendar application.
+Org-mode can export calendar information in the standard iCalendar
+format. If you also want to have TODO entries included in the export,
+configure the variable `org-icalendar-include-todo'. Plain timestamps
+are exported as VEVENT, and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create
+events from deadlines that are in non-TODO items. Deadlines and
+scheduling dates in TODO items will be used to set the start and due
+dates for the TODO entry(1). As categories, it will use the tags
+locally defined in the heading, and the file/tree category(2). See the
+variable `org-icalendar-alarm-time' for a way to assign alarms to
+entries with a time.
+
+ The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
+identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you
+set the variable `org-icalendar-store-UID', the UID will be stored in
+the `:ID:' property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
+entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar
+entries (as a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO
+item), Org adds prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the
+inclusion of the entry. In this way the UID remains unique, but a
+synchronization program can still figure out from which entry all the
+different instances originate.
+
+`C-c C-e i (`org-export-icalendar-this-file')'
+ Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in
+ the same directory, using a file extension `.ics'.
+
+`C-c C-e I (`org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files')'
+ Like `C-c C-e i', but do this for all files in `org-agenda-files'.
+ For each of these files, a separate iCalendar file will be
+ written.
+
+`C-c C-e c (`org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files')'
+ Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
+ `org-agenda-files' and write it to the file given by
+ `org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file'.
+
+ The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION(3)
+properties if the selected entries have them. If not, the summary will
+be derived from the headline, and the description from the body
+(limited to `org-icalendar-include-body' characters).
+
+ How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the
+application you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) See the variables `org-icalendar-use-deadline' and
+`org-icalendar-use-scheduled'.
+
+ (2) To add inherited tags or the TODO state, configure the variable
+`org-icalendar-categories'.
+
+ (3) The LOCATION property can be inherited from higher in the
+hierarchy if you configure `org-use-property-inheritance' accordingly.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Publishing, Next: Working With Source Code, Prev: Exporting, Up: Top
+
+13 Publishing
+*************
+
+Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
+automatic HTML conversion of _projects_ composed of interlinked org
+files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your
+exported HTML pages and related attachments, such as images and source
+code files, to a web server.
+
+ You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML
+and PDF conversion so that files are available in both formats on the
+server.
+
+ Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Configuration:: Defining projects
+* Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
+* Sample configuration:: Example projects
+* Triggering publication:: Publication commands
+
+
+File: org, Node: Configuration, Next: Uploading files, Prev: Publishing, Up: Publishing
+
+13.1 Configuration
+==================
+
+Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
+and many other properties of a project.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Project alist:: The central configuration variable
+* Sources and destinations:: From here to there
+* Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
+* Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
+* Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
+* Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
+* Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
+* Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
+
+
+File: org, Node: Project alist, Next: Sources and destinations, Prev: Configuration, Up: Configuration
+
+13.1.1 The variable `org-publish-project-alist'
+-----------------------------------------------
+
+Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of
+one variable, called `org-publish-project-alist'. Each element of the
+list configures one project, and may be in one of the two following
+forms:
+
+ ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
+ i.e. a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values
+ or
+ ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
+
+ In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property
+values. A project defines the set of files that will be published, as
+well as the publishing configuration to use when publishing those
+files. When a project takes the second form listed above, the
+individual members of the `:components' property are taken to be
+sub-projects, which group together files requiring different publishing
+options. When you publish such a "meta-project", all the components
+will also be published, in the sequence given.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Sources and destinations, Next: Selecting files, Prev: Project alist, Up: Configuration
+
+13.1.2 Sources and destinations for files
+-----------------------------------------
+
+Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
+particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files, and where
+to put published files.
+
+`:base-directory' Directory containing publishing source files
+`:publishing-directory'Directory where output files will be published.
+ You can directly publish to a webserver using a
+ file name syntax appropriate for the Emacs
+ `tramp' package. Or you can publish to a local
+ directory and use external tools to upload your
+ website (*note Uploading files::).
+`:preparation-function'Function or list of functions to be called before
+ starting the publishing process, for example, to
+ run `make' for updating files to be published.
+ The project property list is scoped into this
+ call as the variable `project-plist'.
+`:completion-function' Function or list of functions called after
+ finishing the publishing process, for example, to
+ change permissions of the resulting files. The
+ project property list is scoped into this call as
+ the variable `project-plist'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Selecting files, Next: Publishing action, Prev: Sources and destinations, Up: Configuration
+
+13.1.3 Selecting files
+----------------------
+
+By default, all files with extension `.org' in the base directory are
+considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
+properties
+`:base-extension' Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This
+ actually is a regular expression. Set this to the
+ symbol `any' if you want to get all files in
+ `:base-directory', even without extension.
+`:exclude' Regular expression to match file names that should
+ not be published, even though they have been selected
+ on the basis of their extension.
+`:include' List of files to be included regardless of
+ `:base-extension' and `:exclude'.
+`:recursive' Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for
+ files to publish.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Publishing action, Next: Publishing options, Prev: Selecting files, Up: Configuration
+
+13.1.4 Publishing action
+------------------------
+
+Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
+possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to
+export Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
+`org-publish-org-to-html' which calls the HTML exporter (*note HTML
+export::). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
+`org-publish-org-to-pdf', or as `ascii', `latin1' or `utf8' encoded
+files using the corresponding functions. If you want to publish the
+Org file itself, but with archived, commented, and tag-excluded trees
+removed, use `org-publish-org-to-org' and set the parameters
+`:plain-source' and/or `:htmlized-source'. This will produce
+`file.org' and `file.org.html' in the publishing directory(1). Other
+files like images only need to be copied to the publishing destination;
+for this you may use `org-publish-attachment'. For non-Org files, you
+always need to specify the publishing function:
+
+`:publishing-function' Function executing the publication of a file.
+ This may also be a list of functions, which will
+ all be called in turn.
+`:plain-source' Non-nil means, publish plain source.
+`:htmlized-source' Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
+
+ The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing
+at least a `:publishing-directory' property, the name of the file to be
+published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file.
+It should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation
+(if any) and place the result into the destination folder.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) `file-source.org' and `file-source.org.html' if source and
+publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of setup,
+you need to add `:exclude "-source\\.org"' to the project definition in
+`org-publish-project-alist' to prevent the published source files from
+being considered as new org files the next time the project is
+published.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Publishing options, Next: Publishing links, Prev: Publishing action, Up: Configuration
+
+13.1.5 Options for the HTML/LaTeX exporters
+-------------------------------------------
+
+The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
+and LaTeX exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
+variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along with
+the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
+respective variable for details.
+
+`:link-up' `org-export-html-link-up'
+`:link-home' `org-export-html-link-home'
+`:language' `org-export-default-language'
+`:customtime' `org-display-custom-times'
+`:headline-levels' `org-export-headline-levels'
+`:section-numbers' `org-export-with-section-numbers'
+`:section-number-format'`org-export-section-number-format'
+`:table-of-contents' `org-export-with-toc'
+`:preserve-breaks' `org-export-preserve-breaks'
+`:archived-trees' `org-export-with-archived-trees'
+`:emphasize' `org-export-with-emphasize'
+`:sub-superscript' `org-export-with-sub-superscripts'
+`:special-strings' `org-export-with-special-strings'
+`:footnotes' `org-export-with-footnotes'
+`:drawers' `org-export-with-drawers'
+`:tags' `org-export-with-tags'
+`:todo-keywords' `org-export-with-todo-keywords'
+`:priority' `org-export-with-priority'
+`:TeX-macros' `org-export-with-TeX-macros'
+`:LaTeX-fragments' `org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments'
+`:latex-listings' `org-export-latex-listings'
+`:skip-before-1st-heading'`org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading'
+`:fixed-width' `org-export-with-fixed-width'
+`:timestamps' `org-export-with-timestamps'
+`:author-info' `org-export-author-info'
+`:email-info' `org-export-email-info'
+`:creator-info' `org-export-creator-info'
+`:tables' `org-export-with-tables'
+`:table-auto-headline' `org-export-highlight-first-table-line'
+`:style-include-default'`org-export-html-style-include-default'
+`:style' `org-export-html-style'
+`:style-extra' `org-export-html-style-extra'
+`:convert-org-links' `org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html'
+`:inline-images' `org-export-html-inline-images'
+`:html-extension' `org-export-html-extension'
+`:xml-declaration' `org-export-html-xml-declaration'
+`:html-table-tag' `org-export-html-table-tag'
+`:expand-quoted-html' `org-export-html-expand'
+`:timestamp' `org-export-html-with-timestamp'
+`:publishing-directory' `org-export-publishing-directory'
+`:preamble' `org-export-html-preamble'
+`:postamble' `org-export-html-postamble'
+`:auto-preamble' `org-export-html-auto-preamble'
+`:auto-postamble' `org-export-html-auto-postamble'
+`:author' `user-full-name'
+`:email' `user-mail-address' : `addr;addr;..'
+`:select-tags' `org-export-select-tags'
+`:exclude-tags' `org-export-exclude-tags'
+`:latex-image-options' `org-export-latex-image-default-option'
+
+ Most of the `org-export-with-*' variables have the same effect in
+both HTML and LaTeX exporters, except for `:TeX-macros' and
+`:LaTeX-fragments', respectively `nil' and `t' in the LaTeX export.
+
+ When a property is given a value in `org-publish-project-alist', its
+setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if any)
+during publishing. Options set within a file (*note Export options::),
+however, override everything.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Publishing links, Next: Sitemap, Prev: Publishing options, Up: Configuration
+
+13.1.6 Links between published files
+------------------------------------
+
+To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use something
+like `[[file:foo.org][The foo]]' or simply `file:foo.org.' (*note
+Hyperlinks::). When published, this link becomes a link to `foo.html'.
+In this way, you can interlink the pages of your "org web" project and
+the links will work as expected when you publish them to HTML. If you
+also publish the Org source file and want to link to that, use an
+`http:' link instead of a `file:' link, because `file:' links are
+converted to link to the corresponding `html' file.
+
+ You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are
+careful with relative file names, and provided you have also configured
+Org to upload the related files, these links will work too. See *Note
+Complex example::, for an example of this usage.
+
+ Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
+only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
+location. In this case, use the property
+
+`:link-validation-function' Function to validate links
+
+to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
+accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
+the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
+function returns `nil', then the HTML generator will only insert a
+description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
+function is `org-publish-validate-link' which checks if the given file
+is part of any project in `org-publish-project-alist'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Sitemap, Next: Generating an index, Prev: Publishing links, Up: Configuration
+
+13.1.7 Generating a sitemap
+---------------------------
+
+The following properties may be used to control publishing of a map of
+files for a given project.
+
+`:auto-sitemap' When non-nil, publish a sitemap during
+ `org-publish-current-project' or
+ `org-publish-all'.
+`:sitemap-filename' Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to
+ `sitemap.org' (which becomes `sitemap.html').
+`:sitemap-title' Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of
+ file.
+`:sitemap-function' Plug-in function to use for generation of the
+ sitemap. Defaults to
+ `org-publish-org-sitemap', which generates a
+ plain list of links to all files in the
+ project.
+`:sitemap-sort-folders' Where folders should appear in the sitemap.
+ Set this to `first' (default) or `last' to
+ display folders first or last, respectively.
+ Any other value will mix files and folders.
+`:sitemap-alphabetically' The site map is normally sorted
+ alphabetically. Set this explicitly to `nil'
+ to turn off sorting.
+`:sitemap-ignore-case' Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default
+ `nil'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Generating an index, Prev: Sitemap, Up: Configuration
+
+13.1.8 Generating an index
+--------------------------
+
+Org-mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
+
+`:makeindex' When non-nil, generate in index in the file
+ `theindex.org' and publish it as `theindex.html'.
+
+ The file will be create when first publishing a project with the
+`:makeindex' set. The file only contains a statement `#+include:
+"theindex.inc"'. You can then built around this include statement by
+adding a title, style information etc.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Uploading files, Next: Sample configuration, Prev: Configuration, Up: Publishing
+
+13.2 Uploading files
+====================
+
+For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
+`rsync' or `unison', it might be preferable not to use the built in
+remote publishing facilities of Org-mode which rely heavily on Tramp.
+Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be so efficient for
+multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems under heavy
+usage.
+
+ Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In
+addition to timestamp comparison, they also do content and
+permissions/attribute checks. For this reason you might prefer to
+publish your web to a local directory (possibly even in place with your
+Org files) and then use `unison' or `rsync' to do the synchronization
+with the remote host.
+
+ Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to
+transfer to a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the
+project publishing definition. Simply keep all files in the correct
+location, process your Org files with `org-publish' and let the
+synchronization tool do the rest. You do not need, in this scenario,
+to include attachments such as `jpg', `css' or `gif' files in the
+project definition since the 3rd party tool syncs them.
+
+ Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote
+one, so that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects.
+If you set `org-publish-use-timestamps-flag' to `nil', you gain the main
+benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source
+example files you might include with `#+INCLUDE'. The timestamp
+mechanism in Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have
+been modified.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Sample configuration, Next: Triggering publication, Prev: Uploading files, Up: Publishing
+
+13.3 Sample configuration
+=========================
+
+Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
+project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is more
+complex, with a multi-component project.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Simple example:: One-component publishing
+* Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
+
+
+File: org, Node: Simple example, Next: Complex example, Prev: Sample configuration, Up: Sample configuration
+
+13.3.1 Example: simple publishing configuration
+-----------------------------------------------
+
+This example publishes a set of Org files to the `public_html'
+directory on the local machine.
+
+ (setq org-publish-project-alist
+ '(("org"
+ :base-directory "~/org/"
+ :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
+ :section-numbers nil
+ :table-of-contents nil
+ :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
+ href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
+ type=\"text/css\"/>")))
+
+
+File: org, Node: Complex example, Prev: Simple example, Up: Sample configuration
+
+13.3.2 Example: complex publishing configuration
+------------------------------------------------
+
+This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
+Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
+style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
+excluded.
+
+ To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
+your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
+paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in `~/org' and your
+publishable images in `~/images', you would link to an image with
+ file:../images/myimage.png
+ On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
+same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
+right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
+
+ (setq org-publish-project-alist
+ '(("orgfiles"
+ :base-directory "~/org/"
+ :base-extension "org"
+ :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@host:~/html/notebook/"
+ :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
+ :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
+ :headline-levels 3
+ :section-numbers nil
+ :table-of-contents nil
+ :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
+ href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
+ :auto-preamble t
+ :auto-postamble nil)
+
+ ("images"
+ :base-directory "~/images/"
+ :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
+ :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@host:~/html/images/"
+ :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
+
+ ("other"
+ :base-directory "~/other/"
+ :base-extension "css\\|el"
+ :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@host:~/html/other/"
+ :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
+ ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
+
+
+File: org, Node: Triggering publication, Prev: Sample configuration, Up: Publishing
+
+13.4 Triggering publication
+===========================
+
+Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
+
+`C-c C-e X (`org-publish')'
+ Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to
+ it.
+
+`C-c C-e P (`org-publish-current-project')'
+ Publish the project containing the current file.
+
+`C-c C-e F (`org-publish-current-file')'
+ Publish only the current file.
+
+`C-c C-e E (`org-publish-all')'
+ Publish every project.
+
+ Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above
+functions normally only publish changed files. You can override this
+and force publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of
+the commands above, or by customizing the variable
+`org-publish-use-timestamps-flag'. This may be necessary in particular
+if files include other files via `#+SETUPFILE:' or `#+INCLUDE:'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Working With Source Code, Next: Miscellaneous, Prev: Publishing, Up: Top
+
+14 Working with source code
+***************************
+
+Source code can be included in Org-mode documents using a `src' block,
+e.g.
+
+ #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
+ (defun org-xor (a b)
+ "Exclusive or."
+ (if a (not b) b))
+ #+END_SRC
+
+ Org-mode provides a number of features for working with live source
+code, including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode,
+evaluation of code blocks, tangling of code blocks, and exporting code
+blocks and their results in several formats. This functionality was
+contributed by Eric Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named
+Org-babel.
+
+ The following sections describe Org-mode's code block handling
+facilities.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
+* Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
+* Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
+* Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
+* Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
+* Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
+* Languages:: List of supported code block languages
+* Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
+* Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
+* Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
+* Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
+* Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
+
+
+File: org, Node: Structure of code blocks, Next: Editing source code, Prev: Working With Source Code, Up: Working With Source Code
+
+14.1 Structure of code blocks
+=============================
+
+The structure of code blocks is as follows:
+
+ #+srcname: <name>
+ #+begin_src <language> <switches> <header arguments>
+ <body>
+ #+end_src
+
+ code blocks can also be embedded in text as so called inline code
+blocks as
+
+ src_<language>{<body>}
+
+ or
+
+ src_<language>[<header arguments>]{<body>}
+
+`<name>'
+ This name is associated with the code block. This is similar to
+ the `#+tblname' lines that can be used to name tables in Org-mode
+ files. Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to
+ evaluate the block from other places in the file, other files, or
+ from Org-mode table formulas (see *Note The spreadsheet::).
+
+`<language>'
+ The language of the code in the block.
+
+`<switches>'
+ Switches controlling exportation of the code block (see switches
+ discussion in *Note Literal examples::)
+
+`<header arguments>'
+ Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation,
+ export and tangling of code blocks. See the *Note Header
+ arguments:: section. Header arguments can also be set on a
+ per-buffer or per-subtree basis using properties.
+
+`<body>'
+ The source code.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Editing source code, Next: Exporting code blocks, Prev: Structure of code blocks, Up: Working With Source Code
+
+14.2 Editing source code
+========================
+
+Use `C-c '' to edit the current code block. This brings up a language
+major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code block. Saving
+this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org buffer. Use
+`C-c '' again to exit.
+
+ The `org-src-mode' minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
+following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
+buffer. See also the customization group `org-edit-structure' for
+further configuration options.
+
+`org-src-lang-modes'
+ If an Emacs major-mode named `<lang>-mode' exists, where `<lang>'
+ is the language named in the header line of the code block, then
+ the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
+ can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major
+ modes.
+
+`org-src-window-setup'
+ Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer
+ is created.
+
+`org-src-preserve-indentation'
+ This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
+ Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
+
+`org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer'
+ By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer.
+ Set this variable to nil to switch without asking.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Exporting code blocks, Next: Extracting source code, Prev: Editing source code, Up: Working With Source Code
+
+14.3 Exporting code blocks
+==========================
+
+It is possible to export the _contents_ of code blocks, the _results_
+of code block evaluation, _neither_, or _both_. For most languages,
+the default exports the contents of code blocks. However, for some
+languages (e.g. `ditaa') the default exports the results of code block
+evaluation. For information on exporting code block bodies, see *Note
+Literal examples::.
+
+ The `:exports' header argument can be used to specify export
+behavior:
+
+Header arguments:
+.................
+
+`:exports code'
+ The default in most languages. The body of the code block is
+ exported, as described in *Note Literal examples::.
+
+`:exports results'
+ The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in
+ the Org-mode buffer for export, either updating previous results
+ of the code block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no
+ previous results exist, placing the results immediately after the
+ code block. The body of the code block will not be exported.
+
+`:exports both'
+ Both the code block and its results will be exported.
+
+`:exports none'
+ Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
+
+ It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during
+export. Setting the `org-export-babel-evaluate' variable to `nil' will
+ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process.
+This can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org-mode
+files are exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org-mode
+is used as the markup language for a wiki.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Extracting source code, Next: Evaluating code blocks, Prev: Exporting code blocks, Up: Working With Source Code
+
+14.4 Extracting source code
+===========================
+
+Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
+referred to as "tangling"--a term adopted from the literate programming
+community. During "tangling" of code blocks their bodies are expanded
+using `org-babel-expand-src-block' which can expand both variable and
+"noweb" style references (see *Note Noweb reference syntax::).
+
+Header arguments
+................
+
+`:tangle no'
+ The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
+
+`:tangle yes'
+ Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name
+ is the name of the org file with the extension `.org' replaced by
+ the extension for the block language.
+
+`:tangle filename'
+ Include the code block in the tangled output to file `filename'.
+
+Functions
+.........
+
+`org-babel-tangle'
+ Tangle the current file. Bound to `C-c C-v t'.
+
+`org-babel-tangle-file'
+ Choose a file to tangle. Bound to `C-c C-v f'.
+
+Hooks
+.....
+
+`org-babel-post-tangle-hook'
+ This hook is run from within code files tangled by
+ `org-babel-tangle'. Example applications could include
+ post-processing, compilation or evaluation of tangled code files.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Evaluating code blocks, Next: Library of Babel, Prev: Extracting source code, Up: Working With Source Code
+
+14.5 Evaluating code blocks
+===========================
+
+Code blocks can be evaluated(1) and the results placed in the Org-mode
+buffer. By default, evaluation is only turned on for `emacs-lisp' code
+blocks, however support exists for evaluating blocks in many languages.
+See *Note Languages:: for a list of supported languages. See *Note
+Structure of code blocks:: for information on the syntax used to define
+a code block.
+
+ There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is
+to press `C-c C-c' or `C-c C-v e' with the point on a code block(2).
+This will call the `org-babel-execute-src-block' function to evaluate
+the block and insert its results into the Org-mode buffer.
+
+ It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an
+Org-mode buffer or an Org-mode table. `#+call' (or synonymously
+`#+function' or `#+lob') lines can be used to remotely execute code
+blocks located in the current Org-mode buffer or in the "Library of
+Babel" (see *Note Library of Babel::). These lines use the following
+syntax.
+
+ #+call: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
+ #+function: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
+ #+lob: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
+
+`<name>'
+ The name of the code block to be evaluated.
+
+`<arguments>'
+ Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code
+ block.
+
+`<header arguments>'
+ Header arguments can be placed after the function invocation. See
+ *Note Header arguments:: for more information on header arguments.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Whenever code is evaluated there is a potential for that code to
+do harm. Org-mode provides a number of safeguards to ensure that it
+only evaluates code with explicit confirmation from the user. For
+information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see *Note
+Code evaluation security::.
+
+ (2) The `org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c' variable can be used to
+remove code evaluation from the `C-c C-c' key binding.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Library of Babel, Next: Languages, Prev: Evaluating code blocks, Up: Working With Source Code
+
+14.6 Library of Babel
+=====================
+
+The "Library of Babel" is a library of code blocks that can be called
+from any Org-mode file. The library is housed in an Org-mode file
+located in the `contrib' directory of Org-mode. Org-mode users can
+deposit functions they believe to be generally useful in the library.
+
+ Code blocks defined in the "Library of Babel" can be called remotely
+as if they were in the current Org-mode buffer (see *Note Evaluating
+code blocks:: for information on the syntax of remote code block
+evaluation).
+
+ Code blocks located in any Org-mode file can be loaded into the
+"Library of Babel" with the `org-babel-lob-ingest' function, bound to
+`C-c C-v i'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Languages, Next: Header arguments, Prev: Library of Babel, Up: Working With Source Code
+
+14.7 Languages
+==============
+
+Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
+
+Language Identifier Language Identifier
+Asymptote asymptote C C
+C++ C++ Clojure clojure
+CSS css ditaa ditaa
+Graphviz dot Emacs Lisp emacs-lisp
+gnuplot gnuplot Haskell haskell
+LaTeX latex MATLAB matlab
+Mscgen mscgen Objective Caml ocaml
+Octave octave Oz oz
+Perl perl Python python
+R R Ruby ruby
+Sass sass GNU Screen screen
+shell sh SQL sql
+SQLite sqlite
+
+ Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
+available, it can be found at
+`http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages'.
+
+ The `org-babel-load-languages' controls which languages are enabled
+for evaluation (by default only `emacs-lisp' is enabled). This
+variable can be set using the customization interface or by adding code
+like the following to your emacs configuration.
+
+ The following disables `emacs-lisp' evaluation and enables
+ evaluation of `R' code blocks.
+
+ (org-babel-do-load-languages
+ 'org-babel-load-languages
+ '((emacs-lisp . nil)
+ (R . t)))
+
+ It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the
+related elisp file with `require'.
+
+ The following adds support for evaluating `clojure' code blocks.
+
+ (require 'ob-clojure)
+
+
+File: org, Node: Header arguments, Next: Results of evaluation, Prev: Languages, Up: Working With Source Code
+
+14.8 Header arguments
+=====================
+
+Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
+section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
+describes each header argument in detail.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
+* Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
+
+
+File: org, Node: Using header arguments, Next: Specific header arguments, Prev: Header arguments, Up: Header arguments
+
+14.8.1 Using header arguments
+-----------------------------
+
+The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each
+more specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
+* Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
+* Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
+* Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
+* Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
+* Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
+
+
+File: org, Node: System-wide header arguments, Next: Language-specific header arguments, Prev: Using header arguments, Up: Using header arguments
+
+System-wide header arguments
+............................
+
+System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing
+the `org-babel-default-header-args' variable:
+
+ :session => "none"
+ :results => "replace"
+ :exports => "code"
+ :cache => "no"
+ :noweb => "no"
+
+ For example, the following example could be used to set the default
+value of `:noweb' header arguments to `yes'. This would have the
+effect of expanding `:noweb' references by default when evaluating
+source code blocks.
+
+ (setq org-babel-default-header-args
+ (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
+ (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
+
+
+File: org, Node: Language-specific header arguments, Next: Buffer-wide header arguments, Prev: System-wide header arguments, Up: Using header arguments
+
+Language-specific header arguments
+..................................
+
+Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See
+the language-specific documentation available online at
+`http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Buffer-wide header arguments, Next: Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Prev: Language-specific header arguments, Up: Using header arguments
+
+Buffer-wide header arguments
+............................
+
+Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified through the use of a
+special line placed anywhere in an Org-mode file. The line consists of
+the `#+BABEL:' keyword followed by a series of header arguments which
+may be specified using the standard header argument syntax.
+
+ For example the following would set `session' to `*R*', and
+`results' to `silent' for every code block in the buffer, ensuring that
+all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
+inserted into the buffer.
+
+ #+BABEL: :session *R* :results silent
+
+
+File: org, Node: Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Next: Code block specific header arguments, Prev: Buffer-wide header arguments, Up: Using header arguments
+
+Header arguments in Org-mode properties
+.......................................
+
+Header arguments are also read from Org-mode properties (see *Note
+Property syntax::), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading
+basis. An example of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a
+buffer is
+
+ #+property: tangle yes
+
+ When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are
+looked up with inheritance, so the value of the `:cache' header
+argument will default to `yes' in all code blocks in the subtree rooted
+at the following heading:
+
+ * outline header
+ :PROPERTIES:
+ :cache: yes
+ :END:
+
+ Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
+`org-babel-default-header-args'. It is convenient to use the
+`org-set-property' function bound to `C-c C-x p' to set properties in
+Org-mode documents.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Code block specific header arguments, Next: Header arguments in function calls, Prev: Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Up: Using header arguments
+
+Code block specific header arguments
+....................................
+
+The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the code
+block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
+arguments and their values as part of the `#+begin_src' line.
+Properties set in this way override both the values of
+`org-babel-default-header-args' and header arguments specified as
+properties. In the following example, the `:results' header argument
+is set to `silent', meaning the results of execution will not be
+inserted in the buffer, and the `:exports' header argument is set to
+`code', meaning only the body of the code block will be preserved on
+export to HTML or LaTeX.
+
+ #+source: factorial
+ #+begin_src haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
+ fac 0 = 1
+ fac n = n * fac (n-1)
+ #+end_src
+ Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code
+blocks:
+
+ src_haskell[:exports both]{fac 5}
+
+
+File: org, Node: Header arguments in function calls, Prev: Code block specific header arguments, Up: Using header arguments
+
+Header arguments in function calls
+..................................
+
+At the most specific level, header arguments for "Library of Babel" or
+function call lines can be set as shown below:
+
+ #+call: factorial(n=5) :exports results
+
+
+File: org, Node: Specific header arguments, Prev: Using header arguments, Up: Header arguments
+
+14.8.2 Specific header arguments
+--------------------------------
+
+The following header arguments are defined:
+
+* Menu:
+
+* var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
+* results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
+ be collected and handled
+* file:: Specify a path for file output
+* dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
+ directory for code block execution
+* exports:: Export code and/or results
+* tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
+* comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
+ code files
+* no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
+ expansion during tangling
+* session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
+* noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
+* cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
+* hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
+* colnames:: Handle column names in tables
+* rownames:: Handle row names in tables
+* shebang:: Make tangled files executable
+* eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
+
+
+File: org, Node: var, Next: results, Prev: Specific header arguments, Up: Specific header arguments
+
+14.8.2.1 `:var'
+...............
+
+The `:var' header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
+The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by
+language; these are addressed in the language-specific documentation.
+However, the syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all
+languages. The values passed to arguments can be literal values,
+values from org-mode tables and literal example blocks, or the results
+of other code blocks.
+
+ These values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays--see the
+"indexable variable values" heading below.
+
+ The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using
+the `:var' header argument.
+
+ :var name=assign
+
+ where `assign' can take one of the following forms
+
+ * literal value either a string `"string"' or a number `9'.
+
+ * reference a table name:
+
+ #+tblname: example-table
+ | 1 |
+ | 2 |
+ | 3 |
+ | 4 |
+
+ #+source: table-length
+ #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
+ (length table)
+ #+end_src
+
+ #+results: table-length
+ : 4
+
+ a code block name, as assigned by `#+srcname:', followed by
+ parentheses:
+
+ #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
+ (* 2 length)
+ #+end_src
+
+ #+results:
+ : 8
+
+ In addition, an argument can be passed to the code block referenced
+ by `:var'. The argument is passed within the parentheses
+ following the code block name:
+
+ #+source: double
+ #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=8
+ (* 2 input)
+ #+end_src
+
+ #+results: double
+ : 16
+
+ #+source: squared
+ #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
+ (* input input)
+ #+end_src
+
+ #+results: squared
+ : 4
+
+Alternate argument syntax
+.........................
+
+It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural
+way using the `#+source:' line of a code block. As in the following
+example arguments can be packed inside of parenthesis, separated by
+commas, following the source name.
+
+ #+source: double(input=0, x=2)
+ #+begin_src emacs-lisp
+ (* 2 (+ input x))
+ #+end_src
+
+Indexable variable values
+.........................
+
+It is possible to reference portions of variable values by "indexing"
+into the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting
+back from the end. If an index is separated by `,'s then each
+subsequent section will index into the next deepest nesting or
+dimension of the value. The following example assigns the last cell of
+the first row the table `example-table' to the variable `data':
+
+ #+results: example-table
+ | 1 | a |
+ | 2 | b |
+ | 3 | c |
+ | 4 | d |
+
+ #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
+ data
+ #+end_src
+
+ #+results:
+ : a
+
+ Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers
+separated by a `:', in which case the entire inclusive range is
+referenced. For example the following assigns the middle three rows of
+`example-table' to `data'.
+
+ #+results: example-table
+ | 1 | a |
+ | 2 | b |
+ | 3 | c |
+ | 4 | d |
+ | 5 | 3 |
+
+ #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
+ data
+ #+end_src
+
+ #+results:
+ | 2 | b |
+ | 3 | c |
+ | 4 | d |
+
+ Additionally, an empty index, or the single character `*', are both
+interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
+`0:-1', as shown in the following example in which the entire first
+column is referenced.
+
+ #+results: example-table
+ | 1 | a |
+ | 2 | b |
+ | 3 | c |
+ | 4 | d |
+
+ #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
+ data
+ #+end_src
+
+ #+results:
+ | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 |
+
+ It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as
+tables. Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are
+separated from one another by commas, as shown in the following example.
+
+ #+source: 3D
+ #+begin_src emacs-lisp
+ '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
+ ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
+ ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
+ #+end_src
+
+ #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
+ data
+ #+end_src
+
+ #+results:
+ | 11 | 14 | 17 |
+
+
+File: org, Node: results, Next: file, Prev: var, Up: Specific header arguments
+
+14.8.2.2 `:results'
+...................
+
+There are three classes of `:results' header argument. Only one option
+per class may be supplied per code block.
+
+ * collection header arguments specify how the results should be
+ collected from the code block
+
+ * type header arguments specify what type of result the code block
+ will return--which has implications for how they will be inserted
+ into the Org-mode buffer
+
+ * handling header arguments specify how the results of evaluating
+ the code block should be handled.
+
+Collection
+..........
+
+The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the
+results should be collected from the code block.
+
+ * `value' This is the default. The result is the value of the last
+ statement in the code block. This header argument places the
+ evaluation in functional mode. Note that in some languages, e.g.,
+ Python, use of this result type requires that a `return' statement
+ be included in the body of the source code block. E.g., `:results
+ value'.
+
+ * `output' The result is the collection of everything printed to
+ STDOUT during the execution of the code block. This header
+ argument places the evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., `:results
+ output'.
+
+Type
+....
+
+The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of
+results the code block will return. By default, results are inserted
+as either a table or scalar depending on their value.
+
+ * `table', `vector' The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode
+ table. If a single value is returned, it will be converted into a
+ table with one row and one column. E.g., `:results value table'.
+
+ * `list' The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode list. If
+ a single scalar value is returned it will be converted into a list
+ with only one element.
+
+ * `scalar', `verbatim' The results should be interpreted
+ literally--they will not be converted into a table. The results
+ will be inserted into the Org-mode buffer as quoted text. E.g.,
+ `:results value verbatim'.
+
+ * `file' The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and
+ will be inserted into the Org-mode buffer as a file link. E.g.,
+ `:results value file'.
+
+ * `raw', `org' The results are interpreted as raw Org-mode code and
+ are inserted directly into the buffer. If the results look like a
+ table they will be aligned as such by Org-mode. E.g., `:results
+ value raw'.
+
+ * `html' Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a
+ `begin_html' block. E.g., `:results value html'.
+
+ * `latex' Results assumed to be LaTeX and are enclosed in a
+ `begin_latex' block. E.g., `:results value latex'.
+
+ * `code' Result are assumed to be parseable code and are enclosed in
+ a code block. E.g., `:results value code'.
+
+ * `pp' The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is
+ enclosed in a code block. This option currently supports Emacs
+ Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g., `:results value pp'.
+
+Handling
+........
+
+The following results options indicate what happens with the results
+once they are collected.
+
+ * `silent' The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not
+ be inserted into the Org-mode buffer. E.g., `:results output
+ silent'.
+
+ * `replace' The default value. Any existing results will be
+ removed, and the new results will be inserted into the Org-mode
+ buffer in their place. E.g., `:results output replace'.
+
+ * `append' If there are pre-existing results of the code block then
+ the new results will be appended to the existing results.
+ Otherwise the new results will be inserted as with `replace'.
+
+ * `prepend' If there are pre-existing results of the code block then
+ the new results will be prepended to the existing results.
+ Otherwise the new results will be inserted as with `replace'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: file, Next: dir, Prev: results, Up: Specific header arguments
+
+14.8.2.3 `:file'
+................
+
+The header argument `:file' is used to specify a path for file output.
+An Org-mode style `file:' link is inserted into the buffer as the result
+(see *Note Link format::). Common examples are graphical output from R,
+gnuplot, ditaa and LaTeX code blocks.
+
+ Note that for some languages, including R, gnuplot, LaTeX and ditaa,
+graphical output is sent to the specified file without the file being
+referenced explicitly in the code block. See the documentation for the
+individual languages for details. In contrast, general purpose
+languages such as Python and Ruby require that the code explicitly
+create output corresponding to the path indicated by `:file'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: dir, Next: exports, Prev: file, Up: Specific header arguments
+
+14.8.2.4 `:dir' and remote execution
+....................................
+
+While the `:file' header argument can be used to specify the path to the
+output file, `:dir' specifies the default directory during code block
+execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the
+current buffer is used. In other words, supplying `:dir path'
+temporarily has the same effect as changing the current directory with
+`M-x cd path', and then not supplying `:dir'. Under the surface, `:dir'
+simply sets the value of the Emacs variable `default-directory'.
+
+ When using `:dir', you should supply a relative path for file output
+(e.g. `:file myfile.jpg' or `:file results/myfile.jpg') in which case
+that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
+
+ In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called
+`Work' in your home directory, you could use
+
+ #+begin_src R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
+ matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
+ #+end_src
+
+Remote execution
+................
+
+A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file
+syntax, in which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine.
+An example is
+
+ #+begin_src R :file plot.png :dir /dand@yakuba.princeton.edu:
+ plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
+ #+end_src
+
+ Text results will be returned to the local Org-mode buffer as usual,
+and file output will be created on the remote machine with relative
+paths interpreted relative to the remote directory. An Org-mode link to
+the remote file will be created.
+
+ So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote
+machine, and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org
+buffer:
+
+ [[file:/scp:dand@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
+
+ Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that
+`:dir' sets the value of the Emacs variable `default-directory', thanks
+to tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need
+to install tramp separately in order for these features to work
+correctly.
+
+Further points
+..............
+
+ * If `:dir' is used in conjunction with `:session', although it will
+ determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no
+ attempt is currently made to alter the directory associated with
+ an existing session.
+
+ * `:dir' should typically not be used to create files during export
+ with `:exports results' or `:exports both'. The reason is that, in
+ order to retain portability of exported material between machines,
+ during export links inserted into the buffer will *not* be
+ expanded against `default directory'. Therefore, if
+ `default-directory' is altered using `:dir', it is probable that
+ the file will be created in a location to which the link does not
+ point.
+
+
+File: org, Node: exports, Next: tangle, Prev: dir, Up: Specific header arguments
+
+14.8.2.5 `:exports'
+...................
+
+The `:exports' header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
+or LaTeX exports of the Org-mode file.
+
+ * `code' The default. The body of code is included into the
+ exported file. E.g., `:exports code'.
+
+ * `results' The result of evaluating the code is included in the
+ exported file. E.g., `:exports results'.
+
+ * `both' Both the code and results are included in the exported
+ file. E.g., `:exports both'.
+
+ * `none' Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., `:exports
+ none'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: tangle, Next: comments, Prev: exports, Up: Specific header arguments
+
+14.8.2.6 `:tangle'
+..................
+
+The `:tangle' header argument specifies whether or not the code block
+should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
+
+ * `tangle' The code block is exported to a source code file named
+ after the basename (name w/o extension) of the Org-mode file.
+ E.g., `:tangle yes'.
+
+ * `no' The default. The code block is not exported to a source code
+ file. E.g., `:tangle no'.
+
+ * other Any other string passed to the `:tangle' header argument is
+ interpreted as a file basename to which the block will be
+ exported. E.g., `:tangle basename'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: comments, Next: no-expand, Prev: tangle, Up: Specific header arguments
+
+14.8.2.7 `:comments'
+....................
+
+By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any
+insertion of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body
+of the code block. The `:comments' header argument can be set as
+follows to control the insertion of extra comments into the tangled
+code file.
+
+ * `no' The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
+
+ * `link' The code block is wrapped in comments which contain
+ pointers back to the original Org file from which the code was
+ tangled.
+
+ * `yes' A synonym for "link" to maintain backwards compatibility.
+
+ * `org' Include text from the org-mode file as a comment.
+
+ The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code
+ and is limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case
+ may be.
+
+ * `both' Turns on both the "link" and "org" comment options.
+
+
+File: org, Node: no-expand, Next: session, Prev: comments, Up: Specific header arguments
+
+14.8.2.8 `:no-expand'
+.....................
+
+By default, code blocks are expanded with `org-babel-expand-src-block'
+during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
+specified with `:var' (see *Note var::), and of replacing "noweb"
+references (see *Note Noweb reference syntax::) with their targets. The
+`:no-expand' header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
+
+
+File: org, Node: session, Next: noweb, Prev: no-expand, Up: Specific header arguments
+
+14.8.2.9 `:session'
+...................
+
+The `:session' header argument starts a session for an interpreted
+language where state is preserved.
+
+ By default, a session is not started.
+
+ A string passed to the `:session' header argument will give the
+session a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for
+each interpreted language.
+
+
+File: org, Node: noweb, Next: cache, Prev: session, Up: Specific header arguments
+
+14.8.2.10 `:noweb'
+..................
+
+The `:noweb' header argument controls expansion of "noweb" style (see
+*Note Noweb reference syntax::) references in a code block. This header
+argument can have one of three values: `yes' `no' or `tangle'.
+
+ * `yes' All "noweb" syntax references in the body of the code block
+ will be expanded before the block is evaluated, tangled or
+ exported.
+
+ * `no' The default. No "noweb" syntax specific action is taken on
+ evaluating code blocks, However, noweb references will still be
+ expanded during tangling.
+
+ * `tangle' All "noweb" syntax references in the body of the code
+ block will be expanded before the block is tangled, however
+ "noweb" references will not be expanded when the block is
+ evaluated or exported.
+
+Noweb prefix lines
+..................
+
+Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
+`<<reference>>'. This behavior is illustrated in the following
+example. Because the `<<example>>' noweb reference appears behind the
+SQL comment syntax, each line of the expanded noweb reference will be
+commented.
+
+ This code block:
+
+ -- <<example>>
+
+ expands to:
+
+ -- this is the
+ -- multi-line body of example
+
+ Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines
+will not be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use
+inline noweb references.
+
+
+File: org, Node: cache, Next: hlines, Prev: noweb, Up: Specific header arguments
+
+14.8.2.11 `:cache'
+..................
+
+The `:cache' header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
+the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid
+re-evaluating unchanged code blocks. This header argument can have one
+of two values: `yes' or `no'.
+
+ * `no' The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will
+ be evaluated every time it is called.
+
+ * `yes' Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and
+ arguments passed to the block will be generated. This hash is
+ packed into the `#+results:' line and will be checked on subsequent
+ executions of the code block. If the code block has not changed
+ since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
+
+
+File: org, Node: hlines, Next: colnames, Prev: cache, Up: Specific header arguments
+
+14.8.2.12 `:hlines'
+...................
+
+Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
+hlines. The `:hlines' argument to a code block accepts the values
+`yes' or `no', with a default value of `no'.
+
+ * `no' Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most
+ languages this is the desired effect because an `hline' symbol is
+ interpreted as an unbound variable and raises an error. Setting
+ `:hlines no' or relying on the default value yields the following
+ results.
+
+ #+tblname: many-cols
+ | a | b | c |
+ |---+---+---|
+ | d | e | f |
+ |---+---+---|
+ | g | h | i |
+
+ #+source: echo-table
+ #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols
+ return tab
+ #+end_src
+
+ #+results: echo-table
+ | a | b | c |
+ | d | e | f |
+ | g | h | i |
+
+ * `yes' Leaves hlines in the table. Setting `:hlines yes' has this
+ effect.
+
+ #+tblname: many-cols
+ | a | b | c |
+ |---+---+---|
+ | d | e | f |
+ |---+---+---|
+ | g | h | i |
+
+ #+source: echo-table
+ #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
+ return tab
+ #+end_src
+
+ #+results: echo-table
+ | a | b | c |
+ |---+---+---|
+ | d | e | f |
+ |---+---+---|
+ | g | h | i |
+
+
+File: org, Node: colnames, Next: rownames, Prev: hlines, Up: Specific header arguments
+
+14.8.2.13 `:colnames'
+.....................
+
+The `:colnames' header argument accepts the values `yes', `no', or
+`nil' for unassigned. The default value is `nil'.
+
+ * `nil' If an input table looks like it has column names (because
+ its second row is an hline), then the column names will be removed
+ from the table before processing, then reapplied to the results.
+
+ #+tblname: less-cols
+ | a |
+ |---|
+ | b |
+ | c |
+
+ #+srcname: echo-table-again
+ #+begin_src python :var tab=less-cols
+ return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
+ #+end_src
+
+ #+results: echo-table-again
+ | a |
+ |----|
+ | b* |
+ | c* |
+
+ * `no' No column name pre-processing takes place
+
+ * `yes' Column names are removed and reapplied as with `nil' even if
+ the table does not "look like" it has column names (i.e. the
+ second row is not an hline)
+
+
+File: org, Node: rownames, Next: shebang, Prev: colnames, Up: Specific header arguments
+
+14.8.2.14 `:rownames'
+.....................
+
+The `:rownames' header argument can take on the values `yes' or `no',
+with a default value of `no'.
+
+ * `no' No row name pre-processing will take place.
+
+ * `yes' The first column of the table is removed from the table
+ before processing, and is then reapplied to the results.
+
+ #+tblname: with-rownames
+ | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
+ | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
+
+ #+srcname: echo-table-once-again
+ #+begin_src python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
+ return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
+ #+end_src
+
+ #+results: echo-table-once-again
+ | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
+ | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
+
+
+File: org, Node: shebang, Next: eval, Prev: rownames, Up: Specific header arguments
+
+14.8.2.15 `:shebang'
+....................
+
+Setting the `:shebang' header argument to a string value (e.g.
+`:shebang "#!/bin/bash"') causes the string to be inserted as the first
+line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
+permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
+
+
+File: org, Node: eval, Prev: shebang, Up: Specific header arguments
+
+14.8.2.16 `:eval'
+.................
+
+The `:eval' header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
+specific code blocks. `:eval' accepts two arguments "never" and
+"query". `:eval never' will ensure that a code block is never
+evaluated, this can be useful for protecting against the evaluation of
+dangerous code blocks. `:eval query' will require a query for every
+execution of a code block regardless of the value of the
+`org-confirm-babel-evaluate' variable.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Results of evaluation, Next: Noweb reference syntax, Prev: Header arguments, Up: Working With Source Code
+
+14.9 Results of evaluation
+==========================
+
+The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is
+invoked, as well as on whether `:results value' or `:results output' is
+used. The following table shows the possibilities:
+
+ Non-session Session
+`:results value' value of last value of last expression
+ expression
+`:results output' contents of STDOUT concatenation of interpreter
+ output
+
+ Note: With `:results value', the result in both `:session' and
+non-session is returned to Org-mode as a table (a one- or
+two-dimensional vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
+
+14.9.1 Non-session
+------------------
+
+14.9.1.1 `:results value'
+.........................
+
+This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the
+code in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating
+that function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body
+of such a function. In particular, note that Python does not
+automatically return a value from a function unless a `return'
+statement is present, and so a `return' statement will usually be
+required in Python.
+
+ This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the
+code is automatically wrapped in a function definition.
+
+14.9.1.2 `:results output'
+..........................
+
+The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
+contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
+languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area
+for future work.)
+
+14.9.2 Session
+--------------
+
+14.9.2.1 `:results value'
+.........................
+
+The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
+inferior process. The result returned is the result of the last
+evaluation performed by the interpreter. (This is obtained in a
+language-specific manner: the value of the variable `_' in Python and
+Ruby, and the value of `.Last.value' in R).
+
+14.9.2.2 `:results output'
+..........................
+
+The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
+inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the
+sequence of (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that
+this is not necessarily the same as what would be sent to `STDOUT' if
+the same code were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as
+an external process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
+
+ #+begin_src python :results output
+ print "hello"
+ 2
+ print "bye"
+ #+end_src
+
+ #+resname:
+ : hello
+ : bye
+
+ In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
+ #+begin_src python :results output :session
+ print "hello"
+ 2
+ print "bye"
+ #+end_src
+
+ #+resname:
+ : hello
+ : 2
+ : bye
+
+ But in `:session' mode, the interactive interpreter receives input
+`2' and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements
+are unnecessary here).
+
+
+File: org, Node: Noweb reference syntax, Next: Key bindings and useful functions, Prev: Results of evaluation, Up: Working With Source Code
+
+14.10 Noweb reference syntax
+============================
+
+The "noweb" (see `http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/') Literate
+Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by
+using the familiar Noweb syntax:
+
+ <<code-block-name>>
+
+ When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not "noweb"
+references are expanded depends upon the value of the `:noweb' header
+argument. If `:noweb yes', then a Noweb reference is expanded before
+evaluation. If `:noweb no', the default, then the reference is not
+expanded before evaluation.
+
+ Note: the default value, `:noweb no', was chosen to ensure that
+correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where `<<arg>>'
+is a syntactically valid construct. If `<<arg>>' is not syntactically
+valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting the
+default value.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Key bindings and useful functions, Next: Batch execution, Prev: Noweb reference syntax, Up: Working With Source Code
+
+14.11 Key bindings and useful functions
+=======================================
+
+Many common Org-mode key sequences are re-bound depending on the
+context.
+
+ Within a code block, the following key bindings are active:
+
+`C-c C-c' org-babel-execute-src-block
+`C-c C-o' org-babel-open-src-block-result
+`C-<up>' org-babel-load-in-session
+`M-<down>' org-babel-pop-to-session
+
+ In an Org-mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
+
+`C-c C-v a' or `C-c C-v org-babel-sha1-hash
+C-a'
+`C-c C-v b' or `C-c C-v org-babel-execute-buffer
+C-b'
+`C-c C-v f' or `C-c C-v org-babel-tangle-file
+C-f'
+`C-c C-v g' org-babel-goto-named-source-block
+`C-c C-v h' org-babel-describe-bindings
+`C-c C-v l' or `C-c C-v org-babel-lob-ingest
+C-l'
+`C-c C-v p' or `C-c C-v org-babel-expand-src-block
+C-p'
+`C-c C-v s' or `C-c C-v org-babel-execute-subtree
+C-s'
+`C-c C-v t' or `C-c C-v org-babel-tangle
+C-t'
+`C-c C-v z' or `C-c C-v org-babel-switch-to-session
+C-z'
+
+
+File: org, Node: Batch execution, Prev: Key bindings and useful functions, Up: Working With Source Code
+
+14.12 Batch execution
+=====================
+
+It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
+script calls `org-babel-tangle' on every one of its arguments.
+
+ Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
+
+ #!/bin/sh
+ # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
+ #
+ # tangle files with org-mode
+ #
+ DIR=`pwd`
+ FILES=""
+ ORGINSTALL="~/src/org/lisp/org-install.el"
+
+ # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
+ for i in $@; do
+ FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
+ done
+
+ emacs -Q --batch -l $ORGINSTALL \
+ --eval "(progn
+ (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
+ (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\"))
+ (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
+ (mapc (lambda (file)
+ (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
+ (org-babel-tangle)
+ (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
+
+
+File: org, Node: Miscellaneous, Next: Hacking, Prev: Working With Source Code, Up: Top
+
+15 Miscellaneous
+****************
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
+* Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
+* Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
+* Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
+* Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
+* In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
+* The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
+* Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
+* TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
+* Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
+
+
+File: org, Node: Completion, Next: Easy Templates, Prev: Miscellaneous, Up: Miscellaneous
+
+15.1 Completion
+===============
+
+Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org-mode uses it
+whenever it makes sense. If you prefer an iswitchb- or ido-like
+interface for some of the completion prompts, you can specify your
+preference by setting at most one of the variables
+`org-completion-use-iswitchb' `org-completion-use-ido'.
+
+ Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does not
+make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into the
+buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
+
+`M-<TAB>'
+ Complete word at point
+ * At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
+
+ * After `\', complete TeX symbols supported by the exporter.
+
+ * After `*', complete headlines in the current buffer so that
+ they can be used in search links like `[[*find this
+ headline]]'.
+
+ * After `:' in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is
+ taken from the variable `org-tag-alist' (possibly set through
+ the `#+TAGS' in-buffer option, *note Setting tags::), or it
+ is created dynamically from all tags used in the current
+ buffer.
+
+ * After `:' and not in a headline, complete property keys. The
+ list of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in
+ the current buffer.
+
+ * After `[', complete link abbreviations (*note Link
+ abbreviations::).
+
+ * After `#+', complete the special keywords like `TYP_TODO' or
+ `OPTIONS' which set file-specific options for Org-mode. When
+ the option keyword is already complete, pressing `M-<TAB>'
+ again will insert example settings for this keyword.
+
+ * In the line after `#+STARTUP: ', complete startup keywords,
+ i.e. valid keys for this line.
+
+ * Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Easy Templates, Next: Speed keys, Prev: Completion, Up: Miscellaneous
+
+15.2 Easy Templates
+===================
+
+Org-mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
+`#+BEGIN_SRC' and `#+END_SRC' pairs) with just a few key strokes. This
+is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism. Note that
+Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in a
+similar way, for example `yasnippet'.
+
+ To insert a structural element, type a `<', followed by a template
+selector and `<TAB>'. Completion takes effect only when the above
+keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
+
+ The following template selectors are currently supported.
+
+`s' `#+begin_src ... #+end_src'
+`e' `#+begin_example ... #+end_example'
+`q' `#+begin_quote ... #+end_quote'
+`v' `#+begin_verse ... #+end_verse'
+`c' `#+begin_center ... #+end_center'
+`l' `#+begin_latex ... #+end_latex'
+`L' `#+latex:'
+`h' `#+begin_html ... #+end_html'
+`H' `#+html:'
+`a' `#+begin_ascii ... #+end_ascii'
+`A' `#+ascii:'
+`i' `#+include:' line
+
+ For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB,
+will expand into a complete EXAMPLE template.
+
+ You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
+`org-structure-template-alist'. See the docstring of the variable for
+additional details.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Speed keys, Next: Code evaluation security, Prev: Easy Templates, Up: Miscellaneous
+
+15.3 Speed keys
+===============
+
+Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
+beginning of a headline, i.e. before the first star. Configure the
+variable `org-use-speed-commands' to activate this feature. There is a
+pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using
+the variable `org-speed-commands-user'. Speed keys do not only speed up
+navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way
+to execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available
+on a TTY, or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
+
+ To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press
+`?' with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Code evaluation security, Next: Customization, Prev: Speed keys, Up: Miscellaneous
+
+15.4 Code evaluation and security issues
+========================================
+
+Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating
+them.
+
+ Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk.
+Badly written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by
+accident. Org has default settings which will only evaluate such code
+if you give explicit permission to do so, and as a casual user of these
+features you should leave these precautions intact.
+
+ For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation
+prompts can become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This
+can be done, but you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
+
+ Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
+
+Source code blocks
+ Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when
+ pressing `C-c C-c' in the block. The most important thing to
+ realize here is that Org mode files which contain code snippets
+ are, in a certain sense, like executable files. So you should
+ accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
+ sources--just like you would do with a program you install on your
+ computer.
+
+ Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the
+ variables which take off the default security brakes.
+
+ -- User Option: org-confirm-babel-evaluate
+ When set to t user is queried before code block evaluation
+
+Following `shell' and `elisp' links
+ Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (*note
+ External links::). These links can be problematic because the
+ code to be evaluated is not visible.
+
+ -- User Option: org-confirm-shell-link-function
+ Function to queries user about shell link execution.
+
+ -- User Option: org-confirm-elisp-link-function
+ Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
+
+Formulas in tables
+ Formulas in tables (*note The spreadsheet::) are code that is
+ evaluated either by the calc interpreter, or by the Emacs Lisp
+ interpreter.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Customization, Next: In-buffer settings, Prev: Code evaluation security, Up: Miscellaneous
+
+15.5 Customization
+==================
+
+There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize Org.
+For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not describing the
+variables here. A structured overview of customization variables is
+available with `M-x org-customize'. Or select `Browse Org Group' from
+the `Org->Customization' menu. Many settings can also be activated on
+a per-file basis, by putting special lines into the buffer (*note
+In-buffer settings::).
+
+
+File: org, Node: In-buffer settings, Next: The very busy C-c C-c key, Prev: Customization, Up: Miscellaneous
+
+15.6 Summary of in-buffer settings
+==================================
+
+Org-mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
+per-file basis. These lines start with a `#+' followed by a keyword, a
+colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several setting
+words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple lines for
+the keyword. While these settings are described throughout the manual,
+here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the buffer,
+press `C-c C-c' with the cursor still in the line to activate the
+changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only when the
+file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
+
+`#+ARCHIVE: %s_done::'
+ This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It
+ applies for all subsequent lines until the next `#+ARCHIVE' line,
+ or the end of the file. The first such line also applies to any
+ entries before it. The corresponding variable is
+ `org-archive-location'.
+
+`#+CATEGORY:'
+ This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category
+ applies for all subsequent lines until the next `#+CATEGORY' line,
+ or the end of the file. The first such line also applies to any
+ entries before it.
+
+`#+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....'
+ Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
+ columns view is invoked in locations where no `COLUMNS' property
+ applies.
+
+`#+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...'
+ Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas.
+ This line sets the local variable
+ `org-table-formula-constants-local'. The global version of this
+ variable is `org-table-formula-constants'.
+
+`#+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:'
+ Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including
+ the top-level entries.
+
+`#+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....'
+ Set the file-local set of drawers. The corresponding global
+ variable is `org-drawers'.
+
+`#+LINK: linkword replace'
+ These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
+ *Note Link abbreviations::. The corresponding variable is
+ `org-link-abbrev-alist'.
+
+`#+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default'
+ This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All
+ three must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest
+ priority must have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
+
+`#+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value'
+ This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the
+ current buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a
+ property.
+
+`#+SETUPFILE: file'
+ This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup.
+ Normally this is entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed
+ for option-setting lines (i.e. when starting Org-mode for a file,
+ when pressing `C-c C-c' in a settings line, or when exporting),
+ then the contents of this file are parsed as if they had been
+ included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be any other
+ Org-mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
+ cursor is in the line with `C-c ''.
+
+`#+STARTUP:'
+ This line sets options to be used at startup of Org-mode, when an
+ Org file is being visited.
+
+ The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the
+ outline tree. The corresponding variable for global default
+ settings is `org-startup-folded', with a default value `t', which
+ means `overview'.
+ overview top-level headlines only
+ content all headlines
+ showall no folding of any entries
+ showeverything show even drawer contents
+
+ Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
+ `org-startup-indented'(1)
+ indent start with `org-indent-mode' turned on
+ noindent start with `org-indent-mode' turned off
+
+ Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file.
+ This is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The
+ corresponding variable is `org-startup-align-all-tables', with a
+ default value `nil'.
+ align align all tables
+ noalign don't align tables on startup
+
+ When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically
+ displayed. The corresponding variable is
+ `org-startup-with-inline-images', with a default value `nil' to
+ avoid delays when visiting a file.
+ inlineimages show inline images
+ noinlineimages don't show inline images on startup
+
+ Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock
+ intervals can be configured using these options (see variables
+ `org-log-done', `org-log-note-clock-out' and `org-log-repeat')
+ logdone record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE
+ lognotedone record timestamp and a note when DONE
+ nologdone don't record when items are marked DONE
+ logrepeat record a time when reinstating a repeating item
+ lognoterepeat record a note when reinstating a repeating item
+ nologrepeat do not record when reinstating repeating item
+ lognoteclock-out record a note when clocking out
+ nolognoteclock-out don't record a note when clocking out
+ logreschedule record a timestamp when scheduling time changes
+ lognotereschedule record a note when scheduling time changes
+ nologreschedule do not record when a scheduling date changes
+ logredeadline record a timestamp when deadline changes
+ lognoteredeadline record a note when deadline changes
+ nologredeadline do not record when a deadline date changes
+ logrefile record a timestamp when refiling
+ lognoterefile record a note when refiling
+ nologrefile do not record when refiling
+ Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings,
+ and for indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
+ `org-hide-leading-stars' and `org-odd-levels-only', both with a
+ default setting `nil' (meaning `showstars' and `oddeven').
+ hidestars make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.
+ showstars show all stars starting a headline
+ indent virtual indentation according to outline level
+ noindent no virtual indentation according to outline level
+ odd allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)
+ oddeven allow all outline levels
+ To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
+ `org-put-time-stamp-overlays' and
+ `org-time-stamp-overlay-formats'), use
+ customtime overlay custom time format
+ The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
+ `constants-unit-system').
+ constcgs `constants.el' should use the c-g-s unit system
+ constSI `constants.el' should use the SI unit system
+ To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
+ corresponding variables are `org-footnote-define-inline',
+ `org-footnote-auto-label', and `org-footnote-auto-adjust'.
+ fninline define footnotes inline
+ fnnoinline define footnotes in separate section
+ fnlocal define footnotes near first reference, but not inline
+ fnprompt prompt for footnote labels
+ fnauto create [fn:1]-like labels automatically (default)
+ fnconfirm offer automatic label for editing or confirmation
+ fnplain create [1]-like labels automatically
+ fnadjust automatically renumber and sort footnotes
+ nofnadjust do not renumber and sort automatically
+ To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding
+ variable is `org-hide-block-startup'.
+ hideblocks Hide all begin/end blocks on startup
+ nohideblocks Do not hide blocks on startup
+ The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the
+ variable `org-pretty-entities' and the keywords
+ entitiespretty Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible
+ entitiesplain Leave entities plain
+
+`#+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)'
+ These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid
+ tags in this file, and (potentially) the corresponding _fast tag
+ selection_ keys. The corresponding variable is `org-tag-alist'.
+
+`#+TBLFM:'
+ This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the
+ line.
+
+`#+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,'
+`#+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,'
+`#+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,'
+`#+LATEX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,'
+`#+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:'
+ These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more
+ details see *Note Export options::.
+
+`#+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:'
+ These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
+ current file. The corresponding variable is `org-todo-keywords'.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Emacs 23 and Org-mode 6.29 are required
+
+
+File: org, Node: The very busy C-c C-c key, Next: Clean view, Prev: In-buffer settings, Up: Miscellaneous
+
+15.7 The very busy C-c C-c key
+==============================
+
+The key `C-c C-c' has many purposes in Org, which are all mentioned
+scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of this key is
+to add _tags_ to a headline (*note Tags::). In many other
+circumstances it means something like _"Hey Org, look here and update
+according to what you see here"_. Here is a summary of what this means
+in different contexts.
+
+ - If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
+ tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
+
+ - If the cursor is in one of the special `#+KEYWORD' lines, this
+ triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
+ information.
+
+ - If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
+ works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
+
+ - If the cursor is on a `#+TBLFM' line, re-apply the formulas to the
+ entire table.
+
+ - If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file
+ it. With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction,
+ to the default location.
+
+ - If the cursor is on a `<<<target>>>', update radio targets and
+ corresponding links in this buffer.
+
+ - If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a
+ property drawer, offer property commands.
+
+ - If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
+ definition, and vice versa.
+
+ - If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
+
+ - If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the
+ status of the checkbox.
+
+ - If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
+ ordered list.
+
+ - If the cursor is on the `#+BEGIN' line of a dynamic block, the
+ block is updated.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Clean view, Next: TTY keys, Prev: The very busy C-c C-c key, Up: Miscellaneous
+
+15.8 A cleaner outline view
+===========================
+
+Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start
+with a potentially large number of stars, and that text below the
+headlines is not indented. While this is no problem when writing a
+_book-like_ document where the outline headings are really section
+headings, in a more _list-oriented_ outline, indented structure is a
+lot cleaner:
+
+ * Top level headline | * Top level headline
+ ** Second level | * Second level
+ *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
+ some text | some text
+ *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
+ more text | more text
+ * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
+
+If you are using at least Emacs 23.2(1) and version 6.29 of Org, this
+kind of view can be achieved dynamically at display time using
+`org-indent-mode'. In this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for
+display with the necessary amount of space(2). Also headlines are
+prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of indentation
+shifts by two(3) spaces per level. All headline stars but the last
+one are made invisible using the `org-hide' face(4) - see below under
+`2.' for more information on how this works. You can turn on
+`org-indent-mode' for all files by customizing the variable
+`org-startup-indented', or you can turn it on for individual files using
+
+ #+STARTUP: indent
+
+ If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or
+Org, or if you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that
+the plain text file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display,
+Org supports you in the following way:
+
+ 1. _Indentation of text below headlines_
+ You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary
+ line up with the headline, like
+
+ *** 3rd level
+ more text, now indented
+
+ Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and
+ structure editing(5), preserving or adapting the indentation as
+ appropriate.
+
+ 2. _Hiding leading stars_
+ You can modify the display in such a way that all leading stars
+ become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure the
+ variable `org-hide-leading-stars' or change this on a per-file
+ basis with
+
+ #+STARTUP: hidestars
+ #+STARTUP: showstars
+
+ With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
+
+ * Top level headline
+ * Second level
+ * 3rd level
+ ...
+
+ The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are
+ only fontified with the face `org-hide' that uses the background
+ color as font color. If you are not using either white or black
+ background, you may have to customize this face to get the wanted
+ effect. Another possibility is to set this font such that the
+ extra stars are almost invisible, for example using the color
+ `grey90' on a white background.
+
+ 3. Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and
+ use only odd levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go
+ from one outline level to the next(6). In this way we get the
+ outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order to
+ make the structure editing and export commands handle this
+ convention correctly, configure the variable
+ `org-odd-levels-only', or set this on a per-file basis with one of
+ the following lines:
+
+ #+STARTUP: odd
+ #+STARTUP: oddeven
+
+ You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
+ double-star-per-level convention with `M-x
+ org-convert-to-odd-levels RET' in that file. The reverse
+ operation is `M-x org-convert-to-oddeven-levels'.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Emacs 23.1 can actually crash with `org-indent-mode'
+
+ (2) `org-indent-mode' also sets the `wrap-prefix' property, such
+that `visual-line-mode' (or purely setting `word-wrap') wraps long
+lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
+
+ (3) See the variable `org-indent-indentation-per-level'.
+
+ (4) Turning on `org-indent-mode' sets `org-hide-leading-stars' to
+`t' and `org-adapt-indentation' to `nil'.
+
+ (5) See also the variable `org-adapt-indentation'.
+
+ (6) When you need to specify a level for a property search or refile
+targets, `LEVEL=2' will correspond to 3 stars, etc.
+
+
+File: org, Node: TTY keys, Next: Interaction, Prev: Clean view, Up: Miscellaneous
+
+15.9 Using Org on a tty
+=======================
+
+Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
+Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not accessible
+on a tty, such as the cursor keys (<left>, <right>, <up>, <down>),
+<TAB> and <RET>, in particular when used together with modifiers like
+<Meta> and/or <Shift>. To access these commands on a tty when special
+keys are unavailable, the following alternative bindings can be used.
+The tty bindings below will likely be more cumbersome; you may find for
+some of the bindings below that a customized workaround suits you
+better. For example, changing a timestamp is really only fun with
+`S-<cursor>' keys, whereas on a tty you would rather use `C-c .' to
+re-insert the timestamp.
+
+Default Alternative 1 Speed Alternative 2
+ key
+`S-<TAB>' `C-u <TAB>' `C'
+`M-<left>' `C-c C-x l' `l' `<Esc> <left>'
+`M-S-<left>'`C-c C-x L' `L'
+`M-<right>' `C-c C-x r' `r' `<Esc>
+ <right>'
+`M-S-<right>'`C-c C-x R' `R'
+`M-<up>' `C-c C-x u' ` ' `<Esc> <up>'
+`M-S-<up>' `C-c C-x U' `U'
+`M-<down>' `C-c C-x d' ` ' `<Esc> <down>'
+`M-S-<down>'`C-c C-x D' `D'
+`S-<RET>' `C-c C-x c' ` '
+`M-<RET>' `C-c C-x m' ` ' `<Esc> <RET>'
+`M-S-<RET>' `C-c C-x M' ` '
+`S-<left>' `C-c <left>' ` '
+`S-<right>' `C-c <right>' ` '
+`S-<up>' `C-c <up>' ` '
+`S-<down>' `C-c <down>' ` '
+`C-S-<left>'`C-c C-x ` '
+ <left>'
+`C-S-<right>'`C-c C-x ` '
+ <right>'
+
+
+File: org, Node: Interaction, Prev: TTY keys, Up: Miscellaneous
+
+15.10 Interaction with other packages
+=====================================
+
+Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways with
+other code out there.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
+* Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
+
+
+File: org, Node: Cooperation, Next: Conflicts, Prev: Interaction, Up: Interaction
+
+15.10.1 Packages that Org cooperates with
+-----------------------------------------
+
+`calc.el' by Dave Gillespie
+ Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
+ functionality in its tables (*note The spreadsheet::). Org checks
+ for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
+ `calc-eval' which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc
+ has been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the
+ Emacs distribution. Another possibility for interaction between
+ the two packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. *Note
+ Embedded Mode: (Calc)Embedded Mode.
+
+`constants.el' by Carsten Dominik
+ In a table formula (*note The spreadsheet::), it is possible to use
+ names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
+ constants in the variable `org-table-formula-constants', install
+ the `constants' package which defines a large number of constants
+ and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like `M' for `Mega',
+ etc. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available at
+ `http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools'. Org checks for the
+ function `constants-get', which has to be autoloaded in your
+ setup. See the installation instructions in the file
+ `constants.el'.
+
+`cdlatex.el' by Carsten Dominik
+ Org-mode can make use of the CDLaTeX package to efficiently enter
+ LaTeX fragments into Org files. See *Note CDLaTeX mode::.
+
+`imenu.el' by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
+ Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org-mode
+ supports Imenu--all you need to do to get the index is the
+ following:
+ (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
+ (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
+ By default the index is two levels deep--you can modify the depth
+ using the option `org-imenu-depth'.
+
+`remember.el' by John Wiegley
+ Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
+
+`speedbar.el' by Eric M. Ludlam
+ Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying
+ files and index items in files. Org-mode supports Speedbar and
+ allows you to drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It
+ also allows you to restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file
+ or a subtree by using the command `<' in the Speedbar frame.
+
+`table.el' by Takaaki Ota
+ Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and
+ row-spanning, and alignment can be created using the Emacs table
+ package by Takaaki Ota (`http://sourceforge.net/projects/table',
+ and also part of Emacs 22). Org-mode will recognize these tables
+ and export them properly. Because of interference with other
+ Org-mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit these tables
+ directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command `C-c
+ '' to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
+
+ `C-c ' (`org-edit-special')'
+ Edit a `table.el' table. Works when the cursor is in a
+ table.el table.
+
+ `C-c ~ (`org-table-create-with-table.el')'
+ Insert a `table.el' table. If there is already a table at
+ point, this command converts it between the `table.el' format
+ and the Org-mode format. See the documentation string of the
+ command `org-convert-table' for the restrictions under which
+ this is possible.
+ `table.el' is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
+
+`footnote.el' by Steven L. Baur
+ Org-mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this
+ package. However, Org-mode also has its own footnote support
+ (*note Footnotes::), which makes using `footnote.el' unnecessary.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Conflicts, Prev: Cooperation, Up: Interaction
+
+15.10.2 Packages that lead to conflicts with Org-mode
+-----------------------------------------------------
+
+ In Emacs 23, `shift-selection-mode' is on by default, meaning that
+ cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge
+ regions. This conflicts with the use of `S-<cursor>' commands in
+ Org to change timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item
+ bullet types if the cursor is at such a location. By default,
+ `S-<cursor>' commands outside special contexts don't do anything,
+ but you can customize the variable `org-support-shift-select'.
+ Org-mode then tries to accommodate shift selection by (i) using it
+ outside of the special contexts where special commands apply, and
+ by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the cursor
+ moves across a special context.
+
+`CUA.el' by Kim. F. Storm
+ Key bindings in Org conflict with the `S-<cursor>' keys used by
+ CUA mode (as well as `pc-select-mode' and `s-region-mode') to
+ select and extend the region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in
+ in the form of `shift-selection-mode', see previous paragraph. If
+ you are using Emacs 23, you probably don't want to use another
+ package for this purpose. However, if you prefer to leave these
+ keys to a different package while working in Org-mode, configure
+ the variable `org-replace-disputed-keys'. When set, Org will move
+ the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda buffer
+ (but not during date selection).
+
+ S-UP -> M-p S-DOWN -> M-n
+ S-LEFT -> M-- S-RIGHT -> M-+
+ C-S-LEFT -> M-S-- C-S-RIGHT -> M-S-+
+
+ Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you
+ want to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
+ `org-disputed-keys'.
+
+`yasnippet.el'
+ The way Org-mode binds the TAB key (binding to `[tab]' instead of
+ `"\t"') overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following
+ code fixed this problem:
+
+ (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
+ (lambda ()
+ (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
+ (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-group)))
+
+`windmove.el' by Hovav Shacham
+ This package also uses the `S-<cursor>' keys, so everything written
+ in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you
+ want make the windmove function active in locations where Org-mode
+ does not have special functionality on `S-<cursor>', add this to
+ your configuration:
+
+ ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
+ (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
+ (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
+ (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
+ (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
+
+`viper.el' by Michael Kifer
+ Viper uses `C-c /' and therefore makes this key not access the
+ corresponding Org-mode command `org-sparse-tree'. You need to find
+ another key for this command, or override the key in
+ `viper-vi-global-user-map' with
+
+ (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
+
+
+
+File: org, Node: Hacking, Next: MobileOrg, Prev: Miscellaneous, Up: Top
+
+Appendix A Hacking
+******************
+
+This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the
+functionality of Org.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
+* Add-on packages:: Available extensions
+* Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
+* Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
+* Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for LaTeX and other programs
+* Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
+* Special agenda views:: Customized views
+* Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
+* Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
+* Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
+
+
+File: org, Node: Hooks, Next: Add-on packages, Prev: Hacking, Up: Hacking
+
+A.1 Hooks
+=========
+
+Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
+functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
+use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
+maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
+`http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Add-on packages, Next: Adding hyperlink types, Prev: Hooks, Up: Hacking
+
+A.2 Add-on packages
+===================
+
+A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
+These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as
+contributed packages with the separate release available at the
+Org-mode home page at `http://orgmode.org'. The list of contributed
+packages, along with documentation about each package, is maintained by
+the Worg project at `http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Adding hyperlink types, Next: Context-sensitive commands, Prev: Add-on packages, Up: Hacking
+
+A.3 Adding hyperlink types
+==========================
+
+Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in (*note
+Hyperlinks::). If you would like to add new link types, Org provides
+an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
+`org-man.el', that will add support for creating links like
+`[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]' to show Unix manual pages inside
+Emacs:
+
+ ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
+
+ (require 'org)
+
+ (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
+ (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
+
+ (defcustom org-man-command 'man
+ "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
+ :group 'org-link
+ :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
+
+ (defun org-man-open (path)
+ "Visit the manpage on PATH.
+ PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
+ (funcall org-man-command path))
+
+ (defun org-man-store-link ()
+ "Store a link to a manpage."
+ (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
+ ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
+ (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
+ (link (concat "man:" page))
+ (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
+ (org-store-link-props
+ :type "man"
+ :link link
+ :description description))))
+
+ (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
+ "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
+ ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
+ (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
+ (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
+ (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
+
+ (provide 'org-man)
+
+ ;;; org-man.el ends here
+
+You would activate this new link type in `.emacs' with
+
+ (require 'org-man)
+
+Let's go through the file and see what it does.
+ 1. It does `(require 'org)' to make sure that `org.el' has been
+ loaded.
+
+ 2. The next line calls `org-add-link-type' to define a new link type
+ with prefix `man'. The call also contains the name of a function
+ that will be called to follow such a link.
+
+ 3. The next line adds a function to `org-store-link-functions', in
+ order to allow the command `C-c l' to record a useful link in a
+ buffer displaying a man page.
+
+ The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
+First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
+command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
+`man' and `woman'. Then the function to follow a link is defined. It
+gets the link path as an argument--in this case the link path is just a
+topic for the manual command. The function calls the value of
+`org-man-command' to display the man page.
+
+ Finally the function `org-man-store-link' is defined. When you try
+to store a link with `C-c l', this function will be called to try to
+make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
+create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
+of the variable `major-mode'. If not, the function must exit and
+return the value `nil'. If yes, the link is created by getting the
+manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
+`man:'. Then it must call the command `org-store-link-props' and set
+the `:type' and `:link' properties. Optionally you can also set the
+`:description' property to provide a default for the link description
+when the link is later inserted into an Org buffer with `C-c C-l'.
+
+ When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a
+function `org-PREFIX-complete-link' that implements special (e.g.
+completion) support for inserting such a link with `C-c C-l'. Such a
+function should not accept any arguments, and return the full link with
+prefix.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Context-sensitive commands, Next: Tables in arbitrary syntax, Prev: Adding hyperlink types, Up: Hacking
+
+A.4 Context-sensitive commands
+==============================
+
+Org has several commands that act differently depending on context.
+The most important example it the `C-c C-c' (*note The very busy C-c
+C-c key::). Also the `M-cursor' and `M-S-cursor' keys have this
+property.
+
+ Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that
+detects special context for that add-on and executes functionality
+appropriate for the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's
+`org-R.el' which allows you to evaluate commands based on the `R'
+programming language (1). For this package, special contexts are lines
+that start with `#+R:' or `#+RR:'.
+
+ (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
+ "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
+ (if (save-excursion
+ (beginning-of-line 1)
+ (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
+ (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
+ t) ;; to signal that we took action
+ nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
+
+ (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
+
+ The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that
+is the case, `org-R-apply' is called and the function returns `t' to
+signal that action was taken, and `C-c C-c' will stop looking for other
+contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it
+returns `nil' so that other, similar functions can have a try.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) `org-R.el' has been replaced by the org-mode functionality
+described in *Note Working With Source Code:: and is now obsolete.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Tables in arbitrary syntax, Next: Dynamic blocks, Prev: Context-sensitive commands, Up: Hacking
+
+A.5 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
+========================================
+
+Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
+frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
+specific languages, for example LaTeX. However, this is extremely hard
+to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare, and
+would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl-mode table editor.
+
+ This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl
+mode table in its native format (the source table), and use a custom
+function to translate the table to the correct syntax, and to install
+it in the right location (the target table). This puts the burden of
+writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows for a very
+flexible system.
+
+ Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct
+mode. You can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by
+turning `orgstruct-mode' on, then locally exporting such lists in
+another format (HTML, LaTeX or Texinfo.)
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
+* A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
+* Translator functions:: Copy and modify
+* Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
+
+
+File: org, Node: Radio tables, Next: A LaTeX example, Prev: Tables in arbitrary syntax, Up: Tables in arbitrary syntax
+
+A.5.1 Radio tables
+------------------
+
+To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
+lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
+Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
+between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
+
+ /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
+ /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
+
+Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells Orgtbl
+mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For example:
+ #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
+
+`table_name' is the reference name for the table that is also used in
+the receiver lines. `translation_function' is the Lisp function that
+does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
+arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
+passed as a property list to the translation function for
+interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
+acted upon before the translation function is called:
+
+`:skip N'
+ Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate
+ lines for this parameter!
+
+`:skipcols (n1 n2 ...)'
+ List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column
+ with calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as
+ well. Please note that the translator function sees the table
+ _after_ the removal of these columns, the function never knows
+ that there have been additional columns.
+
+The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
+without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
+compilation of a C file or processing of a LaTeX file. There are a
+number of different solutions:
+
+ * The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported
+ by the language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table
+ between `/*' and `*/' lines.
+
+ * Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of END
+ statement, for example `\bye' in TeX and `\end{document}' in LaTeX.
+
+ * You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to
+ process the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the
+ table. This only sounds tedious--the command `M-x
+ orgtbl-toggle-comment' makes this comment-toggling very easy, in
+ particular if you bind it to a key.
+
+
+File: org, Node: A LaTeX example, Next: Translator functions, Prev: Radio tables, Up: Tables in arbitrary syntax
+
+A.5.2 A LaTeX example of radio tables
+-------------------------------------
+
+The best way to wrap the source table in LaTeX is to use the `comment'
+environment provided by `comment.sty'. It has to be activated by
+placing `\usepackage{comment}' into the document header. Orgtbl mode
+can insert a radio table skeleton(1) with the command `M-x
+orgtbl-insert-radio-table'. You will be prompted for a table name,
+let's say we use `salesfigures'. You will then get the following
+template:
+
+ % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
+ % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
+ \begin{comment}
+ #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
+ | | |
+ \end{comment}
+
+The `#+ORGTBL: SEND' line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
+`orgtbl-to-latex' to convert the table into LaTeX and to put it into
+the receiver location with name `salesfigures'. You may now fill in
+the table--feel free to use the spreadsheet features(2):
+
+ % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
+ % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
+ \begin{comment}
+ #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
+ | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
+ |-------+------+---------+---------|
+ | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
+ | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
+ | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
+ #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
+ % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
+ \end{comment}
+
+When you are done, press `C-c C-c' in the table to get the converted
+table inserted between the two marker lines.
+
+ Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because
+you want to control how columns are aligned, etc. In this case we make
+sure that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
+table, and tell the command to work as a splice, i.e. to not produce
+header and footer commands of the target table:
+
+ \begin{tabular}{lrrr}
+ Month & \multicolumn{1}{c}{Days} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
+ % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
+ % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
+ \end{tabular}
+ %
+ \begin{comment}
+ #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
+ | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
+ |-------+------+---------+---------|
+ | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
+ | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
+ | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
+ #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
+ \end{comment}
+
+ The LaTeX translator function `orgtbl-to-latex' is already part of
+Orgtbl mode. It uses a `tabular' environment to typeset the table and
+marks horizontal lines with `\hline'. Furthermore, it interprets the
+following parameters (see also *note Translator functions::):
+
+`:splice nil/t'
+ When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
+ tabular environment. Default is nil.
+
+`:fmt fmt'
+ A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain `%s' for
+ the original field value. For example, to wrap each field value
+ in dollars, you could use `:fmt "$%s$"'. This may also be a
+ property list with column numbers and formats. for example `:fmt
+ (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")'. A function of one argument can be used in
+ place of the strings; the function must return a formatted string.
+
+`:efmt efmt'
+ Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format
+ should have `%s' twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for
+ example `"%s\\times10^{%s}"'. The default is `"%s\\,(%s)"'. This
+ may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for
+ example `:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^{%s}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^{%s}$")'.
+ After `efmt' has been applied to a value, `fmt' will also be
+ applied. Similar to `fmt', functions of two arguments can be
+ supplied instead of strings.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) By default this works only for LaTeX, HTML, and Texinfo.
+Configure the variable `orgtbl-radio-tables' to install templates for
+other modes.
+
+ (2) If the `#+TBLFM' line contains an odd number of dollar
+characters, this may cause problems with font-lock in LaTeX mode. As
+shown in the example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
+`comment' environment that is used to balance the dollar expressions.
+If you are using AUCTeX with the font-latex library, a much better
+solution is to add the `comment' environment to the variable
+`LaTeX-verbatim-environments'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Translator functions, Next: Radio lists, Prev: A LaTeX example, Up: Tables in arbitrary syntax
+
+A.5.3 Translator functions
+--------------------------
+
+Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: `orgtbl-to-csv'
+(comma-separated values), `orgtbl-to-tsv' (TAB-separated values)
+`orgtbl-to-latex', `orgtbl-to-html', and `orgtbl-to-texinfo'. Except
+for `orgtbl-to-html'(1), these all use a generic translator,
+`orgtbl-to-generic'. For example, `orgtbl-to-latex' itself is a very
+short function that computes the column definitions for the `tabular'
+environment, defines a few field and line separators and then hands
+processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
+
+ (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
+ "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
+ (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
+ org-table-last-alignment ""))
+ (params2
+ (list
+ :tstart (concat "\\begin{tabular}{" alignment "}")
+ :tend "\\end{tabular}"
+ :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
+ :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
+ (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
+
+ As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
+PARAMS) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
+(variable PARAMS2). The ones passed into the function (i.e. the ones
+set by the `ORGTBL SEND' line) take precedence. So if you would like
+to use the LaTeX translator, but wanted the line endings to be
+`\\[2mm]' instead of the default `\\', you could just overrule the
+default with
+
+ #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
+
+ For a new language, you can either write your own converter function
+in analogy with the LaTeX translator, or you can use the generic
+function directly. For example, if you have a language where a table
+is started with `!BTBL!', ended with `!ETBL!', and where table lines are
+started with `!BL!', ended with `!EL!', and where the field separator
+is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on a single
+line!):
+
+ #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
+ :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
+
+Please check the documentation string of the function
+`orgtbl-to-generic' for a full list of parameters understood by that
+function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
+`orgtbl-to-latex', `orgtbl-to-texinfo', and any other function using
+the generic function.
+
+ Of course you can also write a completely new function doing
+complicated things the generic translator cannot do. A translator
+function takes two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list
+of lines, each line either the symbol `hline' or a list of fields. The
+second argument is the property list containing all parameters
+specified in the `#+ORGTBL: SEND' line. The function must return a
+single string containing the formatted table. If you write a generally
+useful translator, please post it on <emacs-orgmode@gnu.org> so that
+others can benefit from your work.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) The HTML translator uses the same code that produces tables
+during HTML export.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Radio lists, Prev: Translator functions, Up: Tables in arbitrary syntax
+
+A.5.4 Radio lists
+-----------------
+
+Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending
+and receiving radio tables (*note Radio tables::). As for radio
+tables, you can insert radio list templates in HTML, LaTeX and Texinfo
+modes by calling `org-list-insert-radio-list'.
+
+ Here are the differences with radio tables:
+
+ - Orgstruct mode must be active.
+
+ - Use the `ORGLST' keyword instead of `ORGTBL'.
+
+ - The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
+ parameters.
+
+ - `C-c C-c' will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
+
+ Here is a LaTeX example. Let's say that you have this in your LaTeX
+file:
+
+ % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
+ % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
+ \begin{comment}
+ #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
+ - a new house
+ - a new computer
+ + a new keyboard
+ + a new mouse
+ - a new life
+ \end{comment}
+
+ Pressing `C-c C-c' on `a new house' and will insert the converted
+LaTeX list between the two marker lines.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Dynamic blocks, Next: Special agenda views, Prev: Tables in arbitrary syntax, Up: Hacking
+
+A.6 Dynamic blocks
+==================
+
+Org documents can contain _dynamic blocks_. These are specially marked
+regions that are updated by some user-written function. A good example
+for such a block is the clock table inserted by the command `C-c C-x
+C-r' (*note Clocking work time::).
+
+ Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a
+name to the block and can also specify parameters for the function
+producing the content of the block.
+
+ #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
+
+ #+END:
+
+ Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
+
+`C-c C-x C-u (`org-dblock-update')'
+ Update dynamic block at point.
+
+`C-u C-c C-x C-u'
+ Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
+
+ Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN
+and END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
+writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
+to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
+extra parameter `:content'.
+
+ For a block with name `myblock', the writer function is
+`org-dblock-write:myblock' with as only parameter a property list with
+the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example of a
+block that keeps track of when the block update function was last run:
+
+ #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
+
+ #+END:
+
+The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
+
+ (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
+ (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
+ (insert "Last block update at: "
+ (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
+
+ If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always
+up-to-date, you could add the function `org-update-all-dblocks' to a
+hook, for example `before-save-hook'. `org-update-all-dblocks' is
+written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
+`org-mode'.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Special agenda views, Next: Extracting agenda information, Prev: Dynamic blocks, Up: Hacking
+
+A.7 Special agenda views
+========================
+
+Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the
+selection made by these agenda views: `todo', `alltodo', `tags',
+`tags-todo', `tags-tree'. You may specify a function that is used at
+each match to verify if the match should indeed be part of the agenda
+view, and if not, how much should be skipped.
+
+ Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a
+WAITING tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that
+you have marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO
+keyword PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the
+keyword PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag
+anywhere in the subtree belonging to the project line.
+
+ To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree
+for the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return `nil' to
+indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
+tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
+search should continue from there.
+
+ (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
+ "Skip trees that are not waiting"
+ (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
+ (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
+ nil ; tag found, do not skip
+ subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
+
+ Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for
+example like this:
+
+ (org-add-agenda-custom-command
+ '("b" todo "PROJECT"
+ ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
+ (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
+
+ Note that this also binds `org-agenda-overriding-header' to get a
+meaningful header in the agenda view.
+
+ A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search
+for entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all
+entries with your custom search function, simply do a search for
+`LEVEL>0'(1), and then use `org-agenda-skip-function' to select the
+entries you really want to have.
+
+ You may also put a Lisp form into `org-agenda-skip-function'. In
+particular, you may use the functions `org-agenda-skip-entry-if' and
+`org-agenda-skip-subtree-if' in this form, for example:
+
+`'(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)'
+ Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
+
+`'(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)'
+ Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
+
+`'(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)'
+ Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
+
+`'(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)'
+ Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
+
+`'(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))'
+ Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
+
+`'(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)'
+ Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
+
+`'(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)'
+ Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline
+ or scheduled.
+
+`'(org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression")'
+ Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
+
+`'(org-agenda-skip-entry 'notregexp "regular expression")'
+ Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
+
+`'(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")'
+ Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
+
+ Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
+like this, even without defining a special function:
+
+ (org-add-agenda-custom-command
+ '("b" todo "PROJECT"
+ ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
+ 'regexp ":waiting:"))
+ (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) Note that, when using `org-odd-levels-only', a level number
+corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of stars.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Extracting agenda information, Next: Using the property API, Prev: Special agenda views, Up: Hacking
+
+A.8 Extracting agenda information
+=================================
+
+Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command line
+in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent directly
+to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
+processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
+`org-batch-agenda', that produces an agenda view and sends it as ASCII
+text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter. If
+the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands you
+have configured in `org-agenda-custom-commands', basically any key you
+can use after `C-c a'. For example, to directly print the current TODO
+list, you could use
+
+ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
+
+ If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used
+as a tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping
+list (all items with the tag `shop', but excluding the tag `NewYork'),
+you could use
+
+ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
+ -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
+
+You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
+
+ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
+ -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
+ org-agenda-span month \
+ org-agenda-include-diary nil \
+ org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
+ | lpr
+
+which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
+`~/org/projects.org', not even including the diary.
+
+ If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways,
+you can use the command `org-batch-agenda-csv' to get a comma-separated
+list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
+contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
+are:
+
+ category The category of the item
+ head The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY
+ type The type of the agenda entry, can be
+ todo selected in TODO match
+ tagsmatch selected in tags match
+ diary imported from diary
+ deadline a deadline
+ scheduled scheduled
+ timestamp appointment, selected by timestamp
+ closed entry was closed on date
+ upcoming-deadline warning about nearing deadline
+ past-scheduled forwarded scheduled item
+ block entry has date block including date
+ todo The TODO keyword, if any
+ tags All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons
+ date The relevant date, like 2007-2-14
+ time The time, like 15:00-16:50
+ extra String with extra planning info
+ priority-l The priority letter if any was given
+ priority-n The computed numerical priority
+
+Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
+led to the selection of the item.
+
+ A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
+For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
+Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
+
+ #!/usr/bin/perl
+
+ # define the Emacs command to run
+ $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
+
+ # run it and capture the output
+ $agenda = qx{$cmd 2>/dev/null};
+
+ # loop over all lines
+ foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) {
+ # get the individual values
+ ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
+ $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
+ # process and print
+ print "[ ] $head\n";
+ }
+
+
+File: org, Node: Using the property API, Next: Using the mapping API, Prev: Extracting agenda information, Up: Hacking
+
+A.9 Using the property API
+==========================
+
+Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
+properties.
+
+ -- Function: org-entry-properties &optional pom which
+ Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.
+ This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for
+ deadline, scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties
+ defined in the entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may
+ occur multiple times if the property key was used several times.
+ POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used. If
+ WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is `special'
+ or `standard', only get that subclass.
+
+ -- Function: org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
+ Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By
+ default, this only looks at properties defined locally in the
+ entry. If INHERIT is non-nil and the entry does not have the
+ property, then also check higher levels of the hierarchy. If
+ INHERIT is the symbol `selective', use inheritance if and only if
+ the setting of `org-use-property-inheritance' selects PROPERTY for
+ inheritance.
+
+ -- Function: org-entry-delete pom property
+ Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
+
+ -- Function: org-entry-put pom property value
+ Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
+
+ -- Function: org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
+ Get all property keys in the current buffer.
+
+ -- Function: org-insert-property-drawer
+ Insert a property drawer at point.
+
+ -- Function: org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest
+ values
+ Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a
+ list of strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as
+ separators.
+
+ -- Function: org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
+ Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated
+ list of values and return the values as a list of strings.
+
+ -- Function: org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
+ Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated
+ list of values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
+
+ -- Function: org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property
+ value
+ Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated
+ list of values and make sure that VALUE is _not_ in this list.
+
+ -- Function: org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property
+ value
+ Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated
+ list of values and check if VALUE is in this list.
+
+ -- User Option: org-property-allowed-value-functions
+ Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific
+ property. The functions must take a single argument, the name of
+ the property, and return a flat list of allowed values. If `:ETC'
+ is one of the values, use the values as completion help, but allow
+ also other values to be entered. The functions must return `nil'
+ if they are not responsible for this property.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Using the mapping API, Prev: Using the property API, Up: Hacking
+
+A.10 Using the mapping API
+==========================
+
+Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries
+satisfying certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to
+produce agenda views, but there is also an API that can be used to
+execute arbitrary functions for each or selected entries. The main
+entry point for this API is:
+
+ -- Function: org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
+ Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
+
+ FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called
+ without arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of
+ the headline. The return values of all calls to the function will
+ be collected and returned as a list.
+
+ The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so
+ FUNC does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the
+ cursor will be moved to the end of the line (presumably of the
+ headline of the processed entry) and search continues from there.
+ Under some circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results.
+ For example, if you have removed (e.g. archived) the current
+ (sub)tree it could mean that the next entry will be skipped
+ entirely. In such cases, you can specify the position from where
+ search should continue by making FUNC set the variable
+ `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer position.
+
+ MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda
+ match view. Only headlines that are matched by this query will be
+ considered during the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all
+ headlines will be visited by the iteration.
+
+ SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
+
+ nil the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any
+ tree the subtree started with the entry at point
+ file the current buffer, without restriction
+ file-with-archives
+ the current buffer, and any archives associated with it
+ agenda all agenda files
+ agenda-with-archives
+ all agenda files with any archive files associated with them
+ (file1 file2 ...)
+ if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned
+ The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping
+ facilities of the scanner. The following items can be given here:
+
+ archive skip trees with the archive tag
+ comment skip trees with the COMMENT keyword
+ function or Lisp form
+ will be used as value for `org-agenda-skip-function',
+ so whenever the function returns t, FUNC
+ will not be called for that entry and search will
+ continue from the point where the function leaves it
+
+ The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything
+you like. It can use the property API (*note Using the property API::)
+to gather more information about the entry, or in order to change
+metadata in the entry. Here are a couple of functions that might be
+handy:
+
+ -- Function: org-todo &optional arg
+ Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the
+ functions for the many possible values for the argument ARG.
+
+ -- Function: org-priority &optional action
+ Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this
+ function for the possible values for ACTION.
+
+ -- Function: org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
+ Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either
+ `on' or `off' will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on
+ or off.
+
+ -- Function: org-promote
+ Promote the current entry.
+
+ -- Function: org-demote
+ Demote the current entry.
+
+ Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current
+file with a tag `TOMORROW' into TODO entries with the keyword
+`UPCOMING'. Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be
+ignored.
+
+ (org-map-entries
+ '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
+ "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
+
+ The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
+`WAITING', in all agenda files.
+
+ (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
+
+
+File: org, Node: MobileOrg, Next: History and Acknowledgments, Prev: Hacking, Up: Top
+
+Appendix B MobileOrg
+********************
+
+MobileOrg (http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/) is an application for the
+iPhone/iPod Touch series of devices, developed by Richard Moreland.
+MobileOrg offers offline viewing and capture support for an Org-mode
+system rooted on a "real" computer. It does also allow you to record
+changes to existing entries. Android users should check out MobileOrg
+Android (http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/) by Matt
+Jones.
+
+ This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda
+views in a format that can be displayed by MobileOrg, and for
+integrating notes captured and changes made by MobileOrg into the main
+system.
+
+ For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set
+up the customization variables `org-todo-keywords' and `org-tags-alist'
+to cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files
+use only part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags
+set up with in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of
+TODO state sets (*note Per-file keywords::) and mutually exclusive tags
+(*note Setting tags::) only for those set in these variables.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
+* Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
+* Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
+
+
+File: org, Node: Setting up the staging area, Next: Pushing to MobileOrg, Prev: MobileOrg, Up: MobileOrg
+
+B.1 Setting up the staging area
+===============================
+
+MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server.
+If you are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the
+files that are uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org-mode
+7.02 and with MobileOrg 1.5 (iPhone version), and you need an `openssl'
+installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
+MobileOrg and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
+`org-mobile-use-encryption'(1).
+
+ The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
+Dropbox.com (http://dropbox.com) account(2). When MobileOrg first
+connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory MobileOrg inside
+the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell Emacs about it:
+
+ (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
+
+ Org-mode has commands to put files for MobileOrg into that directory,
+and to read captured notes from there.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) If you can safely store the password in your Emacs setup, you
+might also want to configure `org-mobile-encryption-password'. Please
+read the docstring of that variable. Note that encryption will apply
+only to the contents of the `.org' files. The file names themselves
+will remain visible.
+
+ (2) If you cannot use Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does
+not support it, you can use a webdav server. For more information,
+check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this FAQ entry
+(http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.php#mobileorg_webdav).
+
+
+File: org, Node: Pushing to MobileOrg, Next: Pulling from MobileOrg, Prev: Setting up the staging area, Up: MobileOrg
+
+B.2 Pushing to MobileOrg
+========================
+
+This operation copies all files currently listed in `org-mobile-files'
+to the directory `org-mobile-directory'. By default this list contains
+all agenda files (as listed in `org-agenda-files'), but additional files
+can be included by customizing `org-mobiles-files'. File names will be
+staged with paths relative to `org-directory', so all files should be
+inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org
+file `agendas.org' with all custom agenda view defined by the user(1).
+Finally, Org writes the file `index.org', containing links to all other
+files. MobileOrg first reads this file from the server, and then
+downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the
+download, MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums(2) have
+changed.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) While creating the agendas, Org-mode will force ID properties on
+all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely identified
+if MobileOrg flags them for further action. If you do not want to get
+these properties in so many entries, you can set the variable
+`org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items' to `nil'. Org mode will then
+rely on outline paths, in the hope that these will be unique enough.
+
+ (2) stored automatically in the file `checksums.dat'
+
+
+File: org, Node: Pulling from MobileOrg, Prev: Pushing to MobileOrg, Up: MobileOrg
+
+B.3 Pulling from MobileOrg
+==========================
+
+When MobileOrg synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
+files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to
+flagged and changed entries to the file `mobileorg.org' on the server.
+Org has a _pull_ operation that integrates this information into an
+inbox file and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is
+how it works:
+
+ 1. Org moves all entries found in `mobileorg.org'(1) and appends them
+ to the file pointed to by the variable
+ `org-mobile-inbox-for-pull'. Each captured entry and each editing
+ event will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
+
+ 2. After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the
+ changes made in MobileOrg. Some changes are applied directly and
+ without user interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO
+ state, headline and body text that can be cleanly applied.
+ Entries that have been flagged for further action will receive a
+ tag `:FLAGGED:', so that they can be easily found again. When
+ there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
+ pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an
+ error message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
+
+ 3. Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries.
+ The user should then go through these entries and do whatever
+ actions are necessary. If a note has been stored while flagging
+ an entry in MobileOrg, that note will be displayed in the echo
+ area when the cursor is on the corresponding agenda line.
+ `?'
+ Pressing `?' in that special agenda will display the full
+ flagging note in another window and also push it onto the
+ kill ring. So you could use `? z C-y C-c C-c' to store that
+ flagging note as a normal note in the entry. Pressing `?'
+ twice in succession will offer to remove the `:FLAGGED:' tag
+ along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored in a
+ property). In this way you indicate that the intended
+ processing for this flagged entry is finished.
+
+ If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can
+always return to this agenda view(2) using `C-c a ?'.
+
+ ---------- Footnotes ----------
+
+ (1) `mobileorg.org' will be empty after this operation.
+
+ (2) Note, however, that there is a subtle difference. The view
+created automatically by `M-x org-mobile-pull <RET>' is guaranteed to
+search all files that have been addressed by the last pull. This might
+include a file that is not currently in your list of agenda files. If
+you later use `C-c a ?' to regenerate the view, only the current agenda
+files will be searched.
+
+
+File: org, Node: History and Acknowledgments, Next: Main Index, Prev: MobileOrg, Up: Top
+
+Appendix C History and acknowledgments
+**************************************
+
+Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the
+Emacs Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects,
+and using Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to
+remember eleven different commands with two or three keys per command,
+only to hide and show parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely
+unacceptable to me. Also, when using outlines to take notes, I
+constantly wanted to restructure the tree, organizing it parallel to my
+thoughts and plans. _Visibility cycling_ and _structure editing_ were
+originally implemented in the package `outline-magic.el', but quickly
+moved to the more general `org.el'. As this environment became
+comfortable for project planning, the next step was adding _TODO
+entries_, basic _timestamps_, and _table support_. These areas
+highlighted the two main goals that Org still has today: to be a new,
+outline-based, plain text mode with innovative and intuitive editing
+features, and to incorporate project planning functionality directly
+into a notes file.
+
+ Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
+<emacs-orgmode@gnu.org> have provided a constant stream of bug reports,
+feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code. Many
+thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am trying
+to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence in
+shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be complete, if I
+have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and let me know.
+
+ Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
+
+Bastien Guerry
+ Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of
+ them integrated into the core by now), including the LaTeX
+ exporter and the plain list parser. His support during the early
+ days, when he basically acted as co-maintainer, was central to the
+ success of this project. Bastien also invented Worg, helped
+ establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsors hosting costs
+ for the orgmode.org website.
+
+Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
+ Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system,
+ which turns Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating
+ code and doing literate programming and reproducible research.
+
+John Wiegley
+ John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly
+ to Org, including the attachment system (`org-attach.el'),
+ integration with Apple Mail (`org-mac-message.el'), hierarchical
+ dependencies of TODO items, habit tracking (`org-habits.el'), and
+ encryption (`org-crypt.el'). Also, the capture system is really
+ an extended copy of his great `remember.el'.
+
+Sebastian Rose
+ Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the
+ pitiful work of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this
+ part of Org onto a much higher level. He also wrote
+ `org-info.js', a Java script for displaying webpages derived from
+ Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with single-key
+ navigation.
+
+OK, now to the full list of contributions! Again, please let me know
+what I am missing here!
+
+ * Russel Adams came up with the idea for drawers.
+
+ * Thomas Baumann wrote `org-bbdb.el' and `org-mhe.el'.
+
+ * Christophe Bataillon created the great unicorn logo that we use on
+ the Org-mode website.
+
+ * Alex Bochannek provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
+
+ * Jan Böcker wrote `org-docview.el'.
+
+ * Brad Bozarth showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org-mode files.
+
+ * Tom Breton wrote `org-choose.el'.
+
+ * Charles Cave's suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
+ for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
+
+ * Pavel Chalmoviansky influenced the agenda treatment of items with
+ specified time.
+
+ * Gregory Chernov patched support for Lisp forms into table
+ calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by
+ porting `nouline.el' to XEmacs.
+
+ * Sacha Chua suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
+
+ * Baoqiu Cui contributed the DocBook exporter.
+
+ * Eddward DeVilla proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
+ came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an
+ API for them.
+
+ * Nick Dokos tracked down several nasty bugs.
+
+ * Kees Dullemond used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
+ inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He
+ also asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
+
+ * Thomas S. Dye contributed documentation on Worg and helped
+ integrating the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
+
+ * Christian Egli converted the documentation into Texinfo format,
+ inspired the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML
+ exporter, and wrote `org-taskjuggler.el'.
+
+ * David Emery provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
+ HTML agendas.
+
+ * Nic Ferrier contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
+
+ * Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
+
+ * John Foerch figured out how to make incremental search show context
+ around a match in a hidden outline tree.
+
+ * Raimar Finken wrote `org-git-line.el'.
+
+ * Mikael Fornius works as a mailing list moderator.
+
+ * Austin Frank works as a mailing list moderator.
+
+ * Eric Fraga drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
+ testing.
+
+ * Barry Gidden did proofreading the manual in preparation for the
+ book publication through Network Theory Ltd.
+
+ * Niels Giesen had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
+
+ * Nicolas Goaziou rewrote much of the plain list code.
+
+ * Kai Grossjohann pointed out key-binding conflicts with other
+ packages.
+
+ * Brian Gough of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as
+ a book.
+
+ * Bernt Hansen has driven much of the support for auto-repeating
+ tasks, task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear
+ explanations have been critical when we started to adopt the Git
+ version control system.
+
+ * Manuel Hermenegildo has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
+ patches.
+
+ * Phil Jackson wrote `org-irc.el'.
+
+ * Scott Jaderholm proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
+ folded entries, and column view for properties.
+
+ * Matt Jones wrote MobileOrg Android.
+
+ * Tokuya Kameshima wrote `org-wl.el' and `org-mew.el'.
+
+ * Shidai Liu ("Leo") asked for embedded LaTeX and tested it. He also
+ provided frequent feedback and some patches.
+
+ * Matt Lundin has proposed last-row references for table formulas
+ and named invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
+
+ * David Maus wrote `org-atom.el', maintains the issues file for Org,
+ and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent
+ replies, small fixes and patches.
+
+ * Jason F. McBrayer suggested agenda export to CSV format.
+
+ * Max Mikhanosha came up with the idea of refiling.
+
+ * Dmitri Minaev sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
+ basis.
+
+ * Stefan Monnier provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
+ happy.
+
+ * Richard Moreland wrote MobileOrg for the iPhone.
+
+ * Rick Moynihan proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
+ and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
+
+ * Todd Neal provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
+
+ * Greg Newman refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
+
+ * Tim O'Callaghan suggested in-file links, search options for general
+ file links, and TAGS.
+
+ * Osamu Okano wrote `orgcard2ref.pl', a Perl program to create a text
+ version of the reference card.
+
+ * Takeshi Okano translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
+ into Japanese.
+
+ * Oliver Oppitz suggested multi-state TODO items.
+
+ * Scott Otterson sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
+ links, among other things.
+
+ * Pete Phillips helped during the development of the TAGS feature,
+ and provided frequent feedback.
+
+ * Martin Pohlack provided the code snippet to bundle character
+ insertion into bundles of 20 for undo.
+
+ * T.V. Raman reported bugs and suggested improvements.
+
+ * Matthias Rempe (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
+ control.
+
+ * Paul Rivier provided the basic implementation of named footnotes.
+ He also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
+
+ * Kevin Rogers contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
+
+ * Frank Ruell solved the mystery of the `keymapp nil' bug, a
+ conflict with `allout.el'.
+
+ * Jason Riedy generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl
+ tables with extensive patches.
+
+ * Philip Rooke created the Org reference card, provided lots of
+ feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
+
+ * Christian Schlauer proposed angular brackets around links, among
+ other things.
+
+ * Paul Sexton wrote `org-ctags.el'.
+
+ * Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by Tom Shannon's
+ `organizer-mode.el'.
+
+ * Ilya Shlyakhter proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in
+ literal examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code
+ lines.
+
+ * Stathis Sideris wrote the `ditaa.jar' ASCII to PNG converter that
+ is now packaged into Org's `contrib' directory.
+
+ * Daniel Sinder came up with the idea of internal archiving by
+ locking subtrees.
+
+ * Dale Smith proposed link abbreviations.
+
+ * James TD Smith has contributed a large number of patches for useful
+ tweaks and features.
+
+ * Adam Spiers asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
+ extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the
+ mapping API.
+
+ * Ulf Stegemann created the table to translate special symbols to
+ HTML, LaTeX, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
+
+ * Andy Stewart contributed code to `org-w3m.el', to copy HTML content
+ with links transformation to Org syntax.
+
+ * David O'Toole wrote `org-publish.el' and drafted the manual
+ chapter about publishing.
+
+ * Sebastien Vauban reported many issues with LaTeX and BEAMER export
+ and enabled source code highlighling in Gnus.
+
+ * Stefan Vollmar organized a video-recorded talk at the
+ Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation
+ of a concept index for HTML export.
+
+ * Ju"rgen Vollmer contributed code generating the table of contents
+ in HTML output.
+
+ * Samuel Wales has provided important feedback and bug reports.
+
+ * Chris Wallace provided a patch implementing the `QUOTE' keyword.
+
+ * David Wainberg suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
+ system.
+
+ * Carsten Wimmer suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
+ linking to Gnus.
+
+ * Roland Winkler requested additional key bindings to make Org work
+ on a tty.
+
+ * Piotr Zielinski wrote `org-mouse.el', proposed agenda blocks and
+ contributed various ideas and code snippets.
+
+
+File: org, Node: Main Index, Next: Key Index, Prev: History and Acknowledgments, Up: Top
+
+Concept index
+*************
+
+
+* Menu:
+
+* #+ARCHIVE: Moving subtrees. (line 27)
+* #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: Images in DocBook export.
+ (line 30)
+* #+ATTR_HTML <1>: Links in HTML export.
+ (line 21)
+* #+ATTR_HTML <2>: Tables in HTML export.
+ (line 11)
+* #+ATTR_HTML: Images in HTML export.
+ (line 24)
+* #+ATTR_LaTeX <1>: Images in LaTeX export.
+ (line 25)
+* #+ATTR_LaTeX: Tables in LaTeX export.
+ (line 13)
+* #+AUTHOR: Export options. (line 19)
+* #+BEGIN, clocktable: The clock table. (line 35)
+* #+BEGIN, columnview: Capturing column view.
+ (line 11)
+* #+BEGIN:dynamic block: Dynamic blocks. (line 15)
+* #+BEGIN_CENTER: Paragraphs. (line 31)
+* #+BEGIN_COMMENT: Comment lines. (line 6)
+* #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK: Quoting DocBook code.
+ (line 11)
+* #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE: Literal examples. (line 8)
+* #+BEGIN_HTML: Quoting HTML tags. (line 12)
+* #+BEGIN_LaTeX: Quoting LaTeX code. (line 14)
+* #+BEGIN_QUOTE: Paragraphs. (line 26)
+* #+BEGIN_SRC: Literal examples. (line 27)
+* #+BEGIN_VERSE: Paragraphs. (line 13)
+* #+BIND: Export options. (line 19)
+* #+CAPTION <1>: Images in HTML export.
+ (line 24)
+* #+CAPTION <2>: Tables in HTML export.
+ (line 11)
+* #+CAPTION <3>: Images in DocBook export.
+ (line 30)
+* #+CAPTION <4>: Images and tables. (line 6)
+* #+CAPTION <5>: Images in LaTeX export.
+ (line 25)
+* #+CAPTION: Tables in LaTeX export.
+ (line 13)
+* #+CATEGORY: Categories. (line 6)
+* #+COLUMNS: Scope of column definitions.
+ (line 8)
+* #+CONSTANTS: References. (line 99)
+* #+DATE: Export options. (line 19)
+* #+DESCRIPTION: Export options. (line 19)
+* #+DOCBOOK: Quoting DocBook code.
+ (line 9)
+* #+DRAWERS: Drawers. (line 6)
+* #+EMAIL: Export options. (line 19)
+* #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Export options. (line 19)
+* #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Export options. (line 19)
+* #+FILETAGS: Tag inheritance. (line 20)
+* #+HTML: Quoting HTML tags. (line 12)
+* #+INCLUDE: Include files. (line 7)
+* #+INFOJS_OPT: JavaScript support. (line 26)
+* #+KEYWORDS: Export options. (line 19)
+* #+LABEL <1>: Images and tables. (line 6)
+* #+LABEL <2>: Images in LaTeX export.
+ (line 25)
+* #+LABEL <3>: Tables in LaTeX export.
+ (line 13)
+* #+LABEL: Images in DocBook export.
+ (line 30)
+* #+LANGUAGE: Export options. (line 19)
+* #+LaTeX: Quoting LaTeX code. (line 12)
+* #+LATEX_CLASS: Header and sectioning.
+ (line 8)
+* #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: Header and sectioning.
+ (line 8)
+* #+LATEX_HEADER <1>: Export options. (line 19)
+* #+LATEX_HEADER: Header and sectioning.
+ (line 8)
+* #+LINK: Link abbreviations. (line 41)
+* #+LINK_HOME: Export options. (line 19)
+* #+LINK_UP: Export options. (line 19)
+* #+MACRO: Macro replacement. (line 6)
+* #+OPTIONS <1>: Headings and sections.
+ (line 14)
+* #+OPTIONS: Export options. (line 19)
+* #+ORGLST: Radio lists. (line 25)
+* #+ORGTBL: Radio tables. (line 15)
+* #+ORGTBL, SEND: A LaTeX example. (line 14)
+* #+PLOT: Org-Plot. (line 6)
+* #+PRIORITIES: Priorities. (line 44)
+* #+PROPERTY: Property syntax. (line 37)
+* #+SEQ_TODO: Per-file keywords. (line 6)
+* #+SETUPFILE: In-buffer settings. (line 61)
+* #+STARTUP:: In-buffer settings. (line 74)
+* #+STYLE: CSS support. (line 44)
+* #+TAGS: Setting tags. (line 29)
+* #+TBLFM: Field formulas. (line 12)
+* #+TBLNAME: References. (line 120)
+* #+TEXT <1>: Initial text. (line 6)
+* #+TEXT: Export options. (line 19)
+* #+TITLE <1>: Document title. (line 8)
+* #+TITLE: Export options. (line 19)
+* #+TODO: Per-file keywords. (line 6)
+* #+TYP_TODO: Per-file keywords. (line 6)
+* #+XSLT: Export options. (line 19)
+* abbreviation, links: Link abbreviations. (line 6)
+* acknowledgments: History and Acknowledgments.
+ (line 6)
+* action, for publishing: Publishing action. (line 6)
+* activation: Activation. (line 6)
+* active region <1>: Structure editing. (line 124)
+* active region <2>: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 11)
+* active region <3>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 156)
+* active region <4>: HTML Export commands.
+ (line 6)
+* active region <5>: LaTeX/PDF export commands.
+ (line 6)
+* active region: DocBook export commands.
+ (line 6)
+* add-on packages: Add-on packages. (line 6)
+* add-ons, context-sensitive commands: Context-sensitive commands.
+ (line 6)
+* agenda: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 6)
+* agenda dispatcher: Agenda dispatcher. (line 6)
+* agenda files: Agenda files. (line 6)
+* agenda files, removing buffers: Agenda commands. (line 486)
+* agenda views: Agenda Views. (line 6)
+* agenda views, custom: Custom agenda views. (line 6)
+* agenda views, exporting <1>: Exporting Agenda Views.
+ (line 13)
+* agenda views, exporting <2>: Agenda commands. (line 473)
+* agenda views, exporting: Exporting Agenda Views.
+ (line 6)
+* agenda views, user-defined: Special agenda views.
+ (line 6)
+* agenda, column view: Agenda column view. (line 6)
+* agenda, pipe: Extracting agenda information.
+ (line 6)
+* agenda, with block views: Block agenda. (line 6)
+* align, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 94)
+* alignment in tables: Column width and alignment.
+ (line 6)
+* anniversaries, from BBDB: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 69)
+* API, for mapping: Using the mapping API.
+ (line 6)
+* API, for properties <1>: Using the property API.
+ (line 6)
+* API, for properties: Property API. (line 6)
+* appointment reminders: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 102)
+* appt.el: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 102)
+* archive locations: Moving subtrees. (line 20)
+* archiving: Archiving. (line 6)
+* ASCII export: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 6)
+* Atom feeds: RSS Feeds. (line 6)
+* attachments: Attachments. (line 6)
+* author: Feedback. (line 6)
+* author info, in export: Export options. (line 39)
+* autoload: Activation. (line 6)
+* babel, languages: Languages. (line 6)
+* babel, library of: Library of Babel. (line 6)
+* backtrace of an error: Feedback. (line 40)
+* Baur, Steven L.: Cooperation. (line 74)
+* BBDB links: External links. (line 6)
+* BBDB, anniversaries: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 69)
+* block agenda: Block agenda. (line 6)
+* blocking, of checkboxes: Checkboxes. (line 46)
+* blocks, folding: Blocks. (line 6)
+* bold text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace.
+ (line 6)
+* Boolean logic, for tag/property searches: Matching tags and properties.
+ (line 34)
+* bug reports: Feedback. (line 6)
+* C-c C-c, overview: The very busy C-c C-c key.
+ (line 6)
+* calc package: The spreadsheet. (line 6)
+* calc.el: Cooperation. (line 6)
+* calculations, in tables <1>: The spreadsheet. (line 6)
+* calculations, in tables: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 156)
+* calendar commands, from agenda: Agenda commands. (line 422)
+* calendar integration: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 28)
+* calendar, for selecting date: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 70)
+* capture <1>: Capture. (line 6)
+* capture: Capture - Refile - Archive.
+ (line 6)
+* category: Categories. (line 6)
+* category, require for tags/property match: Matching tags and properties.
+ (line 59)
+* CDLaTeX: CDLaTeX mode. (line 6)
+* cdlatex.el: Cooperation. (line 29)
+* checkbox blocking: Checkboxes. (line 46)
+* checkbox statistics: Checkboxes. (line 30)
+* checkboxes: Checkboxes. (line 6)
+* checkboxes and TODO dependencies: TODO dependencies. (line 44)
+* children, subtree visibility state: Visibility cycling. (line 10)
+* clean outline view: Clean view. (line 6)
+* clocking time: Clocking work time. (line 6)
+* clocktable, dynamic block: The clock table. (line 6)
+* code block, batch execution: Batch execution. (line 6)
+* code block, editing: Editing source code. (line 6)
+* code block, evaluating: Evaluating code blocks.
+ (line 6)
+* code block, exporting: Exporting code blocks.
+ (line 6)
+* code block, extracting source code: Extracting source code.
+ (line 6)
+* code block, header arguments: Header arguments. (line 6)
+* code block, key bindings: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 6)
+* code block, languages: Languages. (line 6)
+* code block, library: Library of Babel. (line 6)
+* code block, noweb reference: Noweb reference syntax.
+ (line 6)
+* code block, results of evaluation: Results of evaluation.
+ (line 6)
+* code block, structure: Structure of code blocks.
+ (line 6)
+* code line references, markup rules: Literal examples. (line 6)
+* code text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace.
+ (line 6)
+* column formula: Column formulas. (line 6)
+* column view, for properties: Defining columns. (line 6)
+* column view, in agenda: Agenda column view. (line 6)
+* column, of field coordinates: References. (line 84)
+* commands, in agenda buffer: Agenda commands. (line 6)
+* comment lines: Comment lines. (line 6)
+* completion, of dictionary words: Completion. (line 6)
+* completion, of file names: Handling links. (line 89)
+* completion, of link abbreviations: Completion. (line 6)
+* completion, of links: Handling links. (line 66)
+* completion, of option keywords <1>: Export options. (line 6)
+* completion, of option keywords <2>: Per-file keywords. (line 24)
+* completion, of option keywords: Completion. (line 6)
+* completion, of property keys: Completion. (line 6)
+* completion, of tags <1>: Completion. (line 6)
+* completion, of tags: Setting tags. (line 11)
+* completion, of TeX symbols: Completion. (line 6)
+* completion, of TODO keywords <1>: Workflow states. (line 15)
+* completion, of TODO keywords: Completion. (line 6)
+* constants, in calculations: References. (line 99)
+* constants.el: Cooperation. (line 17)
+* constcgs, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 140)
+* constSI, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 140)
+* content, STARTUP keyword <1>: Visibility cycling. (line 55)
+* content, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 80)
+* contents, global visibility state: Visibility cycling. (line 22)
+* context-sensitive commands, hooks: Context-sensitive commands.
+ (line 6)
+* coordinates, of field: References. (line 84)
+* copying, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6)
+* Countdown timer: Countdown timer. (line 6)
+* creating timestamps: Creating timestamps. (line 6)
+* CSS, for HTML export: CSS support. (line 6)
+* CUA.el: Conflicts. (line 19)
+* Cui, Baoqiu: DocBook export. (line 6)
+* custom agenda views: Custom agenda views. (line 6)
+* custom date/time format: Custom time format. (line 6)
+* custom search strings: Custom searches. (line 6)
+* customization: Customization. (line 6)
+* customtime, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 137)
+* cutting, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6)
+* cycling, of TODO states: TODO basics. (line 14)
+* cycling, visibility: Visibility cycling. (line 6)
+* daily agenda: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 6)
+* date format, custom: Custom time format. (line 6)
+* date range: Timestamps. (line 40)
+* date stamp: Dates and Times. (line 6)
+* date stamps: Timestamps. (line 6)
+* date, reading in minibuffer: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 6)
+* dates: Dates and Times. (line 6)
+* Davison, Dan: Working With Source Code.
+ (line 6)
+* DEADLINE keyword: Deadlines and scheduling.
+ (line 9)
+* deadlines: Timestamps. (line 6)
+* debugging, of table formulas: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 98)
+* demotion, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6)
+* dependencies, of TODO states: TODO dependencies. (line 6)
+* diary entries, creating from agenda: Agenda commands. (line 427)
+* diary integration: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 28)
+* dictionary word completion: Completion. (line 6)
+* directories, for publishing: Sources and destinations.
+ (line 6)
+* dispatcher, for export commands: The export dispatcher.
+ (line 6)
+* dispatching agenda commands: Agenda dispatcher. (line 6)
+* display changing, in agenda: Agenda commands. (line 64)
+* DocBook export: DocBook export. (line 6)
+* DocBook recursive sections: Recursive sections. (line 6)
+* document structure: Document Structure. (line 6)
+* document title, markup rules: Document title. (line 6)
+* Dominik, Carsten: Cooperation. (line 29)
+* DONE, final TODO keyword: Per-file keywords. (line 27)
+* drawer, for properties: Property syntax. (line 6)
+* drawer, for state change recording: Tracking TODO state changes.
+ (line 6)
+* drawers: Drawers. (line 6)
+* dvipng: Math formatting in HTML export.
+ (line 6)
+* dynamic blocks: Dynamic blocks. (line 6)
+* dynamic indentation: Clean view. (line 6)
+* editing tables: Tables. (line 6)
+* editing, of table formulas: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 6)
+* effort estimates: Effort estimates. (line 6)
+* effort filtering, in agenda: Agenda commands. (line 179)
+* Elisp links: External links. (line 6)
+* emacsserver: Protocols. (line 6)
+* emphasized text: Export options. (line 39)
+* entitiesplain, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 160)
+* entitiespretty, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 160)
+* evaluate time range: Creating timestamps. (line 59)
+* even, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 128)
+* export, selective by tags: Selective export. (line 6)
+* exporting: Exporting. (line 6)
+* exporting agenda views <1>: Exporting Agenda Views.
+ (line 13)
+* exporting agenda views: Agenda commands. (line 473)
+* exporting, not: Comment lines. (line 6)
+* extended TODO keywords: TODO extensions. (line 6)
+* external archiving: Moving subtrees. (line 6)
+* external links: External links. (line 6)
+* external links, in HTML export: Links in HTML export.
+ (line 6)
+* faces, for TODO keywords: Faces for TODO keywords.
+ (line 6)
+* FAQ: Summary. (line 53)
+* feedback: Feedback. (line 6)
+* field coordinates: References. (line 84)
+* field formula: Field formulas. (line 6)
+* field references: References. (line 15)
+* file links: External links. (line 6)
+* file links, searching: Search options. (line 6)
+* file name completion: Handling links. (line 89)
+* files for agenda: Agenda files. (line 6)
+* files, adding to agenda list: Agenda files. (line 15)
+* files, selecting for publishing: Selecting files. (line 6)
+* filtering, by tag and effort, in agenda: Agenda commands. (line 179)
+* fixed-width sections: Export options. (line 39)
+* fnadjust, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 145)
+* fnauto, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 145)
+* fnconfirm, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 145)
+* fninline, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 145)
+* fnlocal, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 145)
+* fnplain, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 145)
+* fnprompt, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 145)
+* folded, subtree visibility state: Visibility cycling. (line 10)
+* folding, sparse trees: Sparse trees. (line 6)
+* following links: Handling links. (line 101)
+* footnote.el <1>: Footnote markup. (line 6)
+* footnote.el: Cooperation. (line 74)
+* footnotes <1>: Footnotes. (line 6)
+* footnotes: Export options. (line 39)
+* footnotes, markup rules: Footnote markup. (line 6)
+* format specifier: Formula syntax for Calc.
+ (line 14)
+* format, of links: Link format. (line 6)
+* formatting source code, markup rules: Literal examples. (line 23)
+* formula debugging: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 98)
+* formula editing: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 6)
+* formula syntax, Calc: Formula syntax for Calc.
+ (line 6)
+* formula, for individual table field: Field formulas. (line 6)
+* formula, for table column: Column formulas. (line 6)
+* formula, in tables: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 156)
+* Freemind export: Freemind export. (line 6)
+* Gillespie, Dave: Cooperation. (line 6)
+* global cycling: Visibility cycling. (line 22)
+* global key bindings: Activation. (line 6)
+* global TODO list: Global TODO list. (line 6)
+* global visibility states: Visibility cycling. (line 22)
+* Gnus links: External links. (line 6)
+* graph, in tables: Org-Plot. (line 6)
+* grouping columns in tables: Column groups. (line 6)
+* Guerry, Bastien: LaTeX and PDF export.
+ (line 6)
+* habits: Tracking your habits.
+ (line 6)
+* hacking: Hacking. (line 6)
+* header, for LaTeX files: Header and sectioning.
+ (line 6)
+* headings and sections, markup rules: Headings and sections.
+ (line 6)
+* headline levels: Export options. (line 39)
+* headline levels, for exporting <1>: LaTeX/PDF export commands.
+ (line 37)
+* headline levels, for exporting <2>: HTML Export commands.
+ (line 39)
+* headline levels, for exporting: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 34)
+* headline navigation: Motion. (line 6)
+* headline tagging: Tags. (line 6)
+* headline, promotion and demotion: Structure editing. (line 6)
+* headlines: Headlines. (line 6)
+* hide text: Visibility cycling. (line 6)
+* hideblocks, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 156)
+* hideblocks, STARTUP keyword: Blocks. (line 13)
+* hidestars, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 128)
+* hiding leading stars: Clean view. (line 6)
+* history: History and Acknowledgments.
+ (line 6)
+* hooks: Hooks. (line 6)
+* horizontal rules, markup rules: Horizontal rules. (line 6)
+* HTML entities: Special symbols. (line 6)
+* HTML export: HTML export. (line 6)
+* HTML export, CSS: CSS support. (line 6)
+* HTML, and Orgtbl mode: Translator functions.
+ (line 6)
+* hyperlinks: Hyperlinks. (line 6)
+* hyperlinks, adding new types: Adding hyperlink types.
+ (line 6)
+* iCalendar export: iCalendar export. (line 6)
+* idle, resolve, dangling: Resolving idle time. (line 6)
+* images, inline in DocBook: Images in DocBook export.
+ (line 6)
+* images, inline in HTML: Images in HTML export.
+ (line 6)
+* images, inline in LaTeX: Images in LaTeX export.
+ (line 6)
+* images, inlining: Handling links. (line 134)
+* imenu.el: Cooperation. (line 33)
+* in-buffer settings: In-buffer settings. (line 6)
+* inactive timestamp: Timestamps. (line 49)
+* include files, markup rules: Include files. (line 6)
+* indent, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 86)
+* index entries, for publishing: Index entries. (line 6)
+* index, in a publishing project: Generating an index. (line 6)
+* Info links: External links. (line 6)
+* inheritance, of properties: Property inheritance.
+ (line 6)
+* inheritance, of tags: Tag inheritance. (line 6)
+* inlined images, markup rules: Images and tables. (line 18)
+* inlineimages, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 101)
+* inlineimages, STARTUP keyword: Handling links. (line 134)
+* inlining images: Handling links. (line 134)
+* inlining images in DocBook: Images in DocBook export.
+ (line 6)
+* inlining images in HTML: Images in HTML export.
+ (line 6)
+* inlining images in LaTeX: Images in LaTeX export.
+ (line 6)
+* inserting links: Handling links. (line 66)
+* insertion, of templates: Easy Templates. (line 6)
+* installation: Installation. (line 6)
+* internal links: Internal links. (line 6)
+* internal links, in HTML export: Links in HTML export.
+ (line 6)
+* introduction: Introduction. (line 6)
+* iPhone: MobileOrg. (line 6)
+* IRC links: External links. (line 6)
+* italic text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace.
+ (line 6)
+* jumping, to headlines: Motion. (line 6)
+* key bindings, global: Activation. (line 6)
+* keyword options: Per-file keywords. (line 6)
+* LaTeX class: Header and sectioning.
+ (line 6)
+* LaTeX entities: Special symbols. (line 6)
+* LaTeX export: LaTeX and PDF export.
+ (line 6)
+* LaTeX fragments <1>: Export options. (line 39)
+* LaTeX fragments: LaTeX fragments. (line 6)
+* LaTeX fragments, markup rules: Special symbols. (line 6)
+* LaTeX fragments, preview: Previewing LaTeX fragments.
+ (line 6)
+* LaTeX header: Header and sectioning.
+ (line 6)
+* LaTeX interpretation: Embedded LaTeX. (line 6)
+* LaTeX sectioning structure: Header and sectioning.
+ (line 6)
+* LaTeX, and Orgtbl mode: A LaTeX example. (line 6)
+* Latin-1 export: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 6)
+* level, require for tags/property match: Matching tags and properties.
+ (line 59)
+* line-break preservation: Export options. (line 39)
+* link abbreviations: Link abbreviations. (line 6)
+* link abbreviations, completion of: Completion. (line 6)
+* link completion: Handling links. (line 66)
+* link format: Link format. (line 6)
+* links, external: External links. (line 6)
+* links, finding next/previous: Handling links. (line 154)
+* links, handling: Handling links. (line 6)
+* links, in HTML export: Links in HTML export.
+ (line 6)
+* links, internal: Internal links. (line 6)
+* links, publishing: Publishing links. (line 6)
+* links, radio targets: Radio targets. (line 6)
+* links, returning to: Handling links. (line 147)
+* Lisp forms, as table formulas: Formula syntax for Lisp.
+ (line 6)
+* lists, in other modes: Tables in arbitrary syntax.
+ (line 6)
+* lists, markup rules: Lists. (line 6)
+* lists, ordered: Plain lists. (line 6)
+* lists, plain: Plain lists. (line 6)
+* literal examples, markup rules: Literal examples. (line 6)
+* logdone, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 107)
+* logging, of progress: Progress logging. (line 6)
+* lognoteclock-out, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 107)
+* lognotedone, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 107)
+* lognoteredeadline, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 107)
+* lognoterefile, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 107)
+* lognoterepeat, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 107)
+* lognotereschedule, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 107)
+* logredeadline, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 107)
+* logrefile, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 107)
+* logrepeat, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 107)
+* logreschedule, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 107)
+* Ludlam, Eric M.: Cooperation. (line 45)
+* macro replacement, during export: Macro replacement. (line 6)
+* maintainer: Feedback. (line 6)
+* mapping entries, API: Using the mapping API.
+ (line 6)
+* mark ring: Handling links. (line 143)
+* marking characters, tables: Advanced features. (line 38)
+* match view: Matching tags and properties.
+ (line 6)
+* matching, of properties: Matching tags and properties.
+ (line 6)
+* matching, of tags: Matching tags and properties.
+ (line 6)
+* matching, tags: Tags. (line 6)
+* math symbols: Special symbols. (line 6)
+* MathJax: Math formatting in HTML export.
+ (line 6)
+* MH-E links: External links. (line 6)
+* mind map: Freemind export. (line 6)
+* minor mode for structure editing: Orgstruct mode. (line 6)
+* minor mode for tables: Orgtbl mode. (line 6)
+* MobileOrg: MobileOrg. (line 6)
+* mode, for calc: Formula syntax for Calc.
+ (line 14)
+* motion commands in agenda: Agenda commands. (line 19)
+* motion, between headlines: Motion. (line 6)
+* name, of column or field: References. (line 120)
+* named references: References. (line 99)
+* names as TODO keywords: TODO types. (line 6)
+* narrow columns in tables: Column width and alignment.
+ (line 6)
+* noalign, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 94)
+* nofnadjust, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 145)
+* nofninline, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 145)
+* nohideblocks, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 156)
+* nohideblocks, STARTUP keyword: Blocks. (line 13)
+* noindent, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 86)
+* noinlineimages, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 101)
+* noinlineimages, STARTUP keyword: Handling links. (line 134)
+* nologdone, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 107)
+* nolognoteclock-out, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 107)
+* nologredeadline, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 107)
+* nologrefile, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 107)
+* nologrepeat, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 107)
+* nologreschedule, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 107)
+* occur, command: Sparse trees. (line 6)
+* odd, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 128)
+* odd-levels-only outlines: Clean view. (line 6)
+* option keyword completion: Completion. (line 6)
+* options, for custom agenda views: Setting Options. (line 6)
+* options, for customization: Customization. (line 6)
+* options, for export: Export options. (line 6)
+* options, for publishing: Publishing options. (line 6)
+* ordered lists: Plain lists. (line 6)
+* org-agenda, command: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 9)
+* org-hide-block-startup: In-buffer settings. (line 155)
+* org-list-insert-radio-list: Radio lists. (line 6)
+* Org-mode, turning on: Activation. (line 23)
+* org-pretty-entities: In-buffer settings. (line 159)
+* org-publish-project-alist: Project alist. (line 6)
+* Orgstruct mode: Orgstruct mode. (line 6)
+* Orgtbl mode <1>: Orgtbl mode. (line 6)
+* Orgtbl mode: Tables in arbitrary syntax.
+ (line 6)
+* Ota, Takaaki: Cooperation. (line 52)
+* Outline mode: Outlines. (line 6)
+* outline tree: Headlines. (line 6)
+* outlines: Outlines. (line 6)
+* overview, global visibility state: Visibility cycling. (line 22)
+* overview, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 80)
+* overview, STARTUP keyword: Visibility cycling. (line 55)
+* packages, interaction with other: Interaction. (line 6)
+* paragraphs, markup rules: Paragraphs. (line 6)
+* pasting, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6)
+* PDF export <1>: DocBook export. (line 6)
+* PDF export: LaTeX and PDF export.
+ (line 6)
+* per-file keywords: Per-file keywords. (line 6)
+* plain lists: Plain lists. (line 6)
+* plain text external links: External links. (line 57)
+* plot tables using Gnuplot: Org-Plot. (line 6)
+* presentation, of agenda items: Presentation and sorting.
+ (line 6)
+* printing sparse trees: Sparse trees. (line 47)
+* priorities: Priorities. (line 6)
+* priorities, of agenda items: Sorting of agenda items.
+ (line 6)
+* progress logging: Progress logging. (line 6)
+* Project management: TaskJuggler export. (line 6)
+* projects, for publishing: Project alist. (line 6)
+* promotion, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6)
+* properties: Properties and Columns.
+ (line 6)
+* properties, API <1>: Property API. (line 6)
+* properties, API: Using the property API.
+ (line 6)
+* properties, column view: Defining columns. (line 6)
+* properties, inheritance: Property inheritance.
+ (line 6)
+* properties, searching: Property searches. (line 6)
+* properties, special: Special properties. (line 6)
+* property EXPORT_FILE_NAME <1>: DocBook export commands.
+ (line 7)
+* property EXPORT_FILE_NAME: LaTeX/PDF export commands.
+ (line 7)
+* property syntax: Property syntax. (line 6)
+* property, _ALL: Property syntax. (line 37)
+* property, ARCHIVE <1>: Moving subtrees. (line 29)
+* property, ARCHIVE: Property inheritance.
+ (line 34)
+* property, ATTACH_DIR: Attachments. (line 71)
+* property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT: Attachments. (line 76)
+* property, CATEGORY <1>: Categories. (line 12)
+* property, CATEGORY: Property inheritance.
+ (line 30)
+* property, COLUMNS <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 30)
+* property, COLUMNS: Property inheritance.
+ (line 22)
+* property, COOKIE_DATA <1>: Breaking down tasks. (line 21)
+* property, COOKIE_DATA: Checkboxes. (line 30)
+* property, CUSTOM_ID <1>: Handling links. (line 21)
+* property, CUSTOM_ID: Internal links. (line 6)
+* property, DESCRIPTION: iCalendar export. (line 46)
+* property, Effort: Effort estimates. (line 6)
+* property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME <1>: HTML Export commands.
+ (line 7)
+* property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 12)
+* property, EXPORT_TITLE: Document title. (line 15)
+* property, ID <1>: Handling links. (line 21)
+* property, ID <2>: Capturing column view.
+ (line 22)
+* property, ID: iCalendar export. (line 21)
+* property, LATEX_CLASS: Header and sectioning.
+ (line 8)
+* property, LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: Header and sectioning.
+ (line 8)
+* property, LOCATION: iCalendar export. (line 46)
+* property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER: Tracking TODO state changes.
+ (line 6)
+* property, LOGGING <1>: Property inheritance.
+ (line 38)
+* property, LOGGING: Tracking TODO state changes.
+ (line 42)
+* property, ORDERED <1>: TODO dependencies. (line 30)
+* property, ORDERED <2>: Checkboxes. (line 46)
+* property, ORDERED: TODO dependencies. (line 6)
+* property, special, ALLTAGS: Special properties. (line 13)
+* property, special, BLOCKED: Special properties. (line 13)
+* property, special, CATEGORY: Special properties. (line 13)
+* property, special, CLOCKSUM <1>: Special properties. (line 13)
+* property, special, CLOCKSUM: Agenda column view. (line 28)
+* property, special, CLOSED: Special properties. (line 13)
+* property, special, DEADLINE: Special properties. (line 13)
+* property, special, ITEM: Special properties. (line 13)
+* property, special, PRIORITY: Special properties. (line 13)
+* property, special, SCHEDULED: Special properties. (line 13)
+* property, special, TAGS: Special properties. (line 13)
+* property, special, TIMESTAMP: Special properties. (line 13)
+* property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA: Special properties. (line 13)
+* property, special, TODO: Special properties. (line 13)
+* property, SUMMARY: iCalendar export. (line 46)
+* property, VISIBILITY: Visibility cycling. (line 65)
+* property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL: Clocking commands. (line 16)
+* property: LAST_REPEAT: Clocking commands. (line 16)
+* protocols, for external access: Protocols. (line 6)
+* publishing: Publishing. (line 6)
+* query editing, in agenda: Agenda commands. (line 179)
+* quoted HTML tags: Export options. (line 39)
+* radio lists: Radio lists. (line 6)
+* radio tables: Radio tables. (line 6)
+* radio targets: Radio targets. (line 6)
+* range references: References. (line 62)
+* ranges, time: Timestamps. (line 6)
+* recomputing table fields: Updating the table. (line 6)
+* references: References. (line 6)
+* references, named: References. (line 99)
+* references, remote: References. (line 120)
+* references, to a different table: References. (line 120)
+* references, to fields: References. (line 15)
+* references, to ranges: References. (line 62)
+* refiling notes: Refiling notes. (line 6)
+* region, active <1>: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 11)
+* region, active <2>: HTML Export commands.
+ (line 6)
+* region, active <3>: LaTeX/PDF export commands.
+ (line 6)
+* region, active <4>: DocBook export commands.
+ (line 6)
+* region, active <5>: Structure editing. (line 124)
+* region, active: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 156)
+* regular expressions, with tags search: Matching tags and properties.
+ (line 55)
+* relative timer: Relative timer. (line 6)
+* remember.el: Cooperation. (line 42)
+* remote editing, bulk, from agenda: Agenda commands. (line 388)
+* remote editing, from agenda: Agenda commands. (line 258)
+* remote editing, undo: Agenda commands. (line 259)
+* remote references: References. (line 120)
+* repeated tasks: Repeated tasks. (line 6)
+* report, of clocked time: The clock table. (line 6)
+* resolve idle time: Resolving idle time. (line 6)
+* RMAIL links: External links. (line 6)
+* Rose, Sebastian: JavaScript support. (line 6)
+* row, of field coordinates: References. (line 84)
+* RSS feeds: RSS Feeds. (line 6)
+* rsync: Uploading files. (line 6)
+* SCHEDULED keyword: Deadlines and scheduling.
+ (line 27)
+* scheduling: Timestamps. (line 6)
+* Schulte, Eric: Working With Source Code.
+ (line 6)
+* Scripts, for agenda processing: Extracting agenda information.
+ (line 6)
+* search option in file links: Search options. (line 6)
+* search strings, custom: Custom searches. (line 6)
+* search view: Search view. (line 6)
+* searching for tags: Tag searches. (line 6)
+* searching, for text: Search view. (line 6)
+* searching, of properties: Property searches. (line 6)
+* section-numbers: Export options. (line 39)
+* sectioning structure, for LaTeX export: Header and sectioning.
+ (line 6)
+* setting tags: Setting tags. (line 6)
+* SHELL links: External links. (line 6)
+* shift-selection-mode <1>: Plain lists. (line 101)
+* shift-selection-mode: Conflicts. (line 6)
+* show all, command: Visibility cycling. (line 33)
+* show all, global visibility state: Visibility cycling. (line 22)
+* show hidden text: Visibility cycling. (line 6)
+* showall, STARTUP keyword <1>: Visibility cycling. (line 55)
+* showall, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 80)
+* showeverything, STARTUP keyword <1>: Visibility cycling. (line 55)
+* showeverything, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 80)
+* showstars, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 128)
+* sitemap, of published pages: Sitemap. (line 6)
+* sorting, of agenda items: Sorting of agenda items.
+ (line 6)
+* sorting, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6)
+* source code, batch execution: Batch execution. (line 6)
+* source code, block header arguments: Header arguments. (line 6)
+* source code, block structure: Structure of code blocks.
+ (line 6)
+* source code, editing: Editing source code. (line 6)
+* source code, evaluating: Evaluating code blocks.
+ (line 6)
+* source code, exporting: Exporting code blocks.
+ (line 6)
+* source code, extracting: Extracting source code.
+ (line 6)
+* source code, languages: Languages. (line 6)
+* source code, library: Library of Babel. (line 6)
+* source code, noweb reference: Noweb reference syntax.
+ (line 6)
+* source code, results of evaluation: Results of evaluation.
+ (line 6)
+* source code, working with: Working With Source Code.
+ (line 6)
+* sparse tree, for deadlines: Inserting deadline/schedule.
+ (line 31)
+* sparse tree, for TODO: TODO basics. (line 36)
+* sparse tree, tag based: Tags. (line 6)
+* sparse trees: Sparse trees. (line 6)
+* Special characters in DocBook export: Special characters. (line 6)
+* special keywords: In-buffer settings. (line 6)
+* special strings: Export options. (line 39)
+* special symbols: Special symbols. (line 6)
+* speed keys: Speed keys. (line 6)
+* speedbar.el: Cooperation. (line 45)
+* spreadsheet capabilities: The spreadsheet. (line 6)
+* square brackets, around links: External links. (line 57)
+* statistics, for checkboxes: Checkboxes. (line 30)
+* statistics, for TODO items: Breaking down tasks. (line 6)
+* storing links: Handling links. (line 10)
+* Storm, Kim. F.: Conflicts. (line 19)
+* strike-through text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace.
+ (line 6)
+* structure editing: Structure editing. (line 6)
+* structure of document: Document Structure. (line 6)
+* sublevels, inclusion into tags match: Tag inheritance. (line 6)
+* sublevels, inclusion into TODO list: Global TODO list. (line 35)
+* subscript: Subscripts and superscripts.
+ (line 6)
+* subtree cycling: Visibility cycling. (line 10)
+* subtree visibility states: Visibility cycling. (line 10)
+* subtree, cut and paste: Structure editing. (line 6)
+* subtree, subtree visibility state: Visibility cycling. (line 10)
+* subtrees, cut and paste: Structure editing. (line 6)
+* summary: Summary. (line 6)
+* superscript: Subscripts and superscripts.
+ (line 6)
+* syntax, noweb: Noweb reference syntax.
+ (line 6)
+* syntax, of formulas: Formula syntax for Calc.
+ (line 6)
+* table editor, built-in: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 6)
+* table editor, table.el: Cooperation. (line 52)
+* table of contents: Export options. (line 39)
+* table of contents, markup rules: Table of contents. (line 6)
+* table.el: Cooperation. (line 49)
+* tables <1>: Tables. (line 6)
+* tables: Export options. (line 39)
+* tables, in DocBook export: Tables in DocBook export.
+ (line 6)
+* tables, in HTML: Tables in HTML export.
+ (line 6)
+* tables, in LaTeX export: Tables in LaTeX export.
+ (line 6)
+* tables, in other modes: Tables in arbitrary syntax.
+ (line 6)
+* tables, markup rules: Images and tables. (line 6)
+* tag completion: Completion. (line 6)
+* tag filtering, in agenda: Agenda commands. (line 179)
+* tag inheritance: Tag inheritance. (line 6)
+* tag searches: Tag searches. (line 6)
+* tags: Tags. (line 6)
+* tags view: Matching tags and properties.
+ (line 6)
+* tags, setting: Setting tags. (line 6)
+* targets, for links: Internal links. (line 6)
+* targets, radio: Radio targets. (line 6)
+* TaskJuggler export: TaskJuggler export. (line 6)
+* tasks, breaking down: Breaking down tasks. (line 6)
+* tasks, repeated: Repeated tasks. (line 6)
+* template insertion: Easy Templates. (line 6)
+* templates, for Capture: Capture templates. (line 6)
+* TeX interpretation: Embedded LaTeX. (line 6)
+* TeX macros <1>: Special symbols. (line 6)
+* TeX macros: Export options. (line 39)
+* TeX symbol completion: Completion. (line 6)
+* TeX-like syntax for sub- and superscripts: Export options. (line 39)
+* text areas, in HTML: Text areas in HTML export.
+ (line 6)
+* text before first headline, markup rules: Initial text. (line 6)
+* text search: Search view. (line 6)
+* thanks: History and Acknowledgments.
+ (line 6)
+* time clocking: Clocking work time. (line 6)
+* time format, custom: Custom time format. (line 6)
+* time grid: Time-of-day specifications.
+ (line 26)
+* time info, in export: Export options. (line 39)
+* time, reading in minibuffer: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 6)
+* time-of-day specification: Time-of-day specifications.
+ (line 6)
+* time-sorted view: Timeline. (line 6)
+* timeline, single file: Timeline. (line 6)
+* timerange: Timestamps. (line 40)
+* times: Dates and Times. (line 6)
+* timestamp <1>: Timestamps. (line 14)
+* timestamp: Dates and Times. (line 6)
+* timestamp, inactive: Timestamps. (line 49)
+* timestamp, with repeater interval: Timestamps. (line 24)
+* timestamps: Timestamps. (line 6)
+* timestamps, creating: Creating timestamps. (line 6)
+* TODO dependencies: TODO dependencies. (line 6)
+* TODO items: TODO Items. (line 6)
+* TODO keyword matching: Global TODO list. (line 18)
+* TODO keyword matching, with tags search: Matching tags and properties.
+ (line 59)
+* TODO keyword sets: Multiple sets in one file.
+ (line 6)
+* TODO keywords completion: Completion. (line 6)
+* TODO list, global: Global TODO list. (line 6)
+* TODO types: TODO types. (line 6)
+* TODO workflow: Workflow states. (line 6)
+* transient mark mode <1>: Structure editing. (line 124)
+* transient mark mode: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 156)
+* transient-mark-mode <1>: HTML Export commands.
+ (line 6)
+* transient-mark-mode <2>: LaTeX/PDF export commands.
+ (line 6)
+* transient-mark-mode <3>: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 11)
+* transient-mark-mode: DocBook export commands.
+ (line 6)
+* translator function: Translator functions.
+ (line 6)
+* trees, sparse: Sparse trees. (line 6)
+* trees, visibility: Visibility cycling. (line 6)
+* tty key bindings: TTY keys. (line 6)
+* types as TODO keywords: TODO types. (line 6)
+* underlined text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace.
+ (line 6)
+* undoing remote-editing events: Agenda commands. (line 259)
+* unison: Uploading files. (line 6)
+* updating, table: Updating the table. (line 6)
+* URL links: External links. (line 6)
+* USENET links: External links. (line 6)
+* UTF-8 export: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 6)
+* variables, for customization: Customization. (line 6)
+* vectors, in table calculations: Formula syntax for Calc.
+ (line 11)
+* verbatim text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace.
+ (line 6)
+* viper.el: Conflicts. (line 62)
+* visibility cycling: Visibility cycling. (line 6)
+* visibility cycling, drawers: Drawers. (line 6)
+* visible text, printing: Sparse trees. (line 47)
+* VM links: External links. (line 6)
+* WANDERLUST links: External links. (line 6)
+* weekly agenda: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 6)
+* Wiegley, John: Cooperation. (line 42)
+* windmove.el: Conflicts. (line 49)
+* workflow states as TODO keywords: Workflow states. (line 6)
+* XEmacs: Installation. (line 6)
+* XOXO export: XOXO export. (line 6)
+* yasnippet.el: Conflicts. (line 39)
+
+
+File: org, Node: Key Index, Next: Command and Function Index, Prev: Main Index, Up: Top
+
+Key index
+*********
+
+
+* Menu:
+
+* $: Agenda commands. (line 293)
+* ': CDLaTeX mode. (line 42)
+* +: Agenda commands. (line 315)
+* ,: Agenda commands. (line 307)
+* ,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine: Agenda commands. (line 238)
+* -: Agenda commands. (line 320)
+* .: Agenda commands. (line 90)
+* /: Agenda commands. (line 179)
+* :: Agenda commands. (line 303)
+* ;: Countdown timer. (line 6)
+* < <1>: Agenda files. (line 56)
+* < <2>: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 76)
+* <: Using column view. (line 70)
+* <RET> <1>: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 76)
+* <RET> <2>: Agenda commands. (line 37)
+* <RET> <3>: Setting tags. (line 115)
+* <RET> <4>: Handling links. (line 118)
+* <RET>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 65)
+* <SPC> <1>: Agenda commands. (line 28)
+* <SPC>: Setting tags. (line 112)
+* <TAB> <1>: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 56)
+* <TAB> <2>: Visibility cycling. (line 10)
+* <TAB> <3>: Structure editing. (line 32)
+* <TAB> <4>: Plain lists. (line 91)
+* <TAB> <5>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 58)
+* <TAB> <6>: CDLaTeX mode. (line 22)
+* <TAB> <7>: Agenda commands. (line 34)
+* <TAB>: Setting tags. (line 107)
+* > <1>: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 76)
+* > <2>: Using column view. (line 70)
+* > <3>: Agenda commands. (line 365)
+* >: Agenda files. (line 60)
+* ?: Pulling from MobileOrg.
+ (line 33)
+* [: Agenda commands. (line 245)
+* ]: Agenda commands. (line 245)
+* ^: CDLaTeX mode. (line 32)
+* _: CDLaTeX mode. (line 32)
+* `: CDLaTeX mode. (line 38)
+* a <1>: Agenda commands. (line 281)
+* a: Using column view. (line 59)
+* b: Agenda commands. (line 87)
+* B: Agenda commands. (line 396)
+* c: Agenda commands. (line 422)
+* C: Agenda commands. (line 455)
+* c: Agenda commands. (line 423)
+* C-#: Advanced features. (line 9)
+* C-': Agenda files. (line 22)
+* C-,: Agenda files. (line 22)
+* C-0 C-c C-w: Refiling notes. (line 40)
+* C-<RET>: Structure editing. (line 18)
+* C-_: Agenda commands. (line 259)
+* C-c !: Creating timestamps. (line 15)
+* C-c #: Checkboxes. (line 83)
+* C-c $: Moving subtrees. (line 9)
+* C-c %: Handling links. (line 140)
+* C-c &: Handling links. (line 144)
+* C-c ' <1>: Literal examples. (line 65)
+* C-c ' <2>: Editing source code. (line 6)
+* C-c ' <3>: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 36)
+* C-c ' <4>: Include files. (line 22)
+* C-c ': Cooperation. (line 61)
+* C-c * <1>: Plain lists. (line 146)
+* C-c * <2>: Structure editing. (line 113)
+* C-c *: Updating the table. (line 13)
+* C-c +: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 156)
+* C-c ,: Priorities. (line 24)
+* C-c ,org-match-sparse-tree <1>: Property searches. (line 9)
+* C-c ,org-match-sparse-tree: Tag searches. (line 9)
+* C-c - <1>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 101)
+* C-c -: Plain lists. (line 135)
+* C-c .: Creating timestamps. (line 10)
+* C-c / <1>: Sparse trees. (line 15)
+* C-c /: Conflicts. (line 62)
+* C-c / a: Inserting deadline/schedule.
+ (line 38)
+* C-c / b: Inserting deadline/schedule.
+ (line 35)
+* C-c / d: Inserting deadline/schedule.
+ (line 28)
+* C-c / m <1>: Property searches. (line 9)
+* C-c / m: Tag searches. (line 9)
+* C-c / p: Property searches. (line 28)
+* C-c / r: Sparse trees. (line 17)
+* C-c / t: TODO basics. (line 33)
+* C-c ;: Comment lines. (line 12)
+* C-c <: Creating timestamps. (line 26)
+* C-c <RET>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 105)
+* C-c = <1>: Column formulas. (line 27)
+* C-c =: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 13)
+* C-c >: Creating timestamps. (line 30)
+* C-c ?: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 22)
+* C-c [: Agenda files. (line 15)
+* C-c ]: Agenda files. (line 19)
+* C-c ^ <1>: Plain lists. (line 156)
+* C-c ^ <2>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 109)
+* C-c ^: Structure editing. (line 94)
+* C-c `: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 174)
+* C-c a !: Stuck projects. (line 14)
+* C-c a #: Stuck projects. (line 13)
+* C-c a ?: Pulling from MobileOrg.
+ (line 43)
+* C-c a a: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 9)
+* C-c a C: Storing searches. (line 9)
+* C-c a e: Exporting Agenda Views.
+ (line 65)
+* C-c a L: Timeline. (line 10)
+* C-c a m: Property searches. (line 11)
+* C-c a M: Tag searches. (line 16)
+* C-c a m: Tag searches. (line 12)
+* C-c a M: Property searches. (line 15)
+* C-c a m: Matching tags and properties.
+ (line 12)
+* C-c a M: Matching tags and properties.
+ (line 17)
+* C-c a s: Search view. (line 9)
+* C-c a t <1>: TODO basics. (line 44)
+* C-c a t: Global TODO list. (line 9)
+* C-c a T: Global TODO list. (line 15)
+* C-c c: Using capture. (line 6)
+* C-c c C: Capture templates. (line 10)
+* C-c C-a <1>: Attachments. (line 26)
+* C-c C-a: Agenda commands. (line 328)
+* C-c C-a a: Attachments. (line 31)
+* C-c C-a c: Attachments. (line 37)
+* C-c C-a d: Attachments. (line 63)
+* C-c C-a D: Attachments. (line 66)
+* C-c C-a F: Attachments. (line 60)
+* C-c C-a f: Attachments. (line 57)
+* C-c C-a i: Attachments. (line 75)
+* C-c C-a l: Attachments. (line 37)
+* C-c C-a m: Attachments. (line 37)
+* C-c C-a n: Attachments. (line 41)
+* C-c C-a o: Attachments. (line 48)
+* C-c C-a O: Attachments. (line 54)
+* C-c C-a s: Attachments. (line 70)
+* C-c C-a z: Attachments. (line 44)
+* C-c C-b <1>: Motion. (line 15)
+* C-c C-b: Beamer class export. (line 83)
+* C-c C-c <1>: Previewing LaTeX fragments.
+ (line 15)
+* C-c C-c <2>: Clocking commands. (line 41)
+* C-c C-c <3>: The clock table. (line 15)
+* C-c C-c <4>: Clocking commands. (line 41)
+* C-c C-c <5>: Using capture. (line 15)
+* C-c C-c <6>: Cooperation. (line 52)
+* C-c C-c <7>: The very busy C-c C-c key.
+ (line 6)
+* C-c C-c <8>: Plain lists. (line 129)
+* C-c C-c <9>: Footnotes. (line 87)
+* C-c C-c <10>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 57)
+* C-c C-c <11>: Capturing column view.
+ (line 51)
+* C-c C-c <12>: Using column view. (line 52)
+* C-c C-c <13>: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 91)
+* C-c C-c <14>: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 11)
+* C-c C-c <15>: Property syntax. (line 57)
+* C-c C-c <16>: Evaluating code blocks.
+ (line 13)
+* C-c C-c <17>: Checkboxes. (line 52)
+* C-c C-c: Setting tags. (line 18)
+* C-c C-c c: Property syntax. (line 75)
+* C-c C-c d: Property syntax. (line 69)
+* C-c C-c D: Property syntax. (line 72)
+* C-c C-c s: Property syntax. (line 61)
+* C-c C-d <1>: Inserting deadline/schedule.
+ (line 9)
+* C-c C-d: Agenda commands. (line 335)
+* C-c C-e: The export dispatcher.
+ (line 12)
+* C-c C-e A: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 18)
+* C-c C-e a: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 11)
+* C-c C-e b: HTML Export commands.
+ (line 13)
+* C-c C-e c: iCalendar export. (line 39)
+* C-c C-e D: DocBook export commands.
+ (line 6)
+* C-c C-e d: LaTeX/PDF export commands.
+ (line 31)
+* C-c C-e E: Triggering publication.
+ (line 16)
+* C-c C-e F: Triggering publication.
+ (line 13)
+* C-c C-e H: HTML Export commands.
+ (line 16)
+* C-c C-e h: HTML Export commands.
+ (line 6)
+* C-c C-e I: iCalendar export. (line 34)
+* C-c C-e i: iCalendar export. (line 32)
+* C-c C-e j: TaskJuggler export. (line 24)
+* C-c C-e J: TaskJuggler export. (line 27)
+* C-c C-e l: LaTeX/PDF export commands.
+ (line 6)
+* C-c C-e L: LaTeX/PDF export commands.
+ (line 13)
+* C-c C-e m: Freemind export. (line 8)
+* C-c C-e N: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 24)
+* C-c C-e n: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 21)
+* C-c C-e P: Triggering publication.
+ (line 10)
+* C-c C-e p: LaTeX/PDF export commands.
+ (line 28)
+* C-c C-e R: HTML Export commands.
+ (line 19)
+* C-c C-e t: Export options. (line 16)
+* C-c C-e U: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 28)
+* C-c C-e u: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 25)
+* C-c C-e V: DocBook export commands.
+ (line 13)
+* C-c C-e v <1>: The export dispatcher.
+ (line 17)
+* C-c C-e v: Sparse trees. (line 47)
+* C-c C-e v D: DocBook export commands.
+ (line 32)
+* C-c C-e v x: XOXO export. (line 11)
+* C-c C-e X: Triggering publication.
+ (line 8)
+* C-c C-e x: XOXO export. (line 10)
+* C-c C-f: Motion. (line 12)
+* C-c C-j: Motion. (line 21)
+* C-c C-k <1>: Visibility cycling. (line 43)
+* C-c C-k: Using capture. (line 31)
+* C-c C-l: Handling links. (line 65)
+* C-c C-n: Motion. (line 8)
+* C-c C-o <1>: Handling links. (line 101)
+* C-c C-o <2>: Agenda commands. (line 56)
+* C-c C-o <3>: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 11)
+* C-c C-o <4>: Footnotes. (line 91)
+* C-c C-o: Creating timestamps. (line 35)
+* C-c C-p: Motion. (line 9)
+* C-c C-q <1>: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 49)
+* C-c C-q: Setting tags. (line 10)
+* C-c C-r <1>: Visibility cycling. (line 34)
+* C-c C-r: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 52)
+* C-c C-s <1>: Inserting deadline/schedule.
+ (line 14)
+* C-c C-s: Agenda commands. (line 331)
+* C-c C-t <1>: TODO basics. (line 13)
+* C-c C-t: Clocking commands. (line 46)
+* C-c C-u: Motion. (line 18)
+* C-c C-v a: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 18)
+* C-c C-v b: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 18)
+* C-c C-v C-a: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 18)
+* C-c C-v C-b: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 18)
+* C-c C-v C-f: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 20)
+* C-c C-v C-l: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 25)
+* C-c C-v C-p: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 26)
+* C-c C-v C-s: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 28)
+* C-c C-v C-t: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 30)
+* C-c C-v C-z: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 32)
+* C-c C-v f: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 20)
+* C-c C-v g: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 22)
+* C-c C-v h: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 24)
+* C-c C-v i: Library of Babel. (line 16)
+* C-c C-v l: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 25)
+* C-c C-v p: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 26)
+* C-c C-v s: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 28)
+* C-c C-v t <1>: Extracting source code.
+ (line 26)
+* C-c C-v t: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 30)
+* C-c C-v z: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 32)
+* C-c C-w <1>: Structure editing. (line 90)
+* C-c C-w <2>: Agenda commands. (line 278)
+* C-c C-w <3>: Refiling notes. (line 11)
+* C-c C-w: Using capture. (line 22)
+* C-c C-x ,: Relative timer. (line 21)
+* C-c C-x -: Relative timer. (line 13)
+* C-c C-x .: Relative timer. (line 10)
+* C-c C-x 0: Relative timer. (line 30)
+* C-c C-x ;: Countdown timer. (line 6)
+* C-c C-x <: Agenda files. (line 42)
+* C-c C-x > <1>: Agenda commands. (line 172)
+* C-c C-x >: Agenda files. (line 49)
+* C-c C-x \ <1>: Subscripts and superscripts.
+ (line 27)
+* C-c C-x \: Special symbols. (line 31)
+* C-c C-x A <1>: Internal archiving. (line 49)
+* C-c C-x A: Agenda commands. (line 289)
+* C-c C-x a <1>: Agenda commands. (line 286)
+* C-c C-x a: Internal archiving. (line 36)
+* C-c C-x b <1>: Visibility cycling. (line 47)
+* C-c C-x b: Agenda commands. (line 47)
+* C-c C-x c: Structure editing. (line 82)
+* C-c C-x C-a <1>: Agenda commands. (line 281)
+* C-c C-x C-a: Archiving. (line 11)
+* C-c C-x C-b: Checkboxes. (line 55)
+* C-c C-x C-c <1>: Using column view. (line 9)
+* C-c C-x C-c <2>: Agenda column view. (line 11)
+* C-c C-x C-c: Agenda commands. (line 161)
+* C-c C-x C-d: Clocking commands. (line 59)
+* C-c C-x C-e <1>: Clocking commands. (line 38)
+* C-c C-x C-e: Effort estimates. (line 17)
+* C-c C-x C-i: Clocking commands. (line 6)
+* C-c C-x C-j: Clocking commands. (line 54)
+* C-c C-x C-k: Inserting deadline/schedule.
+ (line 22)
+* C-c C-x C-l: Previewing LaTeX fragments.
+ (line 9)
+* C-c C-x C-n: Handling links. (line 150)
+* C-c C-x C-o: Clocking commands. (line 30)
+* C-c C-x C-p: Handling links. (line 150)
+* C-c C-x C-r: The clock table. (line 10)
+* C-c C-x C-s <1>: Agenda commands. (line 293)
+* C-c C-x C-s: Moving subtrees. (line 9)
+* C-c C-x C-t: Custom time format. (line 12)
+* C-c C-x C-u <1>: Capturing column view.
+ (line 51)
+* C-c C-x C-u <2>: Dynamic blocks. (line 21)
+* C-c C-x C-u: The clock table. (line 15)
+* C-c C-x C-v: Handling links. (line 131)
+* C-c C-x C-w <1>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 130)
+* C-c C-x C-w: Structure editing. (line 56)
+* C-c C-x C-x: Clocking commands. (line 50)
+* C-c C-x C-y <1>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 134)
+* C-c C-x C-y: Structure editing. (line 64)
+* C-c C-x e: Effort estimates. (line 14)
+* C-c C-x f: Footnotes. (line 51)
+* C-c C-x G: RSS Feeds. (line 27)
+* C-c C-x g: RSS Feeds. (line 23)
+* C-c C-x i: Capturing column view.
+ (line 49)
+* C-c C-x M-w <1>: Structure editing. (line 60)
+* C-c C-x M-w: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 126)
+* C-c C-x o <1>: Checkboxes. (line 75)
+* C-c C-x o: TODO dependencies. (line 29)
+* C-c C-x p <1>: Header arguments in Org-mode properties.
+ (line 23)
+* C-c C-x p: Property syntax. (line 48)
+* C-c C-y <1>: Creating timestamps. (line 56)
+* C-c C-y: Clocking commands. (line 41)
+* C-c C-z <1>: Agenda commands. (line 323)
+* C-c C-z: Drawers. (line 28)
+* C-c l <1>: Handling links. (line 9)
+* C-c l: Literal examples. (line 73)
+* C-c { <1>: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 32)
+* C-c {: CDLaTeX mode. (line 20)
+* C-c |: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 41)
+* C-c }: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 80)
+* C-c ~: Cooperation. (line 63)
+* C-k: Agenda commands. (line 272)
+* C-S-<left> <1>: Multiple sets in one file.
+ (line 25)
+* C-S-<left>: Agenda commands. (line 270)
+* C-S-<RET>: Structure editing. (line 27)
+* C-S-<right> <1>: Agenda commands. (line 267)
+* C-S-<right>: Multiple sets in one file.
+ (line 25)
+* C-TAB: Internal archiving. (line 46)
+* C-u C-c !: Creating timestamps. (line 19)
+* C-u C-c *: Updating the table. (line 16)
+* C-u C-c .: Creating timestamps. (line 19)
+* C-u C-c = <1>: Field formulas. (line 26)
+* C-u C-c =: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 13)
+* C-u C-c c: Using capture. (line 43)
+* C-u C-c C-c: Updating the table. (line 19)
+* C-u C-c C-l: Handling links. (line 86)
+* C-u C-c C-t: TODO basics. (line 22)
+* C-u C-c C-w: Refiling notes. (line 28)
+* C-u C-c C-x ,: Relative timer. (line 25)
+* C-u C-c C-x a: Internal archiving. (line 39)
+* C-u C-c C-x C-s: Moving subtrees. (line 11)
+* C-u C-c C-x C-u <1>: Capturing column view.
+ (line 55)
+* C-u C-c C-x C-u <2>: Dynamic blocks. (line 22)
+* C-u C-c C-x C-u: The clock table. (line 19)
+* C-u C-u <TAB>: Visibility cycling. (line 68)
+* C-u C-u C-c *: Updating the table. (line 22)
+* C-u C-u C-c =: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 16)
+* C-u C-u C-c c: Using capture. (line 45)
+* C-u C-u C-c C-c: Updating the table. (line 22)
+* C-u C-u C-c C-e: The export dispatcher.
+ (line 21)
+* C-u C-u C-c C-t: Multiple sets in one file.
+ (line 25)
+* C-u C-u C-c C-w: Refiling notes. (line 31)
+* C-u C-u C-u <TAB>: Visibility cycling. (line 33)
+* C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t: TODO dependencies. (line 34)
+* C-up: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 12)
+* C-v: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 76)
+* C-x C-s <1>: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 46)
+* C-x C-s: Agenda commands. (line 157)
+* C-x C-w <1>: Exporting Agenda Views.
+ (line 12)
+* C-x C-w: Agenda commands. (line 472)
+* C-x n s: Structure editing. (line 107)
+* C-x n w: Structure editing. (line 110)
+* C-y: Structure editing. (line 70)
+* d: Agenda commands. (line 65)
+* D: Agenda commands. (line 99)
+* e: Using column view. (line 46)
+* E: Agenda commands. (line 135)
+* F: Agenda commands. (line 40)
+* f: Agenda commands. (line 81)
+* g <1>: Using column view. (line 23)
+* g: Agenda commands. (line 154)
+* G: Agenda commands. (line 143)
+* H: Agenda commands. (line 459)
+* i: Agenda commands. (line 427)
+* I: Agenda commands. (line 370)
+* J: Agenda commands. (line 96)
+* j: Agenda commands. (line 93)
+* J: Agenda commands. (line 380)
+* k: Agenda commands. (line 338)
+* k a: Inserting deadline/schedule.
+ (line 25)
+* k s: Inserting deadline/schedule.
+ (line 25)
+* l: Agenda commands. (line 103)
+* L: Agenda commands. (line 31)
+* m: Agenda commands. (line 388)
+* M: Agenda commands. (line 446)
+* M-<down> <1>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 90)
+* M-<down>: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 76)
+* M-<left> <1>: Plain lists. (line 110)
+* M-<left> <2>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 82)
+* M-<left>: Structure editing. (line 38)
+* M-<RET> <1>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 141)
+* M-<RET> <2>: Plain lists. (line 74)
+* M-<RET> <3>: Structure editing. (line 6)
+* M-<RET>: Relative timer. (line 17)
+* M-<right> <1>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 82)
+* M-<right> <2>: Structure editing. (line 41)
+* M-<right>: Plain lists. (line 110)
+* M-<TAB> <1>: Per-file keywords. (line 24)
+* M-<TAB> <2>: Property syntax. (line 45)
+* M-<TAB> <3>: Completion. (line 16)
+* M-<TAB> <4>: Setting tags. (line 6)
+* M-<TAB>: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 63)
+* M-<up> <1>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 90)
+* M-<up>: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 76)
+* M-a: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 70)
+* M-down: Key bindings and useful functions.
+ (line 13)
+* M-e: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 74)
+* M-S-<down> <1>: Structure editing. (line 53)
+* M-S-<down> <2>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 97)
+* M-S-<down> <3>: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 71)
+* M-S-<down>: Plain lists. (line 104)
+* M-S-<left> <1>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 84)
+* M-S-<left> <2>: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 76)
+* M-S-<left> <3>: Structure editing. (line 44)
+* M-S-<left>: Plain lists. (line 115)
+* M-S-<RET> <1>: Structure editing. (line 23)
+* M-S-<RET> <2>: Checkboxes. (line 72)
+* M-S-<RET>: Plain lists. (line 88)
+* M-S-<right> <1>: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 76)
+* M-S-<right> <2>: Structure editing. (line 47)
+* M-S-<right> <3>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 87)
+* M-S-<right>: Plain lists. (line 115)
+* M-S-<up> <1>: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 71)
+* M-S-<up> <2>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 94)
+* M-S-<up> <3>: Plain lists. (line 104)
+* M-S-<up>: Structure editing. (line 50)
+* M-v: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 76)
+* M-x org-iswitchb: Agenda files. (line 26)
+* mouse-1 <1>: Footnotes. (line 91)
+* mouse-1 <2>: Handling links. (line 122)
+* mouse-1: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 76)
+* mouse-2 <1>: Agenda commands. (line 34)
+* mouse-2 <2>: Footnotes. (line 91)
+* mouse-2: Handling links. (line 122)
+* mouse-3 <1>: Handling links. (line 127)
+* mouse-3: Agenda commands. (line 28)
+* n <1>: Using column view. (line 42)
+* n: Agenda commands. (line 19)
+* o: Agenda commands. (line 64)
+* O: Agenda commands. (line 374)
+* p <1>: Using column view. (line 42)
+* p: Agenda commands. (line 20)
+* P: Agenda commands. (line 312)
+* q <1>: Using column view. (line 26)
+* q: Agenda commands. (line 485)
+* r <1>: Agenda commands. (line 147)
+* r <2>: Global TODO list. (line 23)
+* r: Using column view. (line 19)
+* R: Agenda commands. (line 125)
+* S: Agenda commands. (line 450)
+* s: Agenda commands. (line 157)
+* S-<down> <1>: Priorities. (line 29)
+* S-<down> <2>: Agenda commands. (line 320)
+* S-<down> <3>: Creating timestamps. (line 44)
+* S-<down> <4>: Plain lists. (line 97)
+* S-<down> <5>: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 66)
+* S-<down>: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 76)
+* S-<left> <1>: Creating timestamps. (line 39)
+* S-<left> <2>: Plain lists. (line 151)
+* S-<left> <3>: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 76)
+* S-<left> <4>: Using column view. (line 35)
+* S-<left> <5>: The clock table. (line 23)
+* S-<left> <6>: TODO basics. (line 28)
+* S-<left> <7>: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 66)
+* S-<left> <8>: Multiple sets in one file.
+ (line 32)
+* S-<left> <9>: Agenda commands. (line 361)
+* S-<left>: Property syntax. (line 65)
+* S-<RET>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 159)
+* S-<right> <1>: Using column view. (line 35)
+* S-<right> <2>: Multiple sets in one file.
+ (line 32)
+* S-<right> <3>: Creating timestamps. (line 39)
+* S-<right> <4>: TODO basics. (line 28)
+* S-<right> <5>: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 76)
+* S-<right> <6>: Plain lists. (line 151)
+* S-<right> <7>: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 66)
+* S-<right> <8>: Agenda commands. (line 350)
+* S-<right> <9>: The clock table. (line 23)
+* S-<right>: Property syntax. (line 65)
+* S-<TAB> <1>: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 62)
+* S-<TAB>: Visibility cycling. (line 22)
+* S-<up> <1>: Priorities. (line 29)
+* S-<up> <2>: Creating timestamps. (line 44)
+* S-<up> <3>: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 76)
+* S-<up> <4>: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 66)
+* S-<up>: Agenda commands. (line 315)
+* S-M-<left>: Using column view. (line 75)
+* S-M-<RET>: TODO basics. (line 52)
+* S-M-<right>: Using column view. (line 72)
+* t: Agenda commands. (line 263)
+* T: Agenda commands. (line 298)
+* U: Agenda commands. (line 393)
+* u: Agenda commands. (line 390)
+* v: Using column view. (line 55)
+* v [: Agenda commands. (line 114)
+* v a: Agenda commands. (line 118)
+* v A: Agenda commands. (line 121)
+* v d: Agenda commands. (line 65)
+* v E: Agenda commands. (line 135)
+* v L: Agenda commands. (line 106)
+* v l: Agenda commands. (line 103)
+* v m: Agenda commands. (line 69)
+* v R: Agenda commands. (line 125)
+* v w: Agenda commands. (line 68)
+* v y: Agenda commands. (line 70)
+* w: Agenda commands. (line 68)
+* x: Agenda commands. (line 486)
+* X: Agenda commands. (line 377)
+* z: Agenda commands. (line 323)
+* {: Agenda commands. (line 245)
+* }: Agenda commands. (line 245)
+
+
+File: org, Node: Command and Function Index, Next: Variable Index, Prev: Key Index, Up: Top
+
+Command and function index
+**************************
+
+
+* Menu:
+
+* <1>: Agenda commands. (line 238)
+* <2>: Tag searches. (line 9)
+* : Property searches. (line 9)
+* lisp-complete-symbol: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 63)
+* org-aganda-day-view: Agenda commands. (line 65)
+* org-agenda-action: Agenda commands. (line 338)
+* org-agenda-add-note: Agenda commands. (line 323)
+* org-agenda-archive: Agenda commands. (line 293)
+* org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation: Agenda commands.
+ (line 281)
+* org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling: Agenda commands. (line 289)
+* org-agenda-archives-mode: Agenda commands. (line 118)
+* org-agenda-archives-mode 'files: Agenda commands. (line 121)
+* org-agenda-bulk-action: Agenda commands. (line 396)
+* org-agenda-bulk-mark: Agenda commands. (line 388)
+* org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks: Agenda commands. (line 393)
+* org-agenda-bulk-unmark: Agenda commands. (line 390)
+* org-agenda-clock-cancel: Agenda commands. (line 377)
+* org-agenda-clock-goto: Agenda commands. (line 96)
+* org-agenda-clock-in: Agenda commands. (line 370)
+* org-agenda-clock-out: Agenda commands. (line 374)
+* org-agenda-clockreport-mode: Agenda commands. (line 125)
+* org-agenda-columns <1>: Agenda commands. (line 161)
+* org-agenda-columns: Agenda column view. (line 11)
+* org-agenda-convert-date: Agenda commands. (line 455)
+* org-agenda-date-prompt: Agenda commands. (line 365)
+* org-agenda-deadline: Agenda commands. (line 335)
+* org-agenda-diary-entry: Agenda commands. (line 427)
+* org-agenda-do-date-earlier: Agenda commands. (line 361)
+* org-agenda-do-date-later: Agenda commands. (line 350)
+* org-agenda-earlier: Agenda commands. (line 87)
+* org-agenda-entry-text-mode: Agenda commands. (line 135)
+* org-agenda-exit: Agenda commands. (line 486)
+* org-agenda-filter-by-tag: Agenda commands. (line 179)
+* org-agenda-follow-mode: Agenda commands. (line 40)
+* org-agenda-goto: Agenda commands. (line 34)
+* org-agenda-goto-calendar: Agenda commands. (line 422)
+* org-agenda-goto-date: Agenda commands. (line 93)
+* org-agenda-goto-today: Agenda commands. (line 90)
+* org-agenda-holidays: Agenda commands. (line 459)
+* org-agenda-kill: Agenda commands. (line 272)
+* org-agenda-later: Agenda commands. (line 81)
+* org-agenda-list: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 9)
+* org-agenda-list-stuck-projects: Stuck projects. (line 13)
+* org-agenda-log-mode: Agenda commands. (line 103)
+* org-agenda-manipulate-query-add: Agenda commands. (line 114)
+* org-agenda-month-view: Agenda commands. (line 69)
+* org-agenda-month-year: Agenda commands. (line 70)
+* org-agenda-next-line: Agenda commands. (line 19)
+* org-agenda-open-link: Agenda commands. (line 56)
+* org-agenda-phases-of-moon: Agenda commands. (line 446)
+* org-agenda-previous-line: Agenda commands. (line 20)
+* org-agenda-priority-down: Agenda commands. (line 320)
+* org-agenda-priority-up: Agenda commands. (line 315)
+* org-agenda-quit: Agenda commands. (line 485)
+* org-agenda-recenter: Agenda commands. (line 31)
+* org-agenda-refile: Agenda commands. (line 278)
+* org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock <1>: Agenda files. (line 60)
+* org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock: Agenda commands. (line 172)
+* org-agenda-rodo: Agenda commands. (line 154)
+* org-agenda-schedule: Agenda commands. (line 331)
+* org-agenda-set-restriction-lock: Agenda files. (line 42)
+* org-agenda-set-tags: Agenda commands. (line 303)
+* org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up: Agenda commands. (line 28)
+* org-agenda-show-priority: Agenda commands. (line 312)
+* org-agenda-show-tags: Agenda commands. (line 298)
+* org-agenda-sunrise-sunset: Agenda commands. (line 450)
+* org-agenda-switch-to: Agenda commands. (line 37)
+* org-agenda-to-front: Agenda files. (line 15)
+* org-agenda-todo: Agenda commands. (line 263)
+* org-agenda-todo-nextset: Agenda commands. (line 267)
+* org-agenda-todo-previousset: Agenda commands. (line 270)
+* org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag: Agenda commands. (line 286)
+* org-agenda-toggle-diary: Agenda commands. (line 99)
+* org-agenda-toggle-time-grid: Agenda commands. (line 143)
+* org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer: Agenda commands. (line 47)
+* org-agenda-undo: Agenda commands. (line 259)
+* org-archive-subtree: Moving subtrees. (line 9)
+* org-archive-subtree-default: Archiving. (line 11)
+* org-archive-to-archive-sibling: Internal archiving. (line 49)
+* org-attach <1>: Attachments. (line 26)
+* org-attach: Agenda commands. (line 328)
+* org-attach-attach: Attachments. (line 31)
+* org-attach-delete-all: Attachments. (line 66)
+* org-attach-delete-one: Attachments. (line 63)
+* org-attach-new: Attachments. (line 41)
+* org-attach-open: Attachments. (line 48)
+* org-attach-open-in-emacs: Attachments. (line 54)
+* org-attach-reveal: Attachments. (line 57)
+* org-attach-reveal-in-emacs: Attachments. (line 60)
+* org-attach-set-directory: Attachments. (line 70)
+* org-attach-set-inherit: Attachments. (line 75)
+* org-attach-sync: Attachments. (line 44)
+* org-backward-same-level: Motion. (line 15)
+* org-beamer-select-environment: Beamer class export. (line 83)
+* org-buffer-property-keys: Using the property API.
+ (line 35)
+* org-calendar-goto-agenda: Agenda commands. (line 423)
+* org-capture: Using capture. (line 6)
+* org-capture-finalize: Using capture. (line 15)
+* org-capture-kill: Using capture. (line 31)
+* org-capture-refile: Using capture. (line 22)
+* org-check-after-date: Inserting deadline/schedule.
+ (line 38)
+* org-check-before-date: Inserting deadline/schedule.
+ (line 35)
+* org-check-deadlines: Inserting deadline/schedule.
+ (line 28)
+* org-clock-cancel: Clocking commands. (line 50)
+* org-clock-display: Clocking commands. (line 59)
+* org-clock-goto: Clocking commands. (line 54)
+* org-clock-in: Clocking commands. (line 6)
+* org-clock-modify-effort-estimate <1>: Effort estimates. (line 17)
+* org-clock-modify-effort-estimate: Clocking commands. (line 38)
+* org-clock-out: Clocking commands. (line 30)
+* org-clock-report: The clock table. (line 10)
+* org-clocktable-try-shift: The clock table. (line 23)
+* org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift: Structure editing. (line 82)
+* org-columns: Using column view. (line 9)
+* org-columns-delete: Using column view. (line 75)
+* org-columns-edit-allowed: Using column view. (line 59)
+* org-columns-edit-value: Using column view. (line 46)
+* org-columns-narrow: Using column view. (line 70)
+* org-columns-new: Using column view. (line 72)
+* org-columns-next-allowed-value: Using column view. (line 42)
+* org-columns-previous-allowed-value: Using column view. (line 42)
+* org-columns-quit: Using column view. (line 26)
+* org-columns-redo: Using column view. (line 19)
+* org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle: Using column view. (line 52)
+* org-columns-show-value: Using column view. (line 55)
+* org-columns-widen: Using column view. (line 70)
+* org-complete: Property syntax. (line 45)
+* org-compute-property-at-point: Property syntax. (line 75)
+* org-copy-subtree: Structure editing. (line 60)
+* org-cut-subtree: Structure editing. (line 56)
+* org-cycle <1>: Visibility cycling. (line 10)
+* org-cycle <2>: Structure editing. (line 32)
+* org-cycle: Plain lists. (line 91)
+* org-cycle-agenda-files: Agenda files. (line 22)
+* org-date-from-calendar: Creating timestamps. (line 26)
+* org-dblock-update <1>: The clock table. (line 15)
+* org-dblock-update <2>: Dynamic blocks. (line 21)
+* org-dblock-update: Capturing column view.
+ (line 51)
+* org-deadline: Inserting deadline/schedule.
+ (line 9)
+* org-delete-property: Property syntax. (line 69)
+* org-delete-property-globally: Property syntax. (line 72)
+* org-demote: Using the mapping API.
+ (line 82)
+* org-demote-subtree: Structure editing. (line 47)
+* org-do-demote: Structure editing. (line 41)
+* org-do-promote: Structure editing. (line 38)
+* org-edit-special: Cooperation. (line 61)
+* org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property: Using the property API.
+ (line 51)
+* org-entry-delete: Using the property API.
+ (line 29)
+* org-entry-get: Using the property API.
+ (line 20)
+* org-entry-get-multivalued-property: Using the property API.
+ (line 47)
+* org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property: Using the property API.
+ (line 61)
+* org-entry-properties: Using the property API.
+ (line 10)
+* org-entry-put: Using the property API.
+ (line 32)
+* org-entry-put-multivalued-property: Using the property API.
+ (line 42)
+* org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property: Using the property API.
+ (line 56)
+* org-evaluate-time-range <1>: Creating timestamps. (line 56)
+* org-evaluate-time-range: Clocking commands. (line 41)
+* org-export: The export dispatcher.
+ (line 21)
+* org-export-as-ascii: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 11)
+* org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 18)
+* org-export-as-docbook: DocBook export commands.
+ (line 6)
+* org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open: DocBook export commands.
+ (line 13)
+* org-export-as-freemind: Freemind export. (line 8)
+* org-export-as-html: HTML Export commands.
+ (line 6)
+* org-export-as-html-and-open: HTML Export commands.
+ (line 13)
+* org-export-as-html-to-buffer: HTML Export commands.
+ (line 16)
+* org-export-as-latex: LaTeX/PDF export commands.
+ (line 6)
+* org-export-as-latex-to-buffer: LaTeX/PDF export commands.
+ (line 13)
+* org-export-as-latin1: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 21)
+* org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 24)
+* org-export-as-pdf: LaTeX/PDF export commands.
+ (line 28)
+* org-export-as-pdf-and-open: LaTeX/PDF export commands.
+ (line 31)
+* org-export-as-taskjuggler: TaskJuggler export. (line 24)
+* org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open: TaskJuggler export. (line 27)
+* org-export-as-utf8: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 25)
+* org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 28)
+* org-export-as-xoxo: XOXO export. (line 10)
+* org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files: iCalendar export. (line 34)
+* org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files: iCalendar export.
+ (line 39)
+* org-export-icalendar-this-file: iCalendar export. (line 32)
+* org-export-region-as-html: HTML Export commands.
+ (line 19)
+* org-export-visible: The export dispatcher.
+ (line 17)
+* org-feed-goto-inbox: RSS Feeds. (line 27)
+* org-feed-update-all: RSS Feeds. (line 23)
+* org-force-cycle-archived: Internal archiving. (line 46)
+* org-forward-same-level: Motion. (line 12)
+* org-global-cycle: Visibility cycling. (line 22)
+* org-goto: Motion. (line 21)
+* org-goto-calendar: Creating timestamps. (line 30)
+* org-insert-columns-dblock: Capturing column view.
+ (line 49)
+* org-insert-export-options-template: Export options. (line 16)
+* org-insert-heading <1>: Structure editing. (line 6)
+* org-insert-heading <2>: Relative timer. (line 17)
+* org-insert-heading: Plain lists. (line 74)
+* org-insert-heading-respect-content: Structure editing. (line 18)
+* org-insert-link: Handling links. (line 65)
+* org-insert-property-drawer <1>: Property syntax. (line 55)
+* org-insert-property-drawer: Using the property API.
+ (line 38)
+* org-insert-todo-heading <1>: Structure editing. (line 23)
+* org-insert-todo-heading <2>: Checkboxes. (line 72)
+* org-insert-todo-heading: TODO basics. (line 52)
+* org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content: Structure editing. (line 27)
+* org-map-entries: Using the mapping API.
+ (line 13)
+* org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action: Inserting deadline/schedule.
+ (line 22)
+* org-mark-ring-goto: Handling links. (line 144)
+* org-mark-ring-push: Handling links. (line 140)
+* org-move-subtree-down: Structure editing. (line 53)
+* org-move-subtree-up: Structure editing. (line 50)
+* org-narrow-to-subtree: Structure editing. (line 107)
+* org-next-link: Handling links. (line 150)
+* org-occur: Sparse trees. (line 17)
+* org-open-at-point <1>: Handling links. (line 101)
+* org-open-at-point: Creating timestamps. (line 35)
+* org-paste-subtree: Structure editing. (line 64)
+* org-previous-link: Handling links. (line 150)
+* org-priority <1>: Using the mapping API.
+ (line 70)
+* org-priority: Priorities. (line 24)
+* org-priority-down: Priorities. (line 29)
+* org-priority-up: Priorities. (line 29)
+* org-promote: Using the mapping API.
+ (line 79)
+* org-promote-subtree: Structure editing. (line 44)
+* org-property-action: Property syntax. (line 57)
+* org-property-next-allowed-value: Property syntax. (line 65)
+* org-property-previous-allowed-value: Property syntax. (line 65)
+* org-publish: Triggering publication.
+ (line 8)
+* org-publish-all: Triggering publication.
+ (line 16)
+* org-publish-current-file: Triggering publication.
+ (line 13)
+* org-publish-current-project: Triggering publication.
+ (line 10)
+* org-refile <1>: Structure editing. (line 90)
+* org-refile: Refiling notes. (line 11)
+* org-refile-cache-clear: Refiling notes. (line 40)
+* org-refile-goto-last-stored: Refiling notes. (line 31)
+* org-remove-file: Agenda files. (line 19)
+* org-reveal: Visibility cycling. (line 34)
+* org-save-all-org-buffers: Agenda commands. (line 157)
+* org-schedule: Inserting deadline/schedule.
+ (line 14)
+* org-search-view: Search view. (line 9)
+* org-set-effort: Effort estimates. (line 14)
+* org-set-property: Property syntax. (line 61)
+* org-set-startup-visibility: Visibility cycling. (line 68)
+* org-set-tags-command: Setting tags. (line 18)
+* org-show-todo-key: TODO basics. (line 33)
+* org-sort-entries-or-items: Structure editing. (line 94)
+* org-sparse-tree: Sparse trees. (line 15)
+* org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction: Agenda files. (line 56)
+* org-store-agenda-views: Exporting Agenda Views.
+ (line 65)
+* org-store-link: Handling links. (line 9)
+* org-table-align: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 57)
+* org-table-beginning-of-field: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 70)
+* org-table-copy-down: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 159)
+* org-table-copy-region: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 126)
+* org-table-create-or-convert-from-region: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 187)
+* org-table-create-with-table.el: Cooperation. (line 63)
+* org-table-cut-region: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 130)
+* org-table-delete-column: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 84)
+* org-table-edit-field: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 174)
+* org-table-edit-formulas: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 36)
+* org-table-end-of-field: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 74)
+* org-table-eval-formula <1>: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 13)
+* org-table-eval-formula <2>: Field formulas. (line 26)
+* org-table-eval-formula: Column formulas. (line 27)
+* org-table-export: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 195)
+* org-table-fedit-abort: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 49)
+* org-table-fedit-finish: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 46)
+* org-table-fedit-line-down: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 71)
+* org-table-fedit-line-up: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 71)
+* org-table-fedit-lisp-indent: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 56)
+* org-table-fedit-ref-down: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 66)
+* org-table-fedit-ref-left: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 66)
+* org-table-fedit-ref-right: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 66)
+* org-table-fedit-ref-up: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 66)
+* org-table-fedit-scroll-down: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 76)
+* org-table-fedit-scroll-up: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 76)
+* org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 52)
+* org-table-field-info: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 22)
+* org-table-hline-and-move: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 105)
+* org-table-insert-column: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 87)
+* org-table-insert-hline: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 101)
+* org-table-insert-row: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 97)
+* org-table-iterate: Updating the table. (line 22)
+* org-table-iterate-buffer-tables: Updating the table. (line 33)
+* org-table-kill-row: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 94)
+* org-table-move-column-left: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 82)
+* org-table-move-column-right: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 82)
+* org-table-move-row-down: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 90)
+* org-table-move-row-up: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 90)
+* org-table-next-field: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 58)
+* org-table-next-row: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 65)
+* org-table-paste-rectangle: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 134)
+* org-table-previous-field: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 62)
+* org-table-recalculate: Updating the table. (line 13)
+* org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables: Updating the table. (line 30)
+* org-table-rotate-recalc-marks: Advanced features. (line 9)
+* org-table-sort-lines: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 109)
+* org-table-sum: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 156)
+* org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 80)
+* org-table-toggle-formula-debugger: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 32)
+* org-table-wrap-region: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 141)
+* org-tags-view <1>: Matching tags and properties.
+ (line 17)
+* org-tags-view <2>: Tag searches. (line 16)
+* org-tags-view: Property searches. (line 15)
+* org-time-stamp: Creating timestamps. (line 10)
+* org-time-stamp-inactive: Creating timestamps. (line 15)
+* org-timeline: Timeline. (line 10)
+* org-timer: Relative timer. (line 10)
+* org-timer-item: Relative timer. (line 13)
+* org-timer-start: Relative timer. (line 30)
+* org-timestamp-down-day: Creating timestamps. (line 39)
+* org-timestamp-down-down: Creating timestamps. (line 44)
+* org-timestamp-up: Creating timestamps. (line 44)
+* org-timestamp-up-day: Creating timestamps. (line 39)
+* org-todo <1>: Clocking commands. (line 46)
+* org-todo <2>: TODO basics. (line 13)
+* org-todo: Using the mapping API.
+ (line 66)
+* org-todo-list <1>: Global TODO list. (line 9)
+* org-todo-list: TODO basics. (line 44)
+* org-toggle-archive-tag: Internal archiving. (line 36)
+* org-toggle-checkbox: Checkboxes. (line 55)
+* org-toggle-heading: Structure editing. (line 113)
+* org-toggle-inline-images: Handling links. (line 131)
+* org-toggle-ordered-property <1>: Checkboxes. (line 75)
+* org-toggle-ordered-property: TODO dependencies. (line 29)
+* org-toggle-tag: Using the mapping API.
+ (line 74)
+* org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays: Custom time format. (line 12)
+* org-tree-to-indirect-buffer: Visibility cycling. (line 47)
+* org-update-all-dblocks: Capturing column view.
+ (line 55)
+* org-update-statistics-cookies: Checkboxes. (line 83)
+* org-write-agenda <1>: Agenda commands. (line 472)
+* org-write-agenda: Exporting Agenda Views.
+ (line 12)
+* org-yank: Structure editing. (line 70)
+* outline-next-visible-heading: Motion. (line 8)
+* outline-previous-visible-heading: Motion. (line 9)
+* outline-up-heading: Motion. (line 18)
+* show-all: Visibility cycling. (line 33)
+* show-branches: Visibility cycling. (line 43)
+* widen: Structure editing. (line 110)
+
+
+File: org, Node: Variable Index, Prev: Command and Function Index, Up: Top
+
+Variable index
+**************
+
+This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that
+are mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use `M-x
+org-customize <RET>' and then click yourself through the tree.
+
+
+* Menu:
+
+* cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts: CDLaTeX mode. (line 32)
+* constants-unit-system <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 139)
+* constants-unit-system: References. (line 106)
+* htmlize-output-type: Exporting Agenda Views.
+ (line 21)
+* LaTeX-verbatim-environments: A LaTeX example. (line 21)
+* org-adapt-indentation: Clean view. (line 46)
+* org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines: Exporting Agenda Views.
+ (line 21)
+* org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum: Effort estimates.
+ (line 41)
+* org-agenda-confirm-kill: Agenda commands. (line 275)
+* org-agenda-custom-commands <1>: Sparse trees. (line 31)
+* org-agenda-custom-commands <2>: Extracting agenda information.
+ (line 6)
+* org-agenda-custom-commands <3>: Setting Options. (line 6)
+* org-agenda-custom-commands: Storing searches. (line 9)
+* org-agenda-diary-file: Agenda commands. (line 430)
+* org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks: TODO dependencies. (line 39)
+* org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines: Agenda commands. (line 138)
+* org-agenda-exporter-settings <1>: Agenda commands. (line 473)
+* org-agenda-exporter-settings: Exporting Agenda Views.
+ (line 13)
+* org-agenda-files <1>: iCalendar export. (line 37)
+* org-agenda-files <2>: Sorting of agenda items.
+ (line 8)
+* org-agenda-files: Agenda files. (line 6)
+* org-agenda-filter-preset: Agenda commands. (line 180)
+* org-agenda-log-mode-items: Agenda commands. (line 106)
+* org-agenda-ndays: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 15)
+* org-agenda-overriding-header: Special agenda views.
+ (line 40)
+* org-agenda-prefix-format: Presentation and sorting.
+ (line 6)
+* org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit: Agenda Views. (line 40)
+* org-agenda-show-inherited-tags: Agenda commands. (line 301)
+* org-agenda-skip-archived-trees: Internal archiving. (line 21)
+* org-agenda-skip-function <1>: Using the mapping API.
+ (line 51)
+* org-agenda-skip-function: Special agenda views.
+ (line 43)
+* org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done: Deadlines and scheduling.
+ (line 30)
+* org-agenda-sorting-strategy: Sorting of agenda items.
+ (line 27)
+* org-agenda-span: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 15)
+* org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode: Agenda commands. (line 128)
+* org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode: Agenda commands. (line 138)
+* org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode: Agenda commands. (line 43)
+* org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options: Matching tags and properties.
+ (line 20)
+* org-agenda-text-search-extra-files <1>: Agenda dispatcher. (line 31)
+* org-agenda-text-search-extra-files: Search view. (line 24)
+* org-agenda-time-grid <1>: Agenda commands. (line 146)
+* org-agenda-time-grid: Time-of-day specifications.
+ (line 41)
+* org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines: Global TODO list. (line 38)
+* org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled: Global TODO list. (line 38)
+* org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp: Global TODO list. (line 38)
+* org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date: Global TODO list. (line 38)
+* org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels <1>: Global TODO list. (line 47)
+* org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels: Breaking down tasks. (line 6)
+* org-agenda-use-time-grid <1>: Time-of-day specifications.
+ (line 41)
+* org-agenda-use-time-grid: Agenda commands. (line 146)
+* org-agenda-window-setup: Agenda Views. (line 40)
+* org-archive-default-command <1>: Agenda commands. (line 284)
+* org-archive-default-command: Archiving. (line 12)
+* org-archive-location <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 16)
+* org-archive-location: Moving subtrees. (line 10)
+* org-archive-save-context-info: Moving subtrees. (line 33)
+* org-attach-directory: Attachments. (line 6)
+* org-attach-method: Attachments. (line 32)
+* org-babel-default-header-args <1>: System-wide header arguments.
+ (line 6)
+* org-babel-default-header-args: Header arguments in Org-mode properties.
+ (line 23)
+* org-calc-default-modes: Formula syntax for Calc.
+ (line 14)
+* org-clock-idle-time: Resolving idle time. (line 11)
+* org-clock-into-drawer: Clocking commands. (line 7)
+* org-clock-modeline-total: Clocking commands. (line 16)
+* org-clocktable-defaults: The clock table. (line 37)
+* org-coderef-label-format: Literal examples. (line 57)
+* org-columns-default-format <1>: Agenda commands. (line 164)
+* org-columns-default-format <2>: Agenda column view. (line 18)
+* org-columns-default-format <3>: Effort estimates. (line 31)
+* org-columns-default-format: Using column view. (line 10)
+* org-columns-skip-archived-trees: Internal archiving. (line 31)
+* org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file: iCalendar export. (line 42)
+* org-confirm-babel-evaluate: Code evaluation security.
+ (line 34)
+* org-confirm-elisp-link-function: Code evaluation security.
+ (line 45)
+* org-confirm-shell-link-function: Code evaluation security.
+ (line 42)
+* org-create-file-search-functions: Custom searches. (line 12)
+* org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook: Context-sensitive commands.
+ (line 6)
+* org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree: Headlines. (line 6)
+* org-cycle-emulate-tab: Visibility cycling. (line 16)
+* org-cycle-global-at-bob: Visibility cycling. (line 16)
+* org-cycle-include-plain-lists: Plain lists. (line 67)
+* org-cycle-open-archived-trees: Internal archiving. (line 11)
+* org-cycle-separator-lines: Headlines. (line 22)
+* org-deadline-warning-days <1>: Deadlines and scheduling.
+ (line 12)
+* org-deadline-warning-days: Inserting deadline/schedule.
+ (line 31)
+* org-default-notes-file <1>: Setting up capture. (line 9)
+* org-default-notes-file: Template elements. (line 48)
+* org-default-priority <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 54)
+* org-default-priority: Priorities. (line 38)
+* org-display-custom-times <1>: Custom time format. (line 6)
+* org-display-custom-times: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer: Handling links.
+ (line 130)
+* org-disputed-keys: Conflicts. (line 34)
+* org-done (face): Faces for TODO keywords.
+ (line 6)
+* org-drawers <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 45)
+* org-drawers: Drawers. (line 6)
+* org-effort-property: Effort estimates. (line 6)
+* org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists: Plain lists. (line 29)
+* org-enable-table-editor: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 30)
+* org-enforce-todo-dependencies: TODO dependencies. (line 6)
+* org-entities <1>: Special characters. (line 6)
+* org-entities: Special symbols. (line 15)
+* org-execute-file-search-functions: Custom searches. (line 12)
+* org-export-ascii-links-to-notes: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export.
+ (line 50)
+* org-export-author-info: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-creator-info: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-default-language <1>: Export options. (line 19)
+* org-export-default-language: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes: Images in DocBook export.
+ (line 15)
+* org-export-docbook-doctype: Special characters. (line 6)
+* org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions: Images in DocBook export.
+ (line 35)
+* org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command: DocBook export commands.
+ (line 19)
+* org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command: DocBook export commands.
+ (line 19)
+* org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet: DocBook export commands.
+ (line 25)
+* org-export-email: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-exclude-tags <1>: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-exclude-tags: Selective export. (line 6)
+* org-export-headline-levels <1>: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-headline-levels: Headings and sections.
+ (line 6)
+* org-export-highlight-first-table-line: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-html-auto-postamble: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-html-auto-preamble: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-html-expand: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-html-extension: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-html-extra: CSS support. (line 37)
+* org-export-html-inline-images <1>: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-html-inline-images: Images in HTML export.
+ (line 6)
+* org-export-html-link-home: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-html-link-up: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-html-postamble: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-html-preamble: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-html-style <1>: CSS support. (line 37)
+* org-export-html-style: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-html-style-default: CSS support. (line 37)
+* org-export-html-style-extra: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-html-style-include-default <1>: Publishing options.
+ (line 12)
+* org-export-html-style-include-default: CSS support. (line 37)
+* org-export-html-table-tag <1>: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-html-table-tag: Tables in HTML export.
+ (line 6)
+* org-export-html-tag-class-prefix: CSS support. (line 6)
+* org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix: CSS support. (line 6)
+* org-export-html-use-infojs: JavaScript support. (line 57)
+* org-export-html-with-timestamp: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-latex-classes: Header and sectioning.
+ (line 8)
+* org-export-latex-default-class: Header and sectioning.
+ (line 8)
+* org-export-latex-default-packages-alist: Header and sectioning.
+ (line 8)
+* org-export-latex-packages-alist: Header and sectioning.
+ (line 8)
+* org-export-preserve-breaks: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-publishing-directory: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-run-in-background: The export dispatcher.
+ (line 24)
+* org-export-section-number-format: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-select-tags <1>: Selective export. (line 6)
+* org-export-select-tags: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading <1>: Publishing options.
+ (line 12)
+* org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading: Initial text. (line 12)
+* org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports: TaskJuggler export. (line 119)
+* org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag: TaskJuggler export. (line 34)
+* org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag: TaskJuggler export. (line 48)
+* org-export-with-archived-trees <1>: Internal archiving. (line 27)
+* org-export-with-archived-trees: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-with-drawers: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-with-emphasize: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-with-fixed-width: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-with-footnotes: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments <1>: LaTeX fragments. (line 43)
+* org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-with-priority: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-with-section-numbers: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-with-special-strings: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-with-sub-superscripts <1>: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-with-sub-superscripts: Subscripts and superscripts.
+ (line 15)
+* org-export-with-tables: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-with-tags: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-with-TeX-macros: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-with-timestamps: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-with-toc <1>: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-export-with-toc: Table of contents. (line 6)
+* org-export-with-todo-keywords: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo: Fast access to TODO states.
+ (line 16)
+* org-fast-tag-selection-single-key: Setting tags. (line 143)
+* org-file-apps <1>: Attachments. (line 49)
+* org-file-apps: Handling links. (line 104)
+* org-footnote-auto-adjust <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 143)
+* org-footnote-auto-adjust: Footnotes. (line 58)
+* org-footnote-auto-label <1>: Footnotes. (line 44)
+* org-footnote-auto-label: In-buffer settings. (line 143)
+* org-footnote-define-inline <1>: Footnotes. (line 58)
+* org-footnote-define-inline: In-buffer settings. (line 143)
+* org-footnote-section: Footnotes. (line 58)
+* org-format-latex-header: LaTeX fragments. (line 6)
+* org-format-latex-options <1>: Previewing LaTeX fragments.
+ (line 20)
+* org-format-latex-options: LaTeX fragments. (line 39)
+* org-from-is-user-regexp: Template expansion. (line 39)
+* org-global-properties <1>: Property syntax. (line 40)
+* org-global-properties: Effort estimates. (line 31)
+* org-goto-auto-isearch: Motion. (line 26)
+* org-goto-interface: Motion. (line 37)
+* org-hide (face): Clean view. (line 66)
+* org-hide-block-startup: Blocks. (line 6)
+* org-hide-leading-stars <1>: Clean view. (line 50)
+* org-hide-leading-stars: In-buffer settings. (line 125)
+* org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics: Checkboxes. (line 30)
+* org-hierarchical-todo-statistics: Breaking down tasks. (line 25)
+* org-highest-priority <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 54)
+* org-highest-priority: Priorities. (line 38)
+* org-icalendar-alarm-time: iCalendar export. (line 6)
+* org-icalendar-categories: iCalendar export. (line 6)
+* org-icalendar-include-body: iCalendar export. (line 46)
+* org-icalendar-include-todo: iCalendar export. (line 6)
+* org-icalendar-store-UID: iCalendar export. (line 21)
+* org-icalendar-use-deadline: iCalendar export. (line 6)
+* org-icalendar-use-scheduled: iCalendar export. (line 6)
+* org-imenu-depth: Cooperation. (line 38)
+* org-infojs-options: JavaScript support. (line 57)
+* org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file: Activation. (line 29)
+* org-irc-link-to-logs: Handling links. (line 45)
+* org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion: Handling links. (line 66)
+* org-latex-low-levels: LaTeX/PDF export commands.
+ (line 37)
+* org-link-abbrev-alist <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 49)
+* org-link-abbrev-alist: Link abbreviations. (line 12)
+* org-link-to-org-use-id: Handling links. (line 21)
+* org-list-automatic-rules <1>: Checkboxes. (line 6)
+* org-list-automatic-rules: Plain lists. (line 77)
+* org-list-demote-modify-bullet: Plain lists. (line 56)
+* org-list-end-regexp: Plain lists. (line 29)
+* org-list-ending-method: Plain lists. (line 29)
+* org-log-done <1>: Tracking TODO state changes.
+ (line 26)
+* org-log-done <2>: Agenda commands. (line 106)
+* org-log-done: In-buffer settings. (line 105)
+* org-log-into-drawer <1>: Agenda commands. (line 326)
+* org-log-into-drawer: Tracking TODO state changes.
+ (line 6)
+* org-log-note-clock-out <1>: Clocking commands. (line 33)
+* org-log-note-clock-out: In-buffer settings. (line 105)
+* org-log-refile: Refiling notes. (line 12)
+* org-log-repeat <1>: Repeated tasks. (line 32)
+* org-log-repeat: In-buffer settings. (line 105)
+* org-log-states-order-reversed: Tracking TODO state changes.
+ (line 6)
+* org-lowest-priority <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 54)
+* org-lowest-priority: Priorities. (line 38)
+* org-M-RET-may-split-line <1>: Plain lists. (line 77)
+* org-M-RET-may-split-line: Structure editing. (line 7)
+* org-odd-levels-only <1>: Matching tags and properties.
+ (line 59)
+* org-odd-levels-only <2>: Clean view. (line 74)
+* org-odd-levels-only <3>: In-buffer settings. (line 125)
+* org-odd-levels-only: Special agenda views.
+ (line 43)
+* org-outline-path-complete-in-steps: Refiling notes. (line 12)
+* org-overriding-columns-format: Agenda column view. (line 18)
+* org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator: Plain lists. (line 135)
+* org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 70)
+* org-priority-faces: Priorities. (line 13)
+* org-priority-start-cycle-with-default: Priorities. (line 33)
+* org-property-allowed-value-functions: Using the property API.
+ (line 65)
+* org-publish-project-alist <1>: Publishing options. (line 66)
+* org-publish-project-alist: Project alist. (line 6)
+* org-publish-use-timestamps-flag: Triggering publication.
+ (line 21)
+* org-put-time-stamp-overlays: In-buffer settings. (line 135)
+* org-read-date-display-live: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 84)
+* org-read-date-prefer-future: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 6)
+* org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes: Refiling notes. (line 12)
+* org-refile-targets: Refiling notes. (line 12)
+* org-refile-use-cache: Refiling notes. (line 12)
+* org-refile-use-outline-path: Refiling notes. (line 12)
+* org-remove-highlights-with-change <1>: Sparse trees. (line 20)
+* org-remove-highlights-with-change: Clocking commands. (line 62)
+* org-replace-disputed-keys: Conflicts. (line 19)
+* org-return-follows-link: Handling links. (line 121)
+* org-reverse-note-order: Refiling notes. (line 12)
+* org-show-entry-below: Sparse trees. (line 6)
+* org-show-following-heading: Sparse trees. (line 6)
+* org-show-hierarchy-above: Sparse trees. (line 6)
+* org-show-siblings: Sparse trees. (line 6)
+* org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high: Agenda commands. (line 198)
+* org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees: Internal archiving. (line 17)
+* org-special-ctrl-a/e: Headlines. (line 6)
+* org-special-ctrl-k: Headlines. (line 6)
+* org-speed-commands-user: Speed keys. (line 6)
+* org-startup-align-all-tables <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 91)
+* org-startup-align-all-tables: Column width and alignment.
+ (line 33)
+* org-startup-folded <1>: Visibility cycling. (line 55)
+* org-startup-folded: In-buffer settings. (line 80)
+* org-startup-indented: In-buffer settings. (line 86)
+* org-startup-with-inline-images <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 98)
+* org-startup-with-inline-images: Handling links. (line 134)
+* org-store-link-functions: Adding hyperlink types.
+ (line 65)
+* org-stuck-projects: Stuck projects. (line 17)
+* org-support-shift-select <1>: Plain lists. (line 101)
+* org-support-shift-select <2>: Conflicts. (line 6)
+* org-support-shift-select: Plain lists. (line 154)
+* org-table-auto-blank-field: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 30)
+* org-table-copy-increment: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 162)
+* org-table-export-default-format: Built-in table editor.
+ (line 195)
+* org-table-formula: In-buffer settings. (line 35)
+* org-table-formula-constants <1>: References. (line 99)
+* org-table-formula-constants <2>: Cooperation. (line 17)
+* org-table-formula-constants: In-buffer settings. (line 35)
+* org-table-use-standard-references: Editing and debugging formulas.
+ (line 6)
+* org-tag-alist <1>: Setting tags. (line 23)
+* org-tag-alist: In-buffer settings. (line 165)
+* org-tag-faces: Tags. (line 10)
+* org-tag-persistent-alist: Setting tags. (line 38)
+* org-tags-column: Setting tags. (line 11)
+* org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance: Tag inheritance. (line 22)
+* org-tags-match-list-sublevels <1>: Matching tags and properties.
+ (line 20)
+* org-tags-match-list-sublevels <2>: Tag inheritance. (line 26)
+* org-tags-match-list-sublevels <3>: Tag searches. (line 19)
+* org-tags-match-list-sublevels: Property searches. (line 18)
+* org-time-stamp-custom-formats: Custom time format. (line 6)
+* org-time-stamp-overlay-formats: In-buffer settings. (line 135)
+* org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes: Creating timestamps. (line 23)
+* org-todo (face): Faces for TODO keywords.
+ (line 6)
+* org-todo-keyword-faces: Faces for TODO keywords.
+ (line 6)
+* org-todo-keywords <1>: Global TODO list. (line 18)
+* org-todo-keywords <2>: In-buffer settings. (line 182)
+* org-todo-keywords <3>: TODO basics. (line 36)
+* org-todo-keywords: TODO extensions. (line 6)
+* org-todo-repeat-to-state: Repeated tasks. (line 17)
+* org-todo-state-tags-triggers: TODO basics. (line 57)
+* org-track-ordered-property-with-tag <1>: Checkboxes. (line 78)
+* org-track-ordered-property-with-tag: TODO dependencies. (line 30)
+* org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change: Structure editing.
+ (line 26)
+* org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change: TODO basics.
+ (line 29)
+* org-use-property-inheritance <1>: Property inheritance.
+ (line 6)
+* org-use-property-inheritance <2>: Using the property API.
+ (line 18)
+* org-use-property-inheritance: iCalendar export. (line 46)
+* org-use-speed-commands: Speed keys. (line 6)
+* org-use-tag-inheritance: Tag inheritance. (line 22)
+* org-yank-adjusted-subtrees: Structure editing. (line 73)
+* org-yank-folded-subtrees: Structure editing. (line 73)
+* parse-time-months: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 57)
+* parse-time-weekdays: The date/time prompt.
+ (line 57)
+* ps-landscape-mode: Exporting Agenda Views.
+ (line 21)
+* ps-number-of-columns: Exporting Agenda Views.
+ (line 21)
+* user-full-name <1>: Publishing options. (line 12)
+* user-full-name: Export options. (line 19)
+* user-mail-address <1>: Export options. (line 19)
+* user-mail-address: Publishing options. (line 12)
+
+
+
+Tag Table:
+Node: Top1274
+Node: Introduction21174
+Node: Summary21644
+Node: Installation24537
+Node: Activation26700
+Node: Feedback28438
+Ref: Feedback-Footnote-131016
+Node: Conventions31143
+Node: Document Structure32502
+Node: Outlines33426
+Node: Headlines34082
+Ref: Headlines-Footnote-135082
+Node: Visibility cycling35258
+Ref: Visibility cycling-Footnote-138300
+Ref: Visibility cycling-Footnote-238358
+Ref: Visibility cycling-Footnote-338408
+Node: Motion38678
+Node: Structure editing40015
+Ref: Structure editing-Footnote-146382
+Node: Sparse trees46482
+Ref: Sparse trees-Footnote-148787
+Ref: Sparse trees-Footnote-248993
+Ref: Sparse trees-Footnote-349064
+Node: Plain lists49179
+Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-156646
+Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-257004
+Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-357100
+Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-457189
+Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-557260
+Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-657318
+Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-757562
+Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-857738
+Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-957838
+Node: Drawers57916
+Ref: Drawers-Footnote-159132
+Node: Blocks59237
+Node: Footnotes59798
+Ref: Footnotes-Footnote-164371
+Ref: Footnotes-Footnote-264468
+Node: Orgstruct mode64545
+Node: Tables65654
+Node: Built-in table editor66295
+Node: Column width and alignment75458
+Ref: Column width and alignment-Footnote-178016
+Ref: Column width and alignment-Footnote-278062
+Node: Column groups78159
+Node: Orgtbl mode79671
+Node: The spreadsheet80470
+Node: References81770
+Ref: References-Footnote-187444
+Ref: References-Footnote-287585
+Ref: References-Footnote-387688
+Node: Formula syntax for Calc87978
+Ref: Formula syntax for Calc-Footnote-190891
+Node: Formula syntax for Lisp91215
+Node: Field formulas92938
+Node: Column formulas94401
+Node: Editing and debugging formulas96166
+Node: Updating the table100834
+Node: Advanced features102176
+Node: Org-Plot106613
+Node: Hyperlinks109474
+Node: Link format110231
+Node: Internal links111509
+Ref: Internal links-Footnote-1113322
+Ref: Internal links-Footnote-2113508
+Node: Radio targets113748
+Node: External links114438
+Node: Handling links117881
+Ref: Handling links-Footnote-1125671
+Ref: Handling links-Footnote-2125967
+Ref: Handling links-Footnote-3126213
+Ref: Handling links-Footnote-4126290
+Ref: Handling links-Footnote-5126364
+Node: Using links outside Org126446
+Node: Link abbreviations126931
+Node: Search options129229
+Ref: Search options-Footnote-1131110
+Node: Custom searches131191
+Node: TODO Items132201
+Ref: TODO Items-Footnote-1133309
+Node: TODO basics133423
+Node: TODO extensions136023
+Node: Workflow states137053
+Ref: Workflow states-Footnote-1138378
+Node: TODO types138471
+Ref: TODO types-Footnote-1140069
+Node: Multiple sets in one file140151
+Node: Fast access to TODO states142016
+Ref: Fast access to TODO states-Footnote-1142878
+Node: Per-file keywords143172
+Ref: Per-file keywords-Footnote-1144568
+Node: Faces for TODO keywords144769
+Node: TODO dependencies145813
+Node: Progress logging147986
+Node: Closing items148698
+Ref: Closing items-Footnote-1149747
+Ref: Closing items-Footnote-2149816
+Node: Tracking TODO state changes149889
+Ref: Tracking TODO state changes-Footnote-1152782
+Ref: Tracking TODO state changes-Footnote-2152839
+Node: Tracking your habits153127
+Node: Priorities157326
+Ref: Priorities-Footnote-1159331
+Node: Breaking down tasks159400
+Ref: Breaking down tasks-Footnote-1161392
+Node: Checkboxes161488
+Ref: Checkboxes-Footnote-1166006
+Ref: Checkboxes-Footnote-2166129
+Node: Tags166298
+Node: Tag inheritance167297
+Ref: Tag inheritance-Footnote-1168669
+Ref: Tag inheritance-Footnote-2168769
+Node: Setting tags168895
+Ref: Setting tags-Footnote-1175154
+Node: Tag searches175237
+Node: Properties and Columns176470
+Node: Property syntax177874
+Node: Special properties180862
+Node: Property searches182279
+Node: Property inheritance183711
+Node: Column view185527
+Node: Defining columns186761
+Node: Scope of column definitions187159
+Node: Column attributes188089
+Ref: Column attributes-Footnote-1192698
+Node: Using column view192831
+Node: Capturing column view195693
+Ref: Capturing column view-Footnote-1198685
+Node: Property API198821
+Node: Dates and Times199175
+Node: Timestamps200154
+Ref: Timestamps-Footnote-1202512
+Node: Creating timestamps202643
+Node: The date/time prompt205386
+Ref: The date/time prompt-Footnote-1209671
+Ref: The date/time prompt-Footnote-2209834
+Ref: The date/time prompt-Footnote-3209940
+Node: Custom time format210033
+Node: Deadlines and scheduling211757
+Ref: Deadlines and scheduling-Footnote-1214450
+Node: Inserting deadline/schedule214605
+Ref: Inserting deadline/schedule-Footnote-1216633
+Ref: Inserting deadline/schedule-Footnote-2216741
+Node: Repeated tasks216849
+Ref: Repeated tasks-Footnote-1220195
+Ref: Repeated tasks-Footnote-2220444
+Node: Clocking work time220643
+Ref: Clocking work time-Footnote-1221826
+Node: Clocking commands221964
+Ref: Clocking commands-Footnote-1225701
+Ref: Clocking commands-Footnote-2225808
+Ref: Clocking commands-Footnote-3225858
+Ref: Clocking commands-Footnote-4225916
+Node: The clock table225994
+Ref: The clock table-Footnote-1232157
+Node: Resolving idle time232282
+Ref: Resolving idle time-Footnote-1235536
+Node: Effort estimates235874
+Ref: Effort estimates-Footnote-1238643
+Ref: Effort estimates-Footnote-2238731
+Node: Relative timer238838
+Node: Countdown timer240685
+Node: Capture - Refile - Archive241176
+Node: Capture242157
+Node: Setting up capture243491
+Ref: Setting up capture-Footnote-1243916
+Node: Using capture243982
+Node: Capture templates246138
+Node: Template elements247766
+Node: Template expansion252767
+Ref: Template expansion-Footnote-1255818
+Ref: Template expansion-Footnote-2255905
+Ref: Template expansion-Footnote-3256087
+Node: Attachments256185
+Ref: Attachments-Footnote-1259567
+Node: RSS Feeds259717
+Node: Protocols261307
+Node: Refiling notes262021
+Ref: Refiling notes-Footnote-1264161
+Node: Archiving264257
+Node: Moving subtrees264956
+Ref: Moving subtrees-Footnote-1266667
+Node: Internal archiving267111
+Node: Agenda Views269741
+Node: Agenda files271932
+Ref: Agenda files-Footnote-1274745
+Ref: Agenda files-Footnote-2274894
+Node: Agenda dispatcher275087
+Ref: Agenda dispatcher-Footnote-1277302
+Ref: Agenda dispatcher-Footnote-2277396
+Node: Built-in agenda views277498
+Node: Weekly/daily agenda278147
+Ref: Weekly/daily agenda-Footnote-1283063
+Ref: Weekly/daily agenda-Footnote-2283290
+Node: Global TODO list283403
+Node: Matching tags and properties285931
+Node: Timeline292550
+Node: Search view293242
+Node: Stuck projects294535
+Ref: Stuck projects-Footnote-1296595
+Node: Presentation and sorting296625
+Node: Categories297418
+Ref: Categories-Footnote-1298219
+Node: Time-of-day specifications298656
+Node: Sorting of agenda items300628
+Node: Agenda commands302166
+Ref: Agenda commands-Footnote-1323930
+Ref: Agenda commands-Footnote-2324011
+Ref: Agenda commands-Footnote-3324422
+Node: Custom agenda views324505
+Node: Storing searches325146
+Ref: Storing searches-Footnote-1327680
+Node: Block agenda327797
+Node: Setting Options329035
+Node: Exporting Agenda Views331961
+Ref: Exporting Agenda Views-Footnote-1336862
+Ref: Exporting Agenda Views-Footnote-2336920
+Ref: Exporting Agenda Views-Footnote-3337076
+Ref: Exporting Agenda Views-Footnote-4337263
+Node: Agenda column view337345
+Node: Markup340027
+Node: Structural markup elements341000
+Node: Document title341733
+Node: Headings and sections342495
+Node: Table of contents343165
+Node: Initial text343928
+Node: Lists345042
+Node: Paragraphs345326
+Node: Footnote markup346476
+Node: Emphasis and monospace346831
+Node: Horizontal rules347231
+Node: Comment lines347506
+Node: Images and tables348040
+Node: Literal examples349521
+Ref: Literal examples-Footnote-1353158
+Ref: Literal examples-Footnote-2354136
+Ref: Literal examples-Footnote-3354315
+Ref: Literal examples-Footnote-4354552
+Node: Include files354646
+Node: Index entries355687
+Node: Macro replacement356149
+Node: Embedded LaTeX356979
+Ref: Embedded LaTeX-Footnote-1357921
+Node: Special symbols358111
+Ref: Special symbols-Footnote-1359723
+Node: Subscripts and superscripts359878
+Node: LaTeX fragments361132
+Ref: LaTeX fragments-Footnote-1363772
+Ref: LaTeX fragments-Footnote-2363945
+Ref: LaTeX fragments-Footnote-3364250
+Node: Previewing LaTeX fragments364427
+Node: CDLaTeX mode365436
+Ref: CDLaTeX mode-Footnote-1367923
+Node: Exporting368071
+Node: Selective export369847
+Node: Export options370676
+Ref: Export options-Footnote-1375199
+Node: The export dispatcher375290
+Ref: The export dispatcher-Footnote-1376596
+Node: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export376694
+Ref: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export-Footnote-1379092
+Ref: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export-Footnote-2379150
+Node: HTML export379202
+Node: HTML Export commands380152
+Ref: HTML Export commands-Footnote-1382104
+Ref: HTML Export commands-Footnote-2382162
+Node: Quoting HTML tags382214
+Node: Links in HTML export382865
+Node: Tables in HTML export384000
+Node: Images in HTML export384545
+Ref: Images in HTML export-Footnote-1385842
+Node: Math formatting in HTML export385904
+Ref: Math formatting in HTML export-Footnote-1387340
+Node: Text areas in HTML export387475
+Node: CSS support388319
+Ref: CSS support-Footnote-1391210
+Ref: CSS support-Footnote-2391396
+Node: JavaScript support391596
+Node: LaTeX and PDF export395209
+Ref: LaTeX and PDF export-Footnote-1396082
+Node: LaTeX/PDF export commands396342
+Ref: LaTeX/PDF export commands-Footnote-1398259
+Ref: LaTeX/PDF export commands-Footnote-2398317
+Node: Header and sectioning398369
+Ref: Header and sectioning-Footnote-1399445
+Node: Quoting LaTeX code399571
+Node: Tables in LaTeX export400206
+Node: Images in LaTeX export400939
+Node: Beamer class export402606
+Node: DocBook export408306
+Node: DocBook export commands409174
+Ref: DocBook export commands-Footnote-1410727
+Ref: DocBook export commands-Footnote-2410787
+Node: Quoting DocBook code410839
+Node: Recursive sections411888
+Node: Tables in DocBook export412616
+Node: Images in DocBook export413081
+Node: Special characters415015
+Node: TaskJuggler export416056
+Node: Freemind export421348
+Node: XOXO export421636
+Node: iCalendar export422108
+Ref: iCalendar export-Footnote-1424807
+Ref: iCalendar export-Footnote-2424897
+Ref: iCalendar export-Footnote-3424997
+Node: Publishing425134
+Node: Configuration426002
+Node: Project alist426778
+Node: Sources and destinations427940
+Node: Selecting files429457
+Node: Publishing action430456
+Ref: Publishing action-Footnote-1432246
+Node: Publishing options432600
+Node: Publishing links436209
+Node: Sitemap437891
+Node: Generating an index439413
+Node: Uploading files439996
+Node: Sample configuration441759
+Node: Simple example442248
+Node: Complex example442921
+Node: Triggering publication445008
+Node: Working With Source Code445994
+Node: Structure of code blocks447622
+Node: Editing source code448989
+Node: Exporting code blocks450420
+Node: Extracting source code452142
+Node: Evaluating code blocks453503
+Ref: Evaluating code blocks-Footnote-1455201
+Ref: Evaluating code blocks-Footnote-2455509
+Node: Library of Babel455637
+Node: Languages456447
+Node: Header arguments458419
+Node: Using header arguments458904
+Node: System-wide header arguments459664
+Node: Language-specific header arguments460487
+Node: Buffer-wide header arguments460890
+Node: Header arguments in Org-mode properties461665
+Node: Code block specific header arguments462689
+Node: Header arguments in function calls463823
+Node: Specific header arguments464189
+Node: var465717
+Node: results470206
+Node: file474215
+Node: dir474997
+Node: exports477914
+Node: tangle478566
+Node: comments479277
+Node: no-expand480272
+Node: session480763
+Node: noweb481208
+Node: cache482687
+Node: hlines483523
+Node: colnames485036
+Node: rownames486104
+Node: shebang486966
+Node: eval487361
+Node: Results of evaluation487904
+Node: Noweb reference syntax491103
+Node: Key bindings and useful functions492098
+Node: Batch execution493564
+Node: Miscellaneous494659
+Node: Completion495435
+Node: Easy Templates497410
+Node: Speed keys498794
+Node: Code evaluation security499620
+Node: Customization501794
+Node: In-buffer settings502385
+Ref: In-buffer settings-Footnote-1511615
+Node: The very busy C-c C-c key511663
+Node: Clean view513571
+Ref: Clean view-Footnote-1517557
+Ref: Clean view-Footnote-2517618
+Ref: Clean view-Footnote-3517802
+Ref: Clean view-Footnote-4517863
+Ref: Clean view-Footnote-5517975
+Ref: Clean view-Footnote-6518030
+Node: TTY keys518155
+Node: Interaction519921
+Node: Cooperation520297
+Node: Conflicts524093
+Node: Hacking527410
+Node: Hooks528262
+Node: Add-on packages528678
+Node: Adding hyperlink types529219
+Node: Context-sensitive commands533141
+Ref: Context-sensitive commands-Footnote-1534717
+Node: Tables in arbitrary syntax534851
+Node: Radio tables536263
+Node: A LaTeX example538805
+Ref: A LaTeX example-Footnote-1542727
+Ref: A LaTeX example-Footnote-2542875
+Node: Translator functions543310
+Ref: Translator functions-Footnote-1546533
+Node: Radio lists546621
+Node: Dynamic blocks547750
+Node: Special agenda views549848
+Ref: Special agenda views-Footnote-1553826
+Node: Extracting agenda information553961
+Node: Using the property API558033
+Node: Using the mapping API561325
+Node: MobileOrg565655
+Node: Setting up the staging area567132
+Ref: Setting up the staging area-Footnote-1568231
+Ref: Setting up the staging area-Footnote-2568532
+Node: Pushing to MobileOrg568793
+Ref: Pushing to MobileOrg-Footnote-1569784
+Ref: Pushing to MobileOrg-Footnote-2570200
+Node: Pulling from MobileOrg570257
+Ref: Pulling from MobileOrg-Footnote-1572677
+Ref: Pulling from MobileOrg-Footnote-2572737
+Node: History and Acknowledgments573114
+Node: Main Index584282
+Node: Key Index650959
+Node: Command and Function Index696062
+Node: Variable Index727252
+
+End Tag Table